0
登录后你可以
  • 下载海量资料
  • 学习在线课程
  • 观看技术视频
  • 写文章/发帖/加入社区
会员中心
创作中心
发布
  • 发文章

  • 发资料

  • 发帖

  • 提问

  • 发视频

创作活动
68HC908MR16CFU

68HC908MR16CFU

  • 厂商:

    FREESCALE(飞思卡尔)

  • 封装:

  • 描述:

    68HC908MR16CFU - M68HC08 Microcontrollers - Freescale Semiconductor, Inc

  • 数据手册
  • 价格&库存
68HC908MR16CFU 数据手册
MC68HC908MR32 MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet M68HC08 Microcontrollers MC68HC908MR32 Rev. 6.1 07/2005 freescale.com MC68HC908MR32 MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet To provide the most up-to-date information, the revision of our documents on the World Wide Web will be the most current. Your printed copy may be an earlier revision. To verify you have the latest information available, refer to: http://freescale.com Freescale™ and the Freescale logo are trademarks of Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. This product incorporates SuperFlash® technology licensed from SST. © Freescale Semiconductor, Inc., 2005. All rights reserved. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 3 Revision History The following revision history table summarizes changes contained in this document. For your convenience, the page number designators have been linked to the appropriate location. Revision History Date Revision Level Description Figure 2-1. MC68HC908MR32 Memory Map — Added FLASH Block Protect Register (FLBPR) at address location $FF7E Figure A-1. MC68HC908MR16 Memory Map — Added FLASH Block Protect Register (FLBPR) at address location $FF7E 3.3.3 Conversion Time — Reworked equations and text for clarity. Figure 18-8. Monitor Mode Circuit — PTA7 and connecting circuitry added Table 18-2. Monitor Mode Signal Requirements and Options — Switch locations added to column headings for clarity 5.0 Section 16. Timer Interface A (TIMA) — Timer discrepancies corrected throughout this section. Section 17. Timer Interface B (TIMB) — Timer discrepancies corrected throughout this section. Reformatted to meet current publication standards 2.8.2 FLASH Page Erase Operation — Procedure reworked for clarity 2.8.3 FLASH Mass Erase Operation — Procedure reworked for clarity November, 2003 6.0 2.8.4 FLASH Program Operation — Procedure reworked for clarity Figure 14-14. SIM Break Status Register (SBSR) — Clarified definition of SBSW bit. 19.5 DC Electrical Characteristics — Corrected maximum value for monitor mode entry voltage (on IRQ) 19.6 FLASH Memory Characteristics — Updated table entries July, 2005 6.1 Updated to meet Freescale identity guidelines. Page Number(s) 29 306 50 279 281 233 255 Throughout 42 42 43 207 291 292 Throughout August, 2001 October, 2001 3.0 4.0 December, 2001 MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 4 Freescale Semiconductor List of Chapters Chapter 1 General Description. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17 Chapter 2 Memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25 Chapter 3 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 Chapter 4 Clock Generator Module (CGM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57 Chapter 5 Configuration Register (CONFIG) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73 Chapter 6 Computer Operating Properly (COP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75 Chapter 7 Central Processor Unit (CPU). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79 Chapter 8 External Interrupt (IRQ) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91 Chapter 9 Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97 Chapter 10 Input/Output (I/O) Ports (PORTS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101 Chapter 11 Power-On Reset (POR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113 Chapter 12 Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115 Chapter 13 Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .157 Chapter 14 System Integration Module (SIM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181 Chapter 15 Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195 Chapter 16 Timer Interface A (TIMA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 215 Chapter 17 Timer Interface B (TIMB) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 235 Chapter 18 Development Support . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 251 Chapter 19 Electrical Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 265 Chapter 20 Ordering Information and Mechanical Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 275 Appendix A MC68HC908MR16 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279 MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 5 List of Chapters MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 6 Freescale Semiconductor Table of Contents Chapter 1 General Description 1.1 1.2 1.3 1.4 1.4.1 1.4.2 1.4.3 1.4.4 1.4.5 1.4.6 1.4.7 1.4.8 1.4.9 1.4.10 1.4.11 1.4.12 1.4.13 1.4.14 1.4.15 1.4.16 1.4.17 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Features. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . MCU Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Pin Assignments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Power Supply Pins (VDD and VSS). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Oscillator Pins (OSC1 and OSC2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . External Reset Pin (RST). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . External Interrupt Pin (IRQ) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CGM Power Supply Pins (VDDA and VSSAD) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . External Filter Capacitor Pin (CGMXFC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Analog Power Supply Pins (VDDAD and VSSAD). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ADC Voltage Decoupling Capacitor Pin (VREFH) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ADC Voltage Reference Low Pin (VREFL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Port A Input/Output (I/O) Pins (PTA7–PTA0). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Port B I/O Pins (PTB7/ATD7–PTB0/ATD0) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Port C I/O Pins (PTC6–PTC2 and PTC1/ATD9–PTC0/ATD8). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Port D Input-Only Pins (PTD6/IS3–PTD4/IS1 and PTD3/FAULT4–PTD0/FAULT1) . . . . . . PWM Pins (PWM6–PWM1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PWM Ground Pin (PWMGND) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Port E I/O Pins (PTE7/TCH3A–PTE3/TCLKA and PTE2/TCH1B–PTE0/TCLKB) . . . . . . . . Port F I/O Pins (PTF5/TxD–PTF4/RxD and PTF3/MISO–PTF0/SPSCK) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17 17 18 20 22 22 22 22 22 23 23 23 23 23 23 23 23 23 24 24 24 Chapter 2 Memory 2.1 2.2 2.3 2.4 2.5 2.6 2.7 2.8 2.8.1 2.8.2 2.8.3 2.8.4 2.8.5 2.8.6 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Unimplemented Memory Locations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Reserved Memory Locations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . I/O Section . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Monitor ROM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Random-Access Memory (RAM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FLASH Memory (FLASH) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FLASH Control Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FLASH Page Erase Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FLASH Mass Erase Operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FLASH Program Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FLASH Block Protection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FLASH Block Protect Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 7 25 25 25 26 26 37 37 38 38 39 40 41 43 43 Table of Contents 2.8.7 2.8.8 Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 Chapter 3 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) 3.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.2 Features. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.3 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.3.1 ADC Port I/O Pins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.3.2 Voltage Conversion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.3.3 Conversion Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.3.4 Continuous Conversion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.3.5 Result Justification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.3.6 Monotonicity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.4 Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.5 Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.6 I/O Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.6.1 ADC Analog Power Pin (VDDAD) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.6.2 ADC Analog Ground Pin (VSSAD). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.6.3 ADC Voltage Reference Pin (VREFH) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.6.4 ADC Voltage Reference Low Pin (VREFL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.6.5 ADC Voltage In (ADVIN) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.6.6 ADC External Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.6.6.1 VREFH and VREFL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.6.6.2 ANx. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.6.6.3 Grounding. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.7 I/O Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.7.1 ADC Status and Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.7.2 ADC Data Register High . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.7.3 ADC Data Register Low . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.7.4 ADC Clock Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 45 45 47 47 48 48 48 49 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 51 51 51 51 51 51 52 54 54 55 Chapter 4 Clock Generator Module (CGM) 4.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.2 Features. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.3 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.3.1 Crystal Oscillator Circuit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.3.2 Phase-Locked Loop Circuit (PLL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.3.2.1 PLL Circuits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.3.2.2 Acquisition and Tracking Modes. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.3.2.3 Manual and Automatic PLL Bandwidth Modes. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.3.2.4 Programming the PLL. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.3.2.5 Special Programming Exceptions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.3.3 Base Clock Selector Circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.3.4 CGM External Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57 57 57 59 59 59 60 60 61 62 62 63 MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 8 Freescale Semiconductor 4.4 4.4.1 4.4.2 4.4.3 4.4.4 4.4.5 4.4.6 4.4.7 4.4.8 4.5 4.5.1 4.5.2 4.5.3 4.6 4.7 4.8 4.8.1 4.8.2 4.8.3 4.8.4 I/O Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Crystal Amplifier Input Pin (OSC1). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Crystal Amplifier Output Pin (OSC2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . External Filter Capacitor Pin (CGMXFC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PLL Analog Power Pin (VDDA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Oscillator Enable Signal (SIMOSCEN) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Crystal Output Frequency Signal (CGMXCLK) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CGM Base Clock Output (CGMOUT) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CGM CPU Interrupt (CGMINT) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CGM Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PLL Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PLL Bandwidth Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PLL Programming Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Acquisition/Lock Time Specifications. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Acquisition/Lock Time Definitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Parametric Influences on Reaction Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Choosing a Filter Capacitor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Reaction Time Calculation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64 64 64 64 64 64 65 65 65 65 66 67 68 69 69 70 70 70 71 71 Chapter 5 Configuration Register (CONFIG) 5.1 5.2 5.3 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73 Configuration Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74 Chapter 6 Computer Operating Properly (COP) 6.1 6.2 6.3 6.3.1 6.3.2 6.3.3 6.3.4 6.3.5 6.3.6 6.4 6.5 6.6 6.7 6.8 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . I/O Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CGMXCLK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . COPCTL Write . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Power-On Reset. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Internal Reset. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Reset Vector Fetch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . COPD (COP Disable). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . COP Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Monitor Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75 75 76 76 76 76 76 76 77 77 77 77 77 77 MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 9 Table of Contents Chapter 7 Central Processor Unit (CPU) 7.1 7.2 7.3 7.3.1 7.3.2 7.3.3 7.3.4 7.3.5 7.4 7.5 7.5.1 7.5.2 7.6 7.7 7.8 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Features. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CPU Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Accumulator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Index Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Stack Pointer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Program Counter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Condition Code Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Arithmetic/Logic Unit (ALU) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CPU During Break Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Instruction Set Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Opcode Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79 79 79 80 80 81 81 82 83 83 83 83 83 84 89 Chapter 8 External Interrupt (IRQ) 8.1 8.2 8.3 8.4 8.5 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Features. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IRQ Pin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IRQ Status and Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91 91 91 92 94 Chapter 9 Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI) 9.1 9.2 9.3 9.3.1 9.3.2 9.3.3 9.3.4 9.4 9.5 9.6 9.7 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97 Features. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97 Polled LVI Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98 Forced Reset Operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98 False Reset Protection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98 LVI Trip Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98 LVI Status and Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99 LVI Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99 Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100 MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 10 Freescale Semiconductor Chapter 10 Input/Output (I/O) Ports (PORTS) 10.1 10.2 10.2.1 10.2.2 10.3 10.3.1 10.3.2 10.4 10.4.1 10.4.2 10.5 10.6 10.6.1 10.6.2 10.7 10.7.1 10.7.2 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Port A . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Port A Data Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Data Direction Register A . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Port B . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Port B Data Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Data Direction Register B. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Port C. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Port C Data Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Data Direction Register C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Port D. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Port E . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Port E Data Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Data Direction Register E . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Port F . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Port F Data Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Data Direction Register F . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101 103 103 103 104 104 105 106 106 106 107 108 108 109 110 110 110 Chapter 11 Power-On Reset (POR) 11.1 11.2 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113 Chapter 12 Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC) 12.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12.2 Features. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12.3 Timebase . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12.3.1 Resolution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12.3.2 Prescaler . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12.4 PWM Generators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12.4.1 Load Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12.4.2 PWM Data Overflow and Underflow Conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12.5 Output Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12.5.1 Selecting Six Independent PWMs or Three Complementary PWM Pairs . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12.5.2 Dead-Time Insertion. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12.5.3 Top/Bottom Correction with Motor Phase Current Polarity Sensing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12.5.4 Output Polarity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12.5.5 PWM Output Port Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12.6 Fault Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12.6.1 Fault Condition Input Pins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12.6.1.1 Fault Pin Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12.6.1.2 Automatic Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12.6.1.3 Manual Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115 115 120 120 122 122 122 125 126 126 127 130 133 135 137 137 139 139 140 MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 11 Table of Contents 12.6.2 Software Output Disable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12.6.3 Output Port Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12.7 Initialization and the PWMEN Bit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12.8 PWM Operation in Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12.9 Control Logic Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12.9.1 PWM Counter Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12.9.2 PWM Counter Modulo Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12.9.3 PWMx Value Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12.9.4 PWM Control Register 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12.9.5 PWM Control Register 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12.9.6 Dead-Time Write-Once Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12.9.7 PWM Disable Mapping Write-Once Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12.9.8 Fault Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12.9.9 Fault Status Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12.9.10 Fault Acknowledge Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12.9.11 PWM Output Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12.10 PWM Glossary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141 141 142 143 143 143 144 145 146 148 150 150 150 152 153 154 155 Chapter 13 Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI) 13.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13.2 Features. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13.3 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13.3.1 Data Format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13.3.2 Transmitter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13.3.2.1 Character Length . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13.3.2.2 Character Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13.3.2.3 Break Characters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13.3.2.4 Idle Characters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13.3.2.5 Inversion of Transmitted Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13.3.2.6 Transmitter Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13.3.3 Receiver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13.3.3.1 Character Length . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13.3.3.2 Character Reception. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13.3.3.3 Data Sampling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13.3.3.4 Framing Errors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13.3.3.5 Receiver Wakeup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13.3.3.6 Receiver Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13.3.3.7 Error Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13.4 Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13.5 SCI During Break Module Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13.6 I/O Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13.6.1 PTF5/TxD (Transmit Data). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13.6.2 PTF4/RxD (Receive Data) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13.7 I/O Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13.7.1 SCI Control Register 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13.7.2 SCI Control Register 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 12 Freescale Semiconductor 157 157 159 160 161 162 162 162 163 163 163 163 164 165 165 167 167 167 167 168 168 168 168 169 169 169 171 13.7.3 13.7.4 13.7.5 13.7.6 13.7.7 SCI Control Register 3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . SCI Status Register 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . SCI Status Register 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . SCI Data Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . SCI Baud Rate Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173 174 176 177 177 Chapter 14 System Integration Module (SIM) 14.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14.2 SIM Bus Clock Control and Generation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14.2.1 Bus Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14.2.2 Clock Startup from POR or LVI Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14.2.3 Clocks in Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14.3 Reset and System Initialization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14.3.1 External Pin Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14.3.2 Active Resets from Internal Sources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14.3.2.1 Power-On Reset (POR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14.3.2.2 Computer Operating Properly (COP) Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14.3.2.3 Illegal Opcode Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14.3.2.4 Illegal Address Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14.3.2.5 Forced Monitor Mode Entry Reset (MENRST) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14.3.2.6 Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI) Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14.4 SIM Counter. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14.4.1 SIM Counter During Power-On Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14.4.2 SIM Counter and Reset States . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14.5 Exception Control. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14.5.1 Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14.5.1.1 Hardware Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14.5.1.2 Software Interrupt (SWI) Instruction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14.5.2 Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14.6 Low-Power Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14.6.1 Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14.6.2 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14.7 SIM Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14.7.1 SIM Break Status Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14.7.2 SIM Reset Status Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14.7.3 SIM Break Flag Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181 182 182 182 183 183 183 184 185 185 186 186 186 186 186 186 186 187 187 189 190 190 190 190 191 191 191 192 193 Chapter 15 Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) 15.1 15.2 15.3 15.4 15.4.1 15.4.2 15.5 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Features. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Pin Name Conventions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Master Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Slave Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Transmission Formats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 13 195 195 195 197 198 199 199 Table of Contents 15.5.1 Clock Phase and Polarity Controls. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.5.2 Transmission Format When CPHA = 0 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.5.3 Transmission Format When CPHA = 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.5.4 Transmission Initiation Latency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.6 Error Conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.6.1 Overflow Error . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.6.2 Mode Fault Error . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.7 Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.8 Resetting the SPI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.9 Queuing Transmission Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.10 Low-Power Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.11 I/O Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.11.1 MISO (Master In/Slave Out). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.11.2 MOSI (Master Out/Slave In). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.11.3 SPSCK (Serial Clock) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.11.4 SS (Slave Select) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.11.5 VSS (Clock Ground) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.12 I/O Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.12.1 SPI Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.12.2 SPI Status and Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.12.3 SPI Data Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199 200 201 201 203 203 204 206 207 207 208 208 209 209 209 209 210 210 210 212 214 Chapter 16 Timer Interface A (TIMA) 16.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16.2 Features. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16.3 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16.3.1 TIMA Counter Prescaler. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16.3.2 Input Capture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16.3.3 Output Compare. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16.3.3.1 Unbuffered Output Compare . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16.3.3.2 Buffered Output Compare . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16.3.4 Pulse-Width Modulation (PWM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16.3.4.1 Unbuffered PWM Signal Generation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16.3.4.2 Buffered PWM Signal Generation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16.3.4.3 PWM Initialization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16.4 Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16.5 Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16.6 I/O Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16.6.1 TIMA Clock Pin (PTE3/TCLKA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16.6.2 TIMA Channel I/O Pins (PTE4/TCH0A–PTE7/TCH3A) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16.7 I/O Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16.7.1 TIMA Status and Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16.7.2 TIMA Counter Registers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16.7.3 TIMA Counter Modulo Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16.7.4 TIMA Channel Status and Control Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16.7.5 TIMA Channel Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 14 Freescale Semiconductor 215 215 219 219 219 220 220 221 221 222 223 223 224 224 225 225 225 225 225 227 228 228 232 Chapter 17 Timer Interface B (TIMB) 17.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.2 Features. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.3 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.3.1 TIMB Counter Prescaler. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.3.2 Input Capture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.3.3 Output Compare. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.3.3.1 Unbuffered Output Compare . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.3.3.2 Buffered Output Compare . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.3.4 Pulse-Width Modulation (PWM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.3.4.1 Unbuffered PWM Signal Generation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.3.4.2 Buffered PWM Signal Generation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.3.4.3 PWM Initialization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.4 Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.5 Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.6 I/O Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.6.1 TIMB Clock Pin (PTE0/TCLKB) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.6.2 TIMB Channel I/O Pins (PTE1/TCH0B–PTE2/TCH1B) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.7 I/O Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.7.1 TIMB Status and Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.7.2 TIMB Counter Registers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.7.3 TIMB Counter Modulo Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.7.4 TIMB Channel Status and Control Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.7.5 TIMB Channel Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 235 235 235 238 238 239 239 240 240 241 241 242 243 243 243 243 243 244 244 246 246 247 250 Chapter 18 Development Support 18.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.2 Break Module (BRK) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.2.1 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.2.1.1 Flag Protection During Break Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.2.1.2 CPU During Break Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.2.1.3 TIM1 and TIM2 During Break Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.2.1.4 COP During Break Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.2.2 Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.2.2.1 Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.2.2.2 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.2.3 Break Module Registers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.2.3.1 Break Status and Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.2.3.2 Break Address Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.2.3.3 Break Status Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.2.3.4 Break Flag Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 251 251 251 251 253 253 253 253 253 253 253 254 254 255 255 MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 15 Table of Contents 18.3 Monitor ROM (MON) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.3.1 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.3.1.1 Entering Monitor Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.3.1.2 Normal Monitor Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.3.1.3 Forced Monitor Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.3.1.4 Data Format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.3.1.5 Echoing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.3.1.6 Break Signal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.3.1.7 Commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.3.1.8 Baud Rate. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.3.2 Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 255 256 256 256 259 259 260 260 260 263 263 Chapter 19 Electrical Specifications 19.1 19.2 19.3 19.4 19.5 19.6 19.7 19.8 19.9 19.10 19.11 19.12 19.13 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Absolute Maximum Ratings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Functional Operating Range . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Thermal Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DC Electrical Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FLASH Memory Characteristics. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Control Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Serial Peripheral Interface Characteristics. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . TImer Interface Module Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Clock Generation Module Component Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CGM Operating Conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CGM Acquisition/Lock Time Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 265 265 266 266 267 268 268 269 272 272 272 273 274 Chapter 20 Ordering Information and Mechanical Specifications 20.1 20.2 20.3 20.4 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Order Numbers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64-Pin Plastic Quad Flat Pack (QFP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56-Pin Shrink Dual In-Line Package (SDIP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 275 275 276 277 Appendix A MC68HC908MR16 MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 16 Freescale Semiconductor Chapter 1 General Description 1.1 Introduction The MC68HC908MR32 is a member of the low-cost, high-performance M68HC08 Family of 8-bit microcontroller units (MCUs). All MCUs in the family use the enhanced M68HC08 central processor unit (CPU08) and are available with a variety of modules, memory sizes and types, and package types. The information contained in this document pertains to the MC68HC908MR16 with the exceptions shown in Appendix A MC68HC908MR16. 1.2 Features Features include: • High-performance M68HC08 architecture • Fully upward-compatible object code with M6805, M146805, and M68HC05 Families • 8-MHz internal bus frequency • On-chip FLASH memory with in-circuit programming capabilities of FLASH program memory: MC68HC908MR32 — 32 Kbytes MC68HC908MR16 — 16 Kbytes • On-chip programming firmware for use with host personal computer • FLASH data security(1) • 768 bytes of on-chip random-access memory (RAM) • 12-bit, 6-channel center-aligned or edge-aligned pulse-width modulator (PWMMC) • Serial peripheral interface module (SPI) • Serial communications interface module (SCI) • 16-bit, 4-channel timer interface module (TIMA) • 16-bit, 2-channel timer interface module (TIMB) • Clock generator module (CGM) • Low-voltage inhibit (LVI) module with software selectable trip points • 10-bit, 10-channel analog-to-digital converter (ADC) • System protection features: – Optional computer operating properly (COP) reset – Low-voltage detection with optional reset – Illegal opcode or address detection with optional reset – Fault detection with optional PWM disabling 1. No security feature is absolutely secure. However, Freescale’s strategy is to make reading or copying the FLASH difficult for unauthorized users. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 17 General Description • • • • • Available packages: – 64-pin plastic quad flat pack (QFP) – 56-pin shrink dual in-line package (SDIP) Low-power design, fully static with wait mode Master reset pin (RST) and power-on reset (POR) Stop mode as an option Break module (BRK) supports setting the in-circuit simulator (ICS) single break point Features of the CPU08 include: • Enhanced M68HC05 programming model • Extensive loop control functions • 16 addressing modes (eight more than the M68HC05) • 16-bit index register and stack pointer • Memory-to-memory data transfers • Fast 8 × 8 multiply instruction • Fast 16/8 divide instruction • Binary-coded decimal (BCD) instructions • Optimization for controller applications • C language support 1.3 MCU Block Diagram Figure 1-1 shows the structure of the MC68HC908MR32. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 18 Freescale Semiconductor DDRB USER FLASH — 32,256 BYTES TIMER INTERFACE MODULE A USER RAM — 768 BYTES TIMER INTERFACE MODULE B PTB DDRC USER FLASH VECTOR SPACE — 46 BYTES OSC1 OSC2 CGMXFC SERIAL COMMUNICATIONS INTERFACE MODULE PTC RST SYSTEM INTEGRATION MODULE IRQ MODULE ANALOG-TO-DIGITAL CONVERTER MODULE POWER-ON RESET MODULE PTD DDRE VSS VDD VDDAD VSSAD PTF0/SPSCK(1) POWER Notes: 1. These pins are not available in the 56-pin SDIP package. 2. This module is not available in the 56-pin SDIP package. 3. In the 56-pin SDIP package, these pins are bonded together. DDRF PTF PWMGND PWM6–PWM1 PULSE-WIDTH MODULATOR MODULE PTF5/TxD PTF4/RxD PTF3/MISO(1) PTF2/MOSI(1) PTF1/SS(1) PTE Freescale Semiconductor MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 19 INTERNAL BUS DDRA M68HC08 CPU CPU REGISTERS ARITHMETIC/LOGIC UNIT PTA PTA7–PTA0 PTB7/ATD7 PTB6/ATD6 PTB5/ATD5 PTB4/ATD4 PTB3/ATD3 PTB2/ATD2 PTB1/ATD1 PTB0/ATD0 PTC6 PTC5 PTC4 PTC3 PTC2 PTC1/ATD9(1) PTC0/ATD8 PTD6/IS3 PTD5/IS2 PTD4/IS1 PTD3/FAULT4 PTD2/FAULT3 PTD1/FAULT2 PTD0/FAULT1 PTE7/TCH3A PTE6/TCH2A PTE5/TCH1A PTE4/TCH0A PTE3/TCLKA PTE2/TCH1B(1) PTE1/TCH0B(1) PTE0/TCLKB(1) LOW-VOLTAGE INHIBIT MODULE CONTROL AND STATUS REGISTERS — 112 BYTES COMPUTER OPERATING PROPERLY MODULE MONITOR ROM — 240 BYTES CLOCK GENERATOR MODULE SERIAL PERIPHERAL INTERFACE MODULE(2) IRQ VDDAD VSSAD(3) VREFL(3) VREFH SINGLE BREAK MODULE MCU Block Diagram Figure 1-1. MCU Block Diagram General Description 1.4 Pin Assignments Figure 1-2 shows the 64-pin QFP pin assignments and Figure 1-3 shows the 56-pin SDIP pin assignments. PTB1/ATD1 PTB0/ATD0 CGMXFC VDDAD 50 VSSAD PTA6 OSC2 OSC1 PTA7 PTA5 PTA4 PTA3 PTA2 PTA1 PTA0 64 63 62 61 60 59 58 57 56 55 54 53 52 PTB2/ATD2 PTB3/ATD3 PTB4/ATD4 PTB5/ATD5 PTB6/ATD6 PTB7/ATD7 PTC0/ATD8 PTC1/ATD9 VDDAD VSSAD VREFL VREFH PTC2 PTC3 PTC4 PTC5 51 49 RST 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 48 47 46 45 44 43 42 41 40 39 38 37 36 35 34 IRQ PTF5/TxD PTF4/RxD PTF3/MISO PTF2/MOSI PTF1/SS PTF0/SPSCK VSS VDD PTE7/TCH3A PTE6/TCH2A PTE5/TCH1A PTE4/TCH0A PTE3/TCLKA PTE2/TCH1B 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 PTC6 17 31 16 33 PTE0/TCLKB 32 PTE1/TCH0B PTD0/FAULT1 PTD1/FAULT2 PTD2/FAULT3 PTD3/FAULT4 PWMGND PTD4/IS1 PTD5/IS2 PTD6/IS3 PWM1 PWM2 PWM3 PWM4 PWM5 Figure 1-2. 64-Pin QFP Pin Assignments MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 20 Freescale Semiconductor PWM6 Pin Assignments PTA2 PTA3 PTA4 PTA5 PTA6 PTA7 PTB0/ATD0 PTB1/ATD1 PTB2/ATD2 PTB3/ATD3 PTB4/ATD4 PTB5/ATD5 PTB6/ATD5 PTB7/ATD7 PTC0/ATD8 VDDAD VSSAD/VREFL VREFH PTC2 PTC3 PTC4 PTC5 PTC6 PTD0/FAULT1 PTD1/FAULT2 PTD2/FAULT3 PTD3/FAULT4 PTD4/IS1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 56 55 54 53 52 51 50 49 48 47 46 45 44 43 42 41 40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 PTA1 PTA0 VSSA OSC2 OSC1 CGMXFC VDDA RST IRQ PTF5/TxD PTF4/RxD VSS VDD PTE7/TCH3A PTE6/TCH2A PTE5/TCH1A PTE4/TCH0A PTE3/TCLKA NC PWM6 PWM5 PWMGND PWM4 PWM3 PWM2 PWM1 PTD6/IS3 PTD5/IS2 Note: PTC1, PTE0, PTE1, PTE2, PTF0, PTF1, PTF2, and PTF3 are removed from this package. Figure 1-3. 56-Pin SDIP Pin Assignments MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 21 General Description 1.4.1 Power Supply Pins (VDD and VSS) VDD and VSS are the power supply and ground pins. The MCU operates from a single power supply. Fast signal transitions on MCU pins place high, short-duration current demands on the power supply. To prevent noise problems, take special care to provide power supply bypassing at the MCU as Figure 1-4 shows. Place the C1 bypass capacitor as close to the MCU as possible. Use a high-frequency-response ceramic capacitor for C1. C2 is an optional bulk current bypass capacitor for use in applications that require the port pins to source high-current levels. MCU VDD VSS C1 0.1 µF + C2 1–10 µF VDD Note: Component values shown represent typical applications. Figure 1-4. Power Supply Bypassing 1.4.2 Oscillator Pins (OSC1 and OSC2) The OSC1 and OSC2 pins are the connections for the on-chip oscillator circuit. For more detailed information, see Chapter 4 Clock Generator Module (CGM). 1.4.3 External Reset Pin (RST) A logic 0 on the RST pin forces the MCU to a known startup state. RST is bidirectional, allowing a reset of the entire system. It is driven low when any internal reset source is asserted. See Chapter 14 System Integration Module (SIM). 1.4.4 External Interrupt Pin (IRQ) IRQ is an asynchronous external interrupt pin. See Chapter 8 External Interrupt (IRQ). 1.4.5 CGM Power Supply Pins (VDDA and VSSAD) VDDA and VSSAD are the power supply pins for the analog portion of the clock generator module (CGM). Decoupling of these pins should be per the digital supply. See Chapter 4 Clock Generator Module (CGM). MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 22 Freescale Semiconductor Pin Assignments 1.4.6 External Filter Capacitor Pin (CGMXFC) CGMXFC is an external filter capacitor connection for the CGM. See Chapter 4 Clock Generator Module (CGM). 1.4.7 Analog Power Supply Pins (VDDAD and VSSAD) VDDAD and VSSAD are the power supply pins for the analog-to-digital converter. Decoupling of these pins should be per the digital supply. See Chapter 3 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC). 1.4.8 ADC Voltage Decoupling Capacitor Pin (VREFH) VREFH is the power supply for setting the reference voltage. Connect the VREFH pin to the same voltage potential as VDDAD. See Chapter 3 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC). 1.4.9 ADC Voltage Reference Low Pin (VREFL) VREFL is the lower reference supply for the ADC. Connect the VREFL pin to the same voltage potential as VSSAD. See Chapter 3 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC). 1.4.10 Port A Input/Output (I/O) Pins (PTA7–PTA0) PTA7–PTA0 are general-purpose bidirectional input/output (I/O) port pins. See Chapter 10 Input/Output (I/O) Ports (PORTS). 1.4.11 Port B I/O Pins (PTB7/ATD7–PTB0/ATD0) Port B is an 8-bit special function port that shares all eight pins with the analog-to-digital converter (ADC). See Chapter 3 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) and Chapter 10 Input/Output (I/O) Ports (PORTS). 1.4.12 Port C I/O Pins (PTC6–PTC2 and PTC1/ATD9–PTC0/ATD8) PTC6–PTC2 are general-purpose bidirectional I/O port pins Chapter 10 Input/Output (I/O) Ports (PORTS). PTC1/ATD9–PTC0/ATD8 are special function port pins that are shared with the analog-to-digital converter (ADC). See Chapter 3 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) and Chapter 10 Input/Output (I/O) Ports (PORTS). 1.4.13 Port D Input-Only Pins (PTD6/IS3–PTD4/IS1 and PTD3/FAULT4–PTD0/FAULT1) PTD6/IS3–PTD4/IS1 are special function input-only port pins that also serve as current sensing pins for the pulse-width modulator module (PWMMC). PTD3/FAULT4–PTD0/FAULT1 are special function port pins that also serve as fault pins for the PWMMC. See Chapter 12 Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC) and Chapter 10 Input/Output (I/O) Ports (PORTS). 1.4.14 PWM Pins (PWM6–PWM1) PWM6–PWM1 are dedicated pins used for the outputs of the pulse-width modulator module (PWMMC). These are high-current sink pins. See Chapter 12 Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC) and Chapter 19 Electrical Specifications. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 23 General Description 1.4.15 PWM Ground Pin (PWMGND) PWMGND is the ground pin for the pulse-width modulator module (PWMMC). This dedicated ground pin is used as the ground for the six high-current PWM pins. See Chapter 12 Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC). 1.4.16 Port E I/O Pins (PTE7/TCH3A–PTE3/TCLKA and PTE2/TCH1B–PTE0/TCLKB) Port E is an 8-bit special function port that shares its pins with the two timer interface modules (TIMA and TIMB). See Chapter 16 Timer Interface A (TIMA), Chapter 17 Timer Interface B (TIMB), and Chapter 10 Input/Output (I/O) Ports (PORTS). 1.4.17 Port F I/O Pins (PTF5/TxD–PTF4/RxD and PTF3/MISO–PTF0/SPSCK) Port F is a 6-bit special function port that shares two of its pins with the serial communications interface module (SCI) and four of its pins with the serial peripheral interface module (SPI). See Chapter 15 Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI), Chapter 13 Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI), and Chapter 10 Input/Output (I/O) Ports (PORTS). MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 24 Freescale Semiconductor Chapter 2 Memory 2.1 Introduction The central processor unit (CPU08) can address 64 Kbytes of memory space. The memory map, shown in Figure 2-1, includes: • 32 Kbytes of FLASH • 768 bytes of random-access memory (RAM) • 46 bytes of user-defined vectors • 240 bytes of monitor read-only memory (ROM) 2.2 Unimplemented Memory Locations Some addresses are unimplemented. Accessing an unimplemented address can cause an illegal address reset. In the memory map and in the input/output (I/O) register summary, unimplemented addresses are shaded. Some I/O bits are read only; the write function is unimplemented. Writing to a read-only I/O bit has no effect on microcontroller unit (MCU) operation. In register figures, the write function of read-only bits is shaded. Similarly, some I/O bits are write only; the read function is unimplemented. Reading of write-only I/O bits has no effect on MCU operation. In register figures, the read function of write-only bits is shaded. 2.3 Reserved Memory Locations Some addresses are reserved. Writing to a reserved address can have unpredictable effects on MCU operation. In the memory map (Figure 2-1) and in the I/O register summary (Figure 2-2) reserved addresses are marked with the word reserved. Some I/O bits are reserved. Writing to a reserved bit can have unpredictable effects on MCU operation. In register figures, reserved bits are marked with the letter R. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 25 Memory 2.4 I/O Section Addresses $0000–$005F, shown in Figure 2-2, contain most of the control, status, and data registers. Additional I/O registers have these addresses: • $FE00, SIM break status register (SBSR) • $FE01, SIM reset status register (SRSR) • $FE03, SIM break flag control register (SBFCR) • $FE07, FLASH control register (FLCR) • $FE0C, Break address register high (BRKH) • $FE0D, Break address register low (BRKL) • $FE0E, Break status and control register (BRKSCR) • $FE0F, LVI status and control register (LVISCR) • $FF7E, FLASH block protect register (FLBPR) • $FFFF, COP control register (COPCTL) 2.5 Memory Map Figure 2-1 shows the memory map for the MC68HC908MR32 while the memory map for the MC68HC908MR16 is shown in Appendix A MC68HC908MR16 MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 26 Freescale Semiconductor Memory Map $0000 ↓ I/O REGISTERS — 96 BYTES $005F $0060 ↓ RAM — 768 BYTES $035F $0360 ↓ UNIMPLEMENTED — 31,904 BYTES $7FFF $8000 ↓ FLASH — 32,256 BYTES SIM BREAK STATUS REGISTER (SBSR) SIM RESET STATUS REGISTER (SRSR) RESERVED SIM BREAK FLAG CONTROL REGISTER (SBFCR) RESERVED RESERVED RESERVED RESERVED FLASH CONTROL REGISTER (FLCR) UNIMPLEMENTED UNIMPLEMENTED UNIMPLEMENTED SIM BREAK ADDRESS REGISTER HIGH (BRKH) SIM BREAK ADDRESS REGISTER LOW (BRKL) SIM BREAK FLAG CONTROL REGISTER (SBFCR) LVI STATUS AND CONTROL REGISTER (LVISCR) MONITOR ROM — 240 BYTES $FDFF $FE00 $FE01 $FE02 $FE03 $FE04 $FE05 $FE06 $FE07 $FE08 $FE09 $FE0A $FE0B $FE0C $FE0D $FE0E $FE0F $FE10 ↓ $FEFF $FF00 ↓ $FF7D $FF7E $FF7F ↓ $FFD1 $FFD2 ↓ UNIMPLEMENTED — 126 BYTES FLASH BLOCK PROTECT REGISTER (FLBPR) UNIMPLEMENTED — 83 BYTES VECTORS — 46 BYTES $FFFF Figure 2-1. MC68HC908MR32 Memory Map MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 27 Memory Addr. $0000 Register Name Port A Data Register Read: (PTA) Write: See page 103. Reset: Port B Data Register Read: (PTB) Write: See page 104. Reset: Port C Data Register Read: (PTC) Write: See page 106. Reset: Port D Data Register (PTD) Write: See page 107. Reset: Read: Bit 7 PTA7 6 PTA6 5 PTA5 4 PTA4 3 PTA3 2 PTA2 1 PTA1 Bit 0 PTA0 Unaffected by reset PTB7 PTB6 PTB5 PTB4 PTB3 PTB2 PTB1 PTB0 $0001 Unaffected by reset 0 R 0 R PTC6 PTC5 PTC4 PTC3 PTC2 PTC1 PTC0 $0002 Unaffected by reset PTD6 R PTD5 R PTD4 R PTD3 R PTD2 R PTD1 R PTD0 R $0003 Unaffected by reset DDRA6 0 DDRB6 0 DDRC6 0 DDRA5 0 DDRB5 0 DDRC5 0 DDRA4 0 DDRB4 0 DDRC4 0 DDRA3 0 DDRB3 0 DDRC3 0 DDRA2 0 DDRB2 0 DDRC2 0 DDRA1 0 DDRB1 0 DDRC1 0 DDRA0 0 DDRB0 0 DDRC0 0 $0004 Data Direction Register A Read: DDRA7 (DDRA) Write: See page 103. Reset: 0 Data Direction Register B Read: DDRB7 (DDRB) Write: See page 105. Reset: 0 Data Direction Register C Read: (DDRC) Write: See page 106. Reset: Unimplemented Port E Data Register Read: (PTE) Write: See page 108. Reset: Port F Data Register Read: (PTF) Write: See page 110. Reset: Unimplemented Unimplemented Data Direction Register E Read: DDRE7 (DDRE) Write: See page 109. Reset: 0 Data Direction Register F Read: (DDRF) Write: See page 110. Reset: X = Indeterminate 0 R R 0 R 0 $0005 $0006 $0007 $0008 PTE7 PTE6 PTE5 PTE4 PTE3 PTE2 PTE1 PTE0 Unaffected by reset 0 R 0 R PTF5 PTF4 PTF3 PTF2 PTF1 PTF0 $0009 $000A $000B Unaffected by reset $000C DDRE6 0 0 R = Reserved DDRE5 0 DDRF5 0 DDRE4 0 DDRF4 0 Bold DDRE3 0 DDRF3 0 = Buffered DDRE2 0 DDRF2 0 DDRE1 0 DDRF1 0 DDRE0 0 DDRF0 0 $000D U = Unaffected = Unimplemented Figure 2-2. Control, Status, and Data Registers Summary (Sheet 1 of 8) MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 28 Freescale Semiconductor Memory Map Addr. $000E Register Name TIMA Status/Control Register (TASC) Write: See page 226. Reset: Read: Bit 7 TOF 0 0 Bit 15 R 0 Bit 7 R 0 Bit 15 1 Bit 7 1 CH0F 0 0 Bit 15 6 TOIE 0 Bit 14 R 0 Bit 6 R 0 14 1 Bit 6 1 CH0IE 0 Bit 14 5 TSTOP 1 Bit 13 R 0 Bit 5 R 0 13 1 Bit 5 1 MS0B 0 Bit 13 4 0 TRST 0 Bit 12 R 0 Bit 4 R 0 12 1 Bit 4 1 MS0A 0 Bit 12 3 0 R 0 Bit 11 R 0 Bit 3 R 0 11 1 Bit 3 1 ELS0B 0 Bit 11 2 PS2 0 Bit 10 R 0 Bit 2 R 0 10 1 Bit 2 1 ELS0A 0 Bit 10 1 PS1 0 Bit 9 R 0 Bit 1 R 0 9 1 Bit 1 1 TOV0 0 Bit 9 Bit 0 PS0 0 Bit 8 R 0 Bit 0 R 0 Bit 8 1 Bit 0 1 CH0MAX 0 Bit 8 $000F TIMA Counter Register High Read: (TACNTH) Write: See page 227. Reset: TIMA Counter Register Low Read: (TACNTL) Write: See page 227. Reset: TIMA Counter Modulo Read: Register High (TAMODH) Write: See page 228. Reset: TIMA Counter Modulo Register Low (TAMODL) Write: See page 228. Reset: TIMA Channel 0 Status/Control Read: Register (TASC0) Write: See page 229. Reset: TIMA Channel 0 Register High Read: (TACH0H) Write: See page 232. Reset: TIMA Channel 0 Register Low Read: (TACH0L) Write: See page 232. Reset: TIMA Channel 1 Status/Control Register (TASC1) Write: See page 232. Reset: TIMA Channel 1 Register High Read: (TACH1H) Write: See page 232. Reset: TIMA Channel 1 Register Low Read: (TACH1L) Write: See page 232. Reset: TIMA Channel 2 Status/Control Read: Register (TASC2) Write: See page 229. Reset: X = Indeterminate Read: Read: $0010 $0011 $0012 $0013 $0014 Indeterminate after reset Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 $0015 Indeterminate after reset CH1F 0 0 Bit 15 CH1IE 0 Bit 14 0 R 0 Bit 13 MS1A 0 Bit 12 ELS1B 0 Bit 11 ELS1A 0 Bit 10 TOV1 0 Bit 9 CH1MAX 0 Bit 8 $0016 $0017 Indeterminate after reset Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 $0018 Indeterminate after reset CH2F 0 0 R CH2IE 0 = Reserved MS2B 0 MS2A 0 Bold ELS2B 0 = Buffered ELS2A 0 TOV2 0 CH2MAX 0 $0019 U = Unaffected = Unimplemented Figure 2-2. Control, Status, and Data Registers Summary (Sheet 2 of 8) MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 29 Memory Addr. $001A Register Name TIMA Channel 2 Register High (TACH2H) Write: See page 232. Reset: TIMA Channel 2 Register Low Read: (TACH2L) Write: See page 232. Reset: TIMA Channel 3 Status/Control Read: Register (TASC3) Write: See page 229. Reset: TIMA Channel 3 Register High Read: (TACH3H) Write: See page 232. Reset: TIMA Channel 3 Register Low (TACH3L) Write: See page 232. Reset: Configuration Register Read: (CONFIG) Write: See page 74. Reset: PWM Control Register 1 Read: (PCTL1) Write: See page 146. Reset: Read: Read: Bit 7 Bit 15 6 Bit 14 5 Bit 13 4 Bit 12 3 Bit 11 2 Bit 10 1 Bit 9 Bit 0 Bit 8 Indeterminate after reset Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 $001B Indeterminate after reset CH3F 0 0 Bit 15 CH3IE 0 Bit 14 0 R 0 Bit 13 MS3A 0 Bit 12 ELS3B 0 Bit 11 ELS3A 0 Bit 10 TOV3 0 Bit 9 CH3MAX 0 Bit 8 $001C $001D Indeterminate after reset Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 $001E Indeterminate after reset EDGE 0 DISX 0 BOTNEG 0 DISY 0 LDFQ0 0 FMODE4 0 FFLAG4 0 0 FTACK4 0 0 0 R 0 OUTCTL 0 = Reserved 0 OUT6 0 TOPNEG 0 PWMINT 0 0 0 FINT3 0 FPIN3 U DT6 INDEP 0 PWMF 0 IPOL1 0 FMODE3 0 FFLAG3 0 DT5 FTACK3 0 OUT5 0 Bold 0 OUT4 0 = Buffered LVIRST 1 ISENS1 0 IPOL2 0 FINT2 0 FPIN2 U DT4 LVIPWR 1 ISENS0 0 IPOL3 0 FMODE2 0 FFLAG2 0 DT3 FTACK2 0 OUT3 0 0 OUT2 0 STOPE 0 LDOK 0 PRSC1 0 FINT1 0 FPIN1 U DT2 COPD 0 PWMEN 0 PRSC0 0 FMODE1 0 FFLAG1 0 DT1 FTACK1 0 OUT1 0 $001F $0020 $0021 PWM Control Register 2 Read: LDFQ1 (PCTL2) Write: See page 148. Reset: 0 Fault Control Register (FCR) Write: See page 150. Reset: Fault Status Register Read: (FSR) Write: See page 152. Reset: Fault Acknowledge Register Read: (FTACK) Write: See page 153. Reset: PWM Output Control Register Read: (PWMOUT) Write: See page 154. Reset: X = Indeterminate Read: FINT4 0 FPIN4 U 0 $0022 $0023 $0024 $0025 U = Unaffected = Unimplemented Figure 2-2. Control, Status, and Data Registers Summary (Sheet 3 of 8) MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 30 Freescale Semiconductor Memory Map Addr. $0026 Register Name PWM Counter Register High (PCNTH) Write: See page 143. Reset: PWM Counter Register Low Read: (PCNTL) Write: See page 143. Reset: PWM Counter Modulo Register Read: High (PMODH) Write: See page 144. Reset: PWM Counter Modulo Register Read: Low (PMODL) Write: See page 144. Reset: PWM 1 Value Register High (PVAL1H) Write: See page 145. Reset: PWM 1 Value Register Low Read: (PVAL1L) Write: See page 145. Reset: PWM 2 Value Register High Read: (PVAL2H) Write: See page 145. Reset: PWM 2 Value Register Low Read: (PVAL2L) Write: See page 145. Reset: PWM 3 Value Register High (PVAL3H) Write: See page 145. Reset: PWM 3 Value Register Low Read: (PVAL3L) Write: See page 145. Reset: PWM 4 Value Register High Read: (PVAL4H) Write: See page 145. Reset: PWM 4 Value Register Low Read: (PVAL4L) Write: See page 145. Reset: X = Indeterminate Read: Read: Read: Bit 7 0 0 Bit 7 0 0 0 Bit 7 X Bit 15 0 Bit 7 0 Bit 15 0 Bit 7 0 Bit 15 0 Bit 7 0 Bit 15 0 Bit 7 0 R 6 0 0 Bit 6 0 0 0 Bit 6 X Bit 14 0 Bit 6 0 Bit 14 0 Bit 6 0 Bit 14 0 Bit 6 0 Bit 14 0 Bit 6 0 = Reserved 5 0 0 Bit 5 0 0 0 Bit 5 X Bit 13 0 Bit 5 0 Bit 13 0 Bit 5 0 Bit 13 0 Bit 5 0 Bit 13 0 Bit 5 0 4 0 0 Bit 4 0 0 0 Bit 4 X Bit 12 0 Bit 4 0 Bit 12 0 Bit 4 0 Bit 12 0 Bit 4 0 Bit 12 0 Bit 4 0 Bold 3 Bit 11 0 Bit 3 0 Bit 11 X Bit 3 X Bit 11 0 Bit 3 0 Bit 11 0 Bit 3 0 Bit 11 0 Bit 3 0 Bit 11 0 Bit 3 0 = Buffered 2 Bit 10 0 Bit 2 0 Bit 10 X Bit 2 X Bit 10 0 Bit 2 0 Bit 10 0 Bit 2 0 Bit 10 0 Bit 2 0 Bit 10 0 Bit 2 0 1 Bit 9 0 Bit 1 0 Bit 9 X Bit 1 X Bit 9 0 Bit 1 0 Bit 9 0 Bit 1 0 Bit 9 0 Bit 1 0 Bit 9 0 Bit 1 0 Bit 0 Bit 8 0 Bit 0 0 Bit 8 X Bit 0 X Bit 8 0 Bit 0 0 Bit 8 0 Bit 0 0 Bit 8 0 Bit 0 0 Bit 8 0 Bit 0 0 $0027 $0028 $0029 $002A $002B $002C $002D $002E $002F $0030 $0031 U = Unaffected = Unimplemented Figure 2-2. Control, Status, and Data Registers Summary (Sheet 4 of 8) MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 31 Memory Addr. $0032 Register Name PWM 5 Value Register High (PMVAL5H) Write: See page 145. Reset: PWM 5 Value Register Low Read: (PVAL5L) Write: See page 145. Reset: PWM 6 Value Register High Read: (PVAL6H) Write: See page 145. Reset: PWM 6 Value Register Low Read: (PMVAL6L) Write: See page 145. Reset: Dead-Time Write-Once Register (DEADTM) Write: See page 150. Reset: PWM Disable Mapping Read: Write-Once Register (DISMAP) Write: See page 137. Reset: Read: Read: Bit 7 Bit 15 0 Bit 7 0 Bit 15 0 Bit 7 0 Bit 7 1 Bit 7 1 6 Bit 14 0 Bit 6 0 Bit 14 0 Bit 6 0 Bit 6 1 Bit 6 1 ENSCI 0 TCIE 0 T8 U TC R 1 0 R 0 R6 T6 = Reserved 5 Bit 13 0 Bit 5 0 Bit 13 0 Bit 5 0 Bit 5 1 Bit 5 1 TXINV 0 SCRIE 0 0 R 0 SCRF R 0 0 R 0 R5 T5 4 Bit 12 0 Bit 4 0 Bit 12 0 Bit 4 0 Bit 4 1 Bit 4 1 M 0 ILIE 0 0 R 0 IDLE R 0 0 R 0 R4 T4 Bold 3 Bit 11 0 Bit 3 0 Bit 11 0 Bit 3 0 Bit 3 1 Bit 3 1 WAKE 0 TE 0 ORIE 0 OR R 0 0 R 0 R3 T3 = Buffered 2 Bit 10 0 Bit 2 0 Bit 10 0 Bit 2 0 Bit 2 1 Bit 2 1 ILTY 0 RE 0 NEIE 0 NF R 0 0 R 0 R2 T2 1 Bit 9 0 Bit 1 0 Bit 9 0 Bit 1 0 Bit 1 1 Bit 1 1 PEN 0 RWU 0 FEIE 0 FE R 0 BKF R 0 R1 T1 Bit 0 Bit 8 0 Bit 0 0 Bit 8 0 Bit 0 0 Bit 0 1 Bit 0 1 PTY 0 SBK 0 PEIE 0 PE R 0 RPF R 0 R0 T0 $0033 $0034 $0035 $0036 $0037 $0038 SCI Control Register 1 Read: LOOPS (SCC1) Write: See page 169. Reset: 0 SCI Control Register 2 Read: SCTIE (SCC2) Write: See page 171. Reset: 0 SCI Control Register 3 (SCC3) Write: See page 173. Reset: SCI Status Register 1 Read: (SCS1) Write: See page 174. Reset: SCI Status Register 2 Read: (SCS2) Write: See page 176. Reset: SCI Data Register Read: (SCDR) Write: See page 177. Reset: X = Indeterminate Read: R8 R U SCTE R 1 0 R 0 R7 T7 R $0039 $003A $003B $003C $003D U = Unaffected Unaffected by reset = Unimplemented Figure 2-2. Control, Status, and Data Registers Summary (Sheet 5 of 8) MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 32 Freescale Semiconductor Memory Map Addr. $003E Register Name SCI Baud Rate Register (SCBR) Write: See page 177. Reset: IRQ Status/Control Register Read: (ISCR) Write: See page 94. Reset: Read: Bit 7 0 R 0 0 R 0 6 0 R 0 0 R 0 AIEN 0 0 R AD6 R 5 SCP1 0 0 R 0 ADCO 0 0 R AD5 R 4 SCP0 0 0 R 0 ADCH4 1 0 R AD4 R 0 ADCH3 1 0 R AD3 R 3 0 R 0 IRQF 2 SCR2 0 0 ACK1 0 ADCH2 1 0 R AD2 R 1 SCR1 0 IMASK1 0 ADCH1 1 AD9 R AD1 R Bit 0 SCR0 0 MODE1 0 ADCH0 1 AD8 R AD0 R 0 R 0 SPTIE 0 SPR0 0 R0 T0 $003F $0040 ADC Status and Control Read: COCO R Register (ADSCR) Write: See page 52. Reset: 0 ADC Data Register High Read: Right Justified Mode (ADRH) Write: See page 54. Reset: ADC Data Register Low Right Justified Mode (ADRL) Write: See page 54. Reset: ADC Clock Register Read: (ADCLK) Write: See page 55. Reset: Read: 0 R AD7 R $0041 Unaffected by reset $0042 Unaffected by reset ADIV2 0 ADIV1 0 R 0 ERRIE 0 R6 T6 ADIV0 0 SPMSTR 1 OVRF R 0 R5 T5 ADICLK 0 CPOL 0 MODF R 0 R4 T4 MODE1 0 CPHA 1 SPTE R 1 R3 T3 MODE0 1 SPWOM 0 MODFEN 0 R2 T2 0 0 SPE 0 SPR1 0 R1 T1 $0043 $0044 SPI Control Register Read: SPRIE (SPCR) Write: See page 211. Reset: 0 SPI Status and Control Read: Register (SPSCR) Write: See page 212. Reset: SPI Data Register (SPDR) Write: See page 214. Reset: Unimplemented Read: SPRF R 0 R7 T7 $0045 $0046 $0047 ↓ $0050 Unaffected by reset $0051 TIMB Status/Control Register Read: (TBSC) Write: See page 244. Reset: TIMB Counter Register High Read: (TBCNTH) Write: See page 246. Reset: X = Indeterminate TOF 0 0 Bit 15 R 0 R TOIE 0 Bit 14 R 0 = Reserved TSTOP 1 Bit 13 R 0 0 TRST 0 Bit 12 R 0 Bold 0 R 0 Bit 11 R 0 = Buffered PS2 0 Bit 10 R 0 PS1 0 Bit 9 R 0 PS0 0 Bit 8 R 0 $0052 U = Unaffected = Unimplemented Figure 2-2. Control, Status, and Data Registers Summary (Sheet 6 of 8) MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 33 Memory Addr. $0053 Register Name TIMB Counter Register Low (TBCNTL) Write: See page 246. Reset: TIMB Counter Modulo Register Read: High (TBMODH) Write: See page 246. Reset: TIMB Counter Modulo Register Read: Low (TBMODL) Write: See page 246. Reset: TIMB Channel 0 Status/Control Read: Register (TBSC0) Write: See page 247. Reset: TIMB Channel 0 Register High (TBCH0H) Write: See page 250. Reset: TIMB Channel 0 Register Low Read: (TBCH0L) Write: See page 250. Reset: TIMB Channel 1 Status/Control Read: Register (TBSC1) Write: See page 247. Reset: TIMB Channel 1 Register High Read: (TBCH1H) Write: See page 250. Reset: TIMB Channel 1 Register Low (TBCH1L) Write: See page 250. Reset: PLL Control Register Read: (PCTL) Write: See page 66. Reset: PLL Bandwidth Control Read: Register (PBWC) Write: See page 67. Reset: PLL Programming Register Read: (PPG) Write: See page 68. Reset: Unimplemented X = Indeterminate R = Reserved Bold = Buffered = Unimplemented Read: Read: Read: Bit 7 Bit 7 R 0 Bit 15 1 Bit 7 1 CH0F 0 0 Bit 15 6 Bit 6 R 0 Bit 14 1 Bit 6 1 CH0IE 0 Bit 14 5 Bit 5 R 0 Bit 13 1 Bit 5 1 MS0B 0 Bit 13 4 Bit 4 R 0 Bit 12 1 Bit 4 1 MS0A 0 Bit 12 3 Bit 3 R 0 Bit 11 1 Bit 3 1 ELS0B 0 Bit 11 2 Bit 2 R 0 Bit 10 1 Bit 2 1 ELS0A 0 Bit 10 1 Bit 1 R 0 Bit 9 1 Bit 1 1 TOV0 0 Bit 9 Bit 0 Bit 0 R 0 Bit 8 1 Bit 0 1 CH0MAX 0 Bit 8 $0054 $0055 $0056 $0057 Indeterminate after reset Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 $0058 Indeterminate after reset CH1F 0 0 Bit 15 CH1IE 0 Bit 14 0 R 0 Bit 13 MS1A 0 Bit 12 ELS1B 0 Bit 11 ELS1A 0 Bit 10 TOV1 0 Bit 9 CH1MAX 0 Bit 8 $0059 $005A Indeterminate after reset Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 $005B Indeterminate after reset PLLIE 0 AUTO 0 MUL7 0 PLLF R 0 LOCK R 0 MUL6 1 PLLON 1 ACQ 0 MUL5 1 BCS 0 XLD 0 MUL4 0 1 R 1 0 R 0 VRS7 0 1 R 1 0 R 0 VRS6 1 1 R 1 0 R 0 VRS5 1 1 R 1 0 R 0 VRS4 0 $005C $005D $005E $005F U = Unaffected Figure 2-2. Control, Status, and Data Registers Summary (Sheet 7 of 8) MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 34 Freescale Semiconductor Memory Map Addr. $FE00 Register Name SIM Break Status Register (SBSR) Write: See page 191. Reset: SIM Reset Status Register Read: (SRSR) Write: See page 192. Reset: SIM Break Flag Control Read: Register (SBFCR) Write: See page 193. Reset: FLASH Control Register (FLCR) See page 38. Read: Write: Reset: Break Address Register High Read: (BRKH) Write: See page 254. Reset: Break Address Register Low (BRKL) Write: See page 254. Reset: Break Status and Control Read: Register (BRKSCR) Write: See page 254. Reset: Read: 0 Bit 15 0 Bit 7 0 BRKE 0 0 14 0 6 0 BRKA 0 0 R 0 BPR6 0 0 13 0 5 0 0 0 TRPSEL 0 BPR5 0 0 12 0 4 0 0 0 0 R 0 BPR4 0 Read: Bit 7 R 6 R 5 R 4 R 3 R 2 R 1 BW 0 POR R 1 BCFE 0 0 0 0 0 HVEN 0 11 0 3 0 0 0 0 R 0 BPR3 0 MASS 0 10 0 2 0 0 0 0 R 0 BPR2 0 ERASE 0 9 0 1 0 0 0 0 R 0 BPR1 0 PGM 0 Bit 8 0 Bit 0 0 0 0 0 R 0 BPR0 0 PIN R 0 R COP R 0 R ILOP R 0 R ILAD R 0 R MENRST R 0 R LVI R 0 R 0 R 0 R Bit 0 R $FE01 $FE03 $FE08 $FE0C $FE0D $FE0E $FE0F LVI Status and Control Register Read: LVIOUT (LVISCR) Write: R See page 99. Reset: 0 FLASH Block Protect Register Read: (FLBPR) Write: See page 43. Reset: BPR7 0 $FF7E $FFFF COP Control Register Read: (COPCTL) Write: See page 77. Reset: X = Indeterminate R = Reserved Low byte of reset vector Clear COP counter Unaffected by reset Bold = Buffered = Unimplemented U = Unaffected Figure 2-2. Control, Status, and Data Registers Summary (Sheet 8 of 8) MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 35 Memory Table 2-1 is a list of vector locations. Table 2-1. Vector Addresses Address Low $FFD2 $FFD3 $FFD4 $FFD5 $FFD6 $FFD7 $FFD8 $FFD9 $FFDA $FFDB $FFDC $FFDD $FFDE $FFDF Vector SCI transmit vector (high) SCI transmit vector (low) SCI receive vector (high) SCI receive vector (low) SCI error vector (high) SCI error vector (low) SPI transmit vector (high)(1) SPI transmit vector (low)(1) SPI receive vector (high)(1) SPI receive vector (low)(1) A/D vector (high) A/D vector (low) TIMB overflow vector (high) TIMB overflow vector (low) TIMB channel 1 vector (high) TIMB channel 1 vector (low) TIMB channel 0 vector (high) TIMB channel 0 vector (low) TIMA overflow vector (high) TIMA overflow vector (low) TIMA channel 3 vector (high) TIMA channel 3 vector (low) TIMA channel 2 vector (high) TIMA channel 2 vector (low) TIMA channel 1 vector (high) TIMA channel 1 vector (low) TIMA channel 0 vector (high) TIMA channel 0 vector (low) Priority $FFE0 $FFE1 $FFE2 $FFE3 $FFE4 $FFE5 $FFE6 $FFE7 $FFE8 $FFE9 $FFEA $FFEB $FFEC $FFED 1. The SPI module is not available in the 56-pin SDIP package. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 36 Freescale Semiconductor Monitor ROM Table 2-1. Vector Addresses (Continued) Address $FFEE $FFEF $FFF0 $FFF1 $FFF2 $FFF3 $FFF4 PWMMC vector (high) PWMMC vector (low) FAULT 4 (high) FAULT 4 (low) FAULT 3 (high) FAULT 3 (low) FAULT 2 (high) FAULT 2 (low) FAULT 1 (high) FAULT 1 (low) PLL vector (high) PLL vector (low) IRQ vector (high) IRQ vector (low) SWI vector (high) SWI vector (low) Reset vector (high) Reset vector (low) Vector Priority $FFF5 $FFF6 $FFF7 $FFF8 $FFF9 $FFFA $FFFB $FFFC $FFFD High $FFFE $FFFF 2.6 Monitor ROM The 240 bytes at addresses $FE10–$FEFF are reserved ROM addresses that contain the instructions for the monitor functions. See 18.3 Monitor ROM (MON). 2.7 Random-Access Memory (RAM) Addresses $0060–$035F are RAM locations. The location of the stack RAM is programmable. The 16-bit stack pointer allows the stack to be anywhere in the 64-Kbyte memory space. NOTE For correct operation, the stack pointer must point only to RAM locations. Within page zero are 160 bytes of RAM. Because the location of the stack RAM is programmable, all page zero RAM locations can be used for input/output (I/O) control and user data or code. When the stack pointer is moved from its reset location at $00FF, direct addressing mode instructions can access efficiently all page zero RAM locations. Page zero RAM, therefore, provides ideal locations for frequently accessed global variables. Before processing an interrupt, the central processor unit (CPU) uses five bytes of the stack to save the contents of the CPU registers. NOTE For M68HC05 and M1468HC05 compatibility, the H register is not stacked. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 37 Memory During a subroutine call, the CPU uses two bytes of the stack to store the return address. The stack pointer decrements during pushes and increments during pulls. NOTE Be careful when using nested subroutines. The CPU may overwrite data in the RAM during a subroutine or during the interrupt stacking operation. 2.8 FLASH Memory (FLASH) The FLASH memory is an array of 32,256 bytes with an additional 46 bytes of user vectors and one byte of block protection. NOTE An erased bit reads as a 1 and a programmed bit reads as a 0. Program and erase operations are facilitated through control bits in a memory mapped register. Details for these operations appear later in this section. Memory in the FLASH array is organized into two rows per page. The page size is 128 bytes per page. The minimum erase page size is 128 bytes. Programming is performed on a row basis, 64 bytes at a time. The address ranges for the user memory and vectors are: • $8000–$FDFF, user memory • $FF7E, block protect register (FLBPR) • $FE08, FLASH control register (FLCR) • $FFD2–$FFFF, reserved for user-defined interrupt and reset vectors Programming tools are available from Freescale. Contact a local Freescale representative for more information. NOTE A security feature prevents viewing of the FLASH contents.(1) 2.8.1 FLASH Control Register The FLASH control register (FLCR) controls FLASH program and erase operations. Address: Read: Write: Reset: 0 0 = Unimplemented 0 0 $FE08 Bit 7 0 6 0 5 0 4 0 3 HVEN 0 2 MASS 0 1 ERASE 0 Bit 0 PGM 0 Figure 2-3. FLASH Control Register (FLCR) 1. No security feature is absolutely secure. However, Freescale’s strategy is to make reading or copying the FLASH difficult for unauthorized users. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 38 Freescale Semiconductor FLASH Memory (FLASH) HVEN — High-Voltage Enable Bit This read/write bit enables the charge pump to drive high voltages for program and erase operations in the array. HVEN can only be set if either PGM = 1 or ERASE = 1 and the proper sequence for program or erase is followed. 1 = High voltage enabled to array and charge pump on 0 = High voltage disabled to array and charge pump off MASS — Mass Erase Control Bit Setting this read/write bit configures the 32-Kbyte FLASH array for mass erase operation. Mass erase is disabled if any FLASH block is protected 1 = MASS erase operation selected 0 = MASS erase operation unselected ERASE — Erase Control Bit This read/write bit configures the memory for erase operation. ERASE is interlocked with the PGM bit such that both bits cannot be equal to 1 or set to 1 at the same time. 1 = Erase operation selected 0 = Erase operation unselected PGM — Program Control Bit This read/write bit configures the memory for program operation. PGM is interlocked with the ERASE bit such that both bits cannot be equal to 1 or set to 1 at the same time. 1 = Program operation selected 0 = Program operation unselected 2.8.2 FLASH Page Erase Operation Use this step-by-step procedure to erase a page (128 bytes) of FLASH memory. 1. Set the ERASE bit and clear the MASS bit in the FLASH control register. 2. Read the FLASH block protect register. 3. Write any data to any FLASH location within the address range of the block to be erased. 4. Wait for a time, tNVS (minimum 10 µs). 5. Set the HVEN bit. 6. Wait for a time, tErase (minimum 1 ms or 4 ms). 7. Clear the ERASE bit. 8. Wait for a time, tNVH (minimum 5 µs). 9. Clear the HVEN bit. 10. After time, tRCV (typical 1 µs), the memory can be accessed in read mode again. NOTE Programming and erasing of FLASH locations cannot be performed by code being executed from the FLASH memory. While these operations must be performed in the order shown, other unrelated operations may occur between the steps. In applications that require more than 1000 program/erase cycles, use the 4 ms page erase specification to get improved long-term reliability. Any application can use this 4 ms page erase specification. However, in applications where a FLASH location will be erased and reprogrammed less than 1000 times, and speed is important, use the 1 ms page erase specification to get a shorter cycle time. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 39 Memory 2.8.3 FLASH Mass Erase Operation Use this step-by-step procedure to erase the entire FLASH memory. 1. Set both the ERASE bit and the MASS bit in the FLASH control register. 2. Read the FLASH block protect register. 3. Write any data to any FLASH address(1) within the FLASH memory address range. 4. Wait for a time, tNVS (minimum 10 µs). 5. Set the HVEN bit. 6. Wait for a time, tMErase (minimum 4 ms). 7. Clear the ERASE and MASS bits. NOTE Mass erase is disabled whenever any block is protected (FLBPR does not equal $FF). 8. Wait for a time, tNVHL (minimum 100 µs). 9. Clear the HVEN bit. 10. After time, tRCV (typical 1 µs), the memory can be accessed in read mode again. NOTE Programming and erasing of FLASH locations cannot be performed by code being executed from the FLASH memory. While these operations must be performed in the order shown, other unrelated operations may occur between the steps. 1. When in monitor mode, with security sequence failed (see 18.3.2 Security), write to the FLASH block protect register instead of any FLASH address. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 40 Freescale Semiconductor FLASH Memory (FLASH) 2.8.4 FLASH Program Operation Use the following step-by-step procedure to program a row of FLASH memory. Figure 2-4 shows a flowchart of the programming algorithm. NOTE Only bytes which are currently $FF may be programmed. 1. Set the PGM bit. This configures the memory for program operation and enables the latching of address and data for programming. 2. Read the FLASH block protect register. 3. Write any data to any FLASH location within the address range desired. 4. Wait for a time, tNVS (minimum 10 µs). 5. Set the HVEN bit. 6. Wait for a time, tPGS (minimum 5 µs). 7. Write data to the FLASH address being programmed(1). 8. Wait for time, tPROG (minimum 30 µs). 9. Repeat step 7 and 8 until all desired bytes within the row are programmed. 10. Clear the PGM bit(1). 11. Wait for time, tNVH (minimum 5 µs). 12. Clear the HVEN bit. 13. After time, tRCV (typical 1 µs), the memory can be accessed in read mode again. NOTE The COP register at location $FFFF should not be written between steps 5-12, when the HVEN bit is set. Since this register is located at a valid FLASH address, unpredictable behavior may occur if this location is written while HVEN is set. This program sequence is repeated throughout the memory until all data is programmed. NOTE Programming and erasing of FLASH locations cannot be performed by code being executed from the FLASH memory. While these operations must be performed in the order shown, other unrelated operations may occur between the steps. Do not exceed tPROG maximum, see 19.6 FLASH Memory Characteristics. 1. The time between each FLASH address change, or the time between the last FLASH address programmed to clearing PGM bit, must not exceed the maximum programming time, tPROG maximum. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 41 Memory ALGORITHM FOR PROGRAMMING A ROW (64 BYTES) OF FLASH MEMORY 1 SET PGM BIT 2 READ THE FLASH BLOCK PROTECT REGISTER 3 WRITE ANY DATA TO ANY FLASH ADDRESS WITHIN THE ROW ADDRESS RANGE DESIRED 4 WAIT FOR A TIME, tNVS 5 SET HVEN BIT 6 WAIT FOR A TIME, tPGS 7 WRITE DATA TO THE FLASH ADDRESS TO BE PROGRAMMED 8 WAIT FOR A TIME, tPROG COMPLETED PROGRAMMING THIS ROW? NO YES 10 CLEAR PGM BIT 11 WAIT FOR A TIME, tNVH Note: The time between each FLASH address change (step 7 to step 7), or the time between the last FLASH address programmed to clearing PGM bit (step 7 to step 10) must not exceed the maximum programming time, tPROG max. This row program algorithm assumes the row/s to be programmed are initially erased. 12 CLEAR HVEN BIT 13 WAIT FOR A TIME, tRCV END OF PROGRAMMING Figure 2-4. FLASH Programming Flowchart MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 42 Freescale Semiconductor FLASH Memory (FLASH) 2.8.5 FLASH Block Protection Due to the ability of the on-board charge pump to erase and program the FLASH memory in the target application, provision is made for protecting a block of memory from unintentional erase or program operations due to system malfunction. This protection is done by using a FLASH block protect register (FLBPR). The FLBPR determines the range of the FLASH memory which is to be protected. The range of the protected area starts from a location defined by FLBPR and ends at the bottom of the FLASH memory ($FFFF). When the memory is protected, the HVEN bit cannot be set in either ERASE or PROGRAM operations. NOTE In performing a program or erase operation, the FLASH block protect register must be read after setting the PGM or ERASE bit and before asserting the HVEN bit When the FLBPR is programmed with all 0s, the entire memory is protected from being programmed and erased. When all the bits are erased (all 1s), the entire memory is accessible for program and erase. When bits within the FLBPR are programmed, they lock a block of memory, whose address ranges are shown in 2.8.6 FLASH Block Protect Register. Once the FLBPR is programmed with a value other than $FF, any erase or program of the FLBPR or the protected block of FLASH memory is prohibited. Mass erase is disabled whenever any block is protected (FLBPR does not equal $FF). The FLBPR itself can be erased or programmed only with an external voltage, VTST, present on the IRQ pin. This voltage also allows entry from reset into the monitor mode. 2.8.6 FLASH Block Protect Register The FLASH block protect register (FLBPR) is implemented as a byte within the FLASH memory, and therefore can be written only during a programming sequence of the FLASH memory. The value in this register determines the starting location of the protected range within the FLASH memory. Address: Read: Write: Reset: $FF7E Bit 7 BPR7 0 6 BPR6 0 5 BPR5 0 4 BPR4 0 3 BPR3 0 2 BPR2 0 1 BPR1 0 Bit 0 BPR0 0 U = Unaffected by reset. Initial value from factory is 1. Write to this register by a programming sequence to the FLASH memory. Figure 2-5. FLASH Block Protect Register (FLBPR) BPR[7:0] — FLASH Block Protect Bits These eight bits represent bits [14:7] of a 16-bit memory address. Bit 15 is 1 and bits [6:0] are 0s. The resultant 16-bit address is used for specifying the start address of the FLASH memory for block protection. The FLASH is protected from this start address to the end of FLASH memory at $FFFF. With this mechanism, the protect start address can be XX00 and XX80 (128 bytes page boundaries) within the FLASH memory. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 43 Memory 16-BIT MEMORY ADDRESS START ADDRESS OF FLASH BLOCK PROTECT 1 FLBPR VALUE 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Figure 2-6. FLASH Block Protect Start Address Refer to Table 2-2 for examples of the protect start address. Table 2-2. Examples of Protect Start Address BPR[7:0] $00 $01 (0000 0001) $02 (0000 0010) $FE (1111 1110) $FF Start of Address of Protect Range The entire FLASH memory is protected. $8080 (1000 0000 1000 0000) $8100 (1000 0001 0000 0000) and so on... $FF00 (1111 1111 0000 0000) The entire FLASH memory is not protected. Note: The end address of the protected range is always $FFFF. 2.8.7 Wait Mode Putting the MCU into wait mode while the FLASH is in read mode does not affect the operation of the FLASH memory directly, but there will not be any memory activity since the CPU is inactive. The WAIT instruction should not be executed while performing a program or erase operation on the FLASH. Otherwise, the operation will discontinue, and the FLASH will be on standby mode. 2.8.8 Stop Mode Putting the MCU into stop mode while the FLASH is in read mode does not affect the operation of the FLASH memory directly, but there will not be any memory activity since the CPU is inactive. The STOP instruction should not be executed while performing a program or erase operation on the FLASH, otherwise the operation will discontinue, and the FLASH will be on standby mode NOTE Standby mode is the power-saving mode of the FLASH module in which all internal control signals to the FLASH are inactive and the current consumption of the FLASH is at a minimum. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 44 Freescale Semiconductor Chapter 3 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) 3.1 Introduction This section describes the 10-bit analog-to-digital converter (ADC). 3.2 Features Features of the ADC module include: • 10 channels with multiplexed input • Linear successive approximation • 10-bit resolution, 8-bit accuracy • Single or continuous conversion • Conversion complete flag or conversion complete interrupt • Selectable ADC clock • Left or right justified result • Left justified sign data mode • High impedance buffered ADC input 3.3 Functional Description Ten ADC channels are available for sampling external sources at pins PTC1/ATD9:PTC0/ATD8 and PTB7/ATD7:PTB0/ATD0. To achieve the best possible accuracy, these pins are implemented as input-only pins when the analog-to-digital (A/D) feature is enabled. An analog multiplexer allows the single ADC to select one of the 10 ADC channels as ADC voltage IN (ADCVIN). ADCVIN is converted by the successive approximation algorithm. When the conversion is completed, the ADC places the result in the ADC data register (ADRH and ADRL) and sets a flag or generates an interrupt. See Figure 3-2. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 45 DDRA PTA DDRB USER FLASH — 32,256 BYTES TIMER INTERFACE MODULE A USER RAM — 768 BYTES TIMER INTERFACE MODULE B PTB DDRC USER FLASH VECTOR SPACE — 46 BYTES OSC1 OSC2 CGMXFC SERIAL COMMUNICATIONS INTERFACE MODULE PTC RST SYSTEM INTEGRATION MODULE IRQ MODULE ANALOG-TO-DIGITAL CONVERTER MODULE POWER-ON RESET MODULE PTD DDRE VSS VDD VDDAD VSSAD PTF0/SPSCK(1) POWER Notes: 1. These pins are not available in the 56-pin SDIP package. 2. This module is not available in the 56-pin SDIP package. 3. In the 56-pin SDIP package, these pins are bonded together. Figure 3-1. Block Diagram Highlighting ADC Block and Pins DDRF PTF PWMGND PWM6–PWM1 PULSE-WIDTH MODULATOR MODULE PTF5/TxD PTF4/RxD PTF3/MISO(1) PTF2/MOSI(1) PTF1/SS(1) PTE 46 INTERNAL BUS M68HC08 CPU CPU REGISTERS ARITHMETIC/LOGIC UNIT PTA7–PTA0 PTB7/ATD7 PTB6/ATD6 PTB5/ATD5 PTB4/ATD4 PTB3/ATD3 PTB2/ATD2 PTB1/ATD1 PTB0/ATD0 PTC6 PTC5 PTC4 PTC3 PTC2 PTC1/ATD9(1) PTC0/ATD8 PTD6/IS3 PTD5/IS2 PTD4/IS1 PTD3/FAULT4 PTD2/FAULT3 PTD1/FAULT2 PTD0/FAULT1 PTE7/TCH3A PTE6/TCH2A PTE5/TCH1A PTE4/TCH0A PTE3/TCLKA PTE2/TCH1B(1) PTE1/TCH0B(1) PTE0/TCLKB(1) LOW-VOLTAGE INHIBIT MODULE CONTROL AND STATUS REGISTERS — 112 BYTES COMPUTER OPERATING PROPERLY MODULE Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor MONITOR ROM — 240 BYTES CLOCK GENERATOR MODULE SERIAL PERIPHERAL INTERFACE MODULE(2) IRQ VDDA VSSA(3) VREFL(3) VREFH SINGLE BREAK MODULE Functional Description INTERNAL DATA BUS PTB/Cx ADC CHANNEL x READ PTB/PTC DISABLE ADC DATA REGISTERS INTERRUPT LOGIC CONVERSION COMPLETE ADC ADC VOLTAGE IN ADVIN CHANNEL SELECT ADCH[4:0] AIEN COCO ADC CLOCK CGMXCLK BUS CLOCK CLOCK GENERATOR ADIV[2:0] ADICLK Figure 3-2. ADC Block Diagram 3.3.1 ADC Port I/O Pins PTC1/ATD9:PTC0/ATD8 and PTB7/ATD7:PTB0/ATD0 are general-purpose I/O pins that are shared with the ADC channels. The channel select bits define which ADC channel/port pin will be used as the input signal. The ADC overrides the port logic when that port is selected by the ADC multiplexer. The remaining ADC channels/port pins are controlled by the port logic and can be used as general-purpose input/output (I/O) pins. Writes to the port register or DDR will not have any effect on the port pin that is selected by the ADC. Read of a port pin which is in use by the ADC will return a 0. 3.3.2 Voltage Conversion When the input voltage to the ADC equals VREFH, the ADC converts the signal to $3FF (full scale). If the input voltage equals VREFL, the ADC converts it to $000. Input voltages between VREFH and VREFL are straight-line linear conversions. All other input voltages will result in $3FF if greater than VREFH and $000 if less than VREFL. NOTE Input voltage should not exceed the analog supply voltages. See 19.13 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) Characteristics. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 47 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) 3.3.3 Conversion Time Conversion starts after a write to the ADSCR. A conversion is between 16 and 17 ADC clock cycles, therefore: 16 to17 ADC Cycles Conversion time = ADC Frequency Number of Bus Cycles = Conversion Time x CPU Bus Frequency The ADC conversion time is determined by the clock source chosen and the divide ratio selected. The clock source is either the bus clock or CGMXCLK and is selectable by ADICLK located in the ADC clock register. For example, if CGMXCLK is 4 MHz and is selected as the ADC input clock source, the ADC input clock divide-by-4 prescale is selected and the CPU bus frequency is 8 MHz: Conversion Time = 16 to 17 ADC Cycles = 16 to 17 µs 4 MHz/4 Number of bus cycles = 16 µs x 8 MHz = 128 to 136 cycles NOTE The ADC frequency must be between fADIC minimum and fADIC maximum to meet A/D specifications. See 19.13 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) Characteristics. Since an ADC cycle may be comprised of several bus cycles (eight, 136 minus 128, in the previous example) and the start of a conversion is initiated by a bus cycle write to the ADSCR, from zero to eight additional bus cycles may occur before the start of the initial ADC cycle. This results in a fractional ADC cycle and is represented as the 17th cycle. 3.3.4 Continuous Conversion In continuous conversion mode, the ADC data registers ADRH and ADRL will be filled with new data after each conversion. Data from the previous conversion will be overwritten whether that data has been read or not. Conversions will continue until the ADCO bit is cleared. The COCO bit is set after each conversion and will stay set until the next read of the ADC data register. When a conversion is in process and the ADSCR is written, the current conversion data should be discarded to prevent an incorrect reading. 3.3.5 Result Justification The conversion result may be formatted in four different ways: 1. Left justified 2. Right justified 3. Left Justified sign data mode 4. 8-bit truncation mode All four of these modes are controlled using MODE0 and MODE1 bits located in the ADC clock register (ADCR). Left justification will place the eight most significant bits (MSB) in the corresponding ADC data register high, ADRH. This may be useful if the result is to be treated as an 8-bit result where the two least MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 48 Freescale Semiconductor Functional Description significant bits (LSB), located in the ADC data register low, ADRL, can be ignored. However, ADRL must be read after ADRH or else the interlocking will prevent all new conversions from being stored. Right justification will place only the two MSBs in the corresponding ADC data register high, ADRH, and the eight LSBs in ADC data register low, ADRL. This mode of operation typically is used when a 10-bit unsigned result is desired. Left justified sign data mode is similar to left justified mode with one exception. The MSB of the 10-bit result, AD9 located in ADRH, is complemented. This mode of operation is useful when a result, represented as a signed magnitude from mid-scale, is needed. Finally, 8-bit truncation mode will place the eight MSBs in ADC data register low, ADRL. The two LSBs are dropped. This mode of operation is used when compatibility with 8-bit ADC designs are required. No interlocking between ADRH and ADRL is present. NOTE Quantization error is affected when only the most significant eight bits are used as a result. See Figure 3-3. 8-BIT 10-BIT RESULT RESULT 003 00B 00A 009 002 008 007 006 005 001 004 003 002 001 000 000 1/2 1 1/2 1/2 2 1/2 3 1/2 4 1/2 5 1/2 1 1/2 6 1/2 7 1/2 8 1/2 9 1/2 2 1/2 INPUT VOLTAGE REPRESENTED AS 10-BIT INPUT VOLTAGE REPRESENTED AS 8-BIT WHEN TRUNCATION IS USED, ERROR FROM IDEAL 8-BIT = 3/8 LSB DUE TO NON-IDEAL QUANTIZATION. IDEAL 10-BIT CHARACTERISTIC WITH QUANTIZATION = ±1/2 IDEAL 8-BIT CHARACTERISTIC WITH QUANTIZATION = ±1/2 10-BIT TRUNCATED TO 8-BIT RESULT Figure 3-3. 8-Bit Truncation Mode Error 3.3.6 Monotonicity The conversion process is monotonic and has no missing codes. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 49 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) 3.4 Interrupts When the AIEN bit is set, the ADC module is capable of generating a CPU interrupt after each ADC conversion. A CPU interrupt is generated if the COCO bit is at 0. The COCO bit is not used as a conversion complete flag when interrupts are enabled. 3.5 Wait Mode The WAIT instruction can put the MCU in low power-consumption standby mode. The ADC continues normal operation during wait mode. Any enabled CPU interrupt request from the ADC can bring the MCU out of wait mode. If the ADC is not required to bring the MCU out of wait mode, power down the ADC by setting ADCH[4:0] in the ADC status and control register before executing the WAIT instruction. 3.6 I/O Signals The ADC module has 10 input signals that are shared with port B and port C. 3.6.1 ADC Analog Power Pin (VDDAD) The ADC analog portion uses VDDAD as its power pin. Connect the VDDAD pin to the same voltage potential as VDD. External filtering may be necessary to ensure clean VDDAD for good results. NOTE Route VDDAD carefully for maximum noise immunity and place bypass capacitors as close as possible to the package. 3.6.2 ADC Analog Ground Pin (VSSAD) The ADC analog portion uses VSSAD as its ground pin. Connect the VSSAD pin to the same voltage potential as VSS. 3.6.3 ADC Voltage Reference Pin (VREFH) VREFH is the power supply for setting the reference voltage VREFH. Connect the VREFH pin to the same voltage potential as VDDAD. There will be a finite current associated with VREFH. See Chapter 19 Electrical Specifications. NOTE Route VREFH carefully for maximum noise immunity and place bypass capacitors as close as possible to the package. 3.6.4 ADC Voltage Reference Low Pin (VREFL) VREFL is the lower reference supply for the ADC. Connect the VREFL pin to the same voltage potential as VSSAD. A finite current will be associated with VREFL. See Chapter 19 Electrical Specifications. NOTE In the 56-pin shrink dual in-line package (SDIP), VREFL and VSSAD are tied together. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 50 Freescale Semiconductor I/O Registers 3.6.5 ADC Voltage In (ADVIN) ADVIN is the input voltage signal from one of the 10 ADC channels to the ADC module. 3.6.6 ADC External Connections This section describes the ADC external connections: VREFH and VREFL, ANx, and grounding. 3.6.6.1 VREFH and VREFL Both ac and dc current are drawn through the VREFH and VREFL loop. The AC current is in the form of current spikes required to supply charge to the capacitor array at each successive approximation step. The current flows through the internal resistor string. The best external component to meet both these current demands is a capacitor in the 0.01 µF to 1 µF range with good high frequency characteristics. This capacitor is connected between VREFH and VREFL and must be placed as close as possible to the package pins. Resistance in the path is not recommended because the dc current will cause a voltage drop which could result in conversion errors. 3.6.6.2 ANx Empirical data shows that capacitors from the analog inputs to VREFL improve ADC performance. 0.01-µF and 0.1-µF capacitors with good high-frequency characteristics are sufficient. These capacitors must be placed as close as possible to the package pins. 3.6.6.3 Grounding In cases where separate power supplies are used for analog and digital power, the ground connection between these supplies should be at the VSSAD pin. This should be the only ground connection between these supplies if possible. The VSSA pin makes a good single point ground location. Connect the VREFL pin to the same potential as VSSAD at the single point ground location. 3.7 I/O Registers These I/O registers control and monitor operation of the ADC: • ADC status and control register, ADSCR • ADC data registers, ADRH and ARDL • ADC clock register, ADCLK MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 51 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) 3.7.1 ADC Status and Control Register This section describes the function of the ADC status and control register (ADSCR). Writing ADSCR aborts the current conversion and initiates a new conversion. Address: $0040 Bit 7 Read: Write: Reset: COCO R 0 R 6 AIEN 0 = Reserved 5 ADCO 0 4 ADCH4 1 3 ADCH3 1 2 ADCH2 1 1 ADCH1 1 Bit 0 ADCH0 1 Figure 3-4. ADC Status and Control Register (ADSCR) COCO — Conversions Complete Bit In non-interrupt mode (AIEN = 0), COCO is a read-only bit that is set at the end of each conversion. COCO will stay set until cleared by a read of the ADC data register. Reset clears this bit. In interrupt mode (AIEN = 1), COCO is a read-only bit that is not set at the end of a conversion. It always reads as a 0. 1 = Conversion completed (AIEN = 0) 0 = Conversion not completed (AIEN = 0) or CPU interrupt enabled (AIEN = 1) NOTE The write function of the COCO bit is reserved. When writing to the ADSCR register, always have a 0 in the COCO bit position. AIEN — ADC Interrupt Enable Bit When this bit is set, an interrupt is generated at the end of an ADC conversion. The interrupt signal is cleared when the data register is read or the status/control register is written. Reset clears the AIEN bit. 1 = ADC interrupt enabled 0 = ADC interrupt disabled ADCO — ADC Continuous Conversion Bit When set, the ADC will convert samples continuously and update the ADR register at the end of each conversion. Only one conversion is allowed when this bit is cleared. Reset clears the ADCO bit. 1 = Continuous ADC conversion 0 = One ADC conversion ADCH[4:0] — ADC Channel Select Bits ADCH4, ADCH3, ADCH2, ADCH1, and ADCH0 form a 5-bit field which is used to select one of 10 ADC channels. The ADC channels are detailed in Table 3-1. NOTE Take care to prevent switching noise from corrupting the analog signal when simultaneously using a port pin as both an analog and digital input. The ADC subsystem is turned off when the channel select bits are all set to 1. This feature allows for reduced power consumption for the MCU when the ADC is not used. NOTE Recovery from the disabled state requires one conversion cycle to stabilize. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 52 Freescale Semiconductor I/O Registers The voltage levels supplied from internal reference nodes as specified in Table 3-1 are used to verify the operation of the ADC both in production test and for user applications. Table 3-1. Mux Channel Select ADCH4 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 ADCH3 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 ADCH2 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 ADCH1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 ADCH0 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 0 1 0 1 0 1 Input Select PTB0/ATD0 PTB1/ATD1 PTB2/ATD2 PTB3/ATD3 PTB4/ATD4 PTB5/ATD5 PTB6/ATD6 PTB7/ATD7 PTC0/ATD8 PTC1/ATD9(1) Unused(2) Ø Ø Ø Ø Ø Ø Unused(2) Reserved(3) Unused(2) VREFH VREFL ADC power off 1. ATD9 is not available in the 56-pin SDIP package. 2. Used for factory testing. 3. If any unused channels are selected, the resulting ADC conversion will be unknown. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 53 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) 3.7.2 ADC Data Register High In left justified mode, this 8-bit result register holds the eight MSBs of the 10-bit result. This register is updated each time an ADC single channel conversion completes. Reading ADRH latches the contents of ADRL until ADRL is read. Until ADRL is read, all subsequent ADC results will be lost. Address: Read: Write: Reset: R = Reserved $0041 Bit 7 AD9 R 6 AD8 R 5 AD7 R 4 AD6 R 3 AD5 R 2 AD4 R 1 AD3 R Bit 0 AD2 R Unaffected by reset Figure 3-5. ADC Data Register High (ADRH) Left Justified Mode In right justified mode, this 8-bit result register holds the two MSBs of the 10-bit result. All other bits read as 0. This register is updated each time a single channel ADC conversion completes. Reading ADRH latches the contents of ADRL until ADRL is read. Until ADRL is read, all subsequent ADC results will be lost. Address: Read: Write: Reset: R = Reserved $0041 Bit 7 0 R 6 0 R 5 0 R 4 0 R 3 0 R 2 0 R 1 AD9 R Bit 0 AD8 R Unaffected by reset Figure 3-6. ADC Data Register High (ADRH) Right Justified Mode 3.7.3 ADC Data Register Low In left justified mode, this 8-bit result register holds the two LSBs of the 10-bit result. All other bits read as 0. This register is updated each time a single channel ADC conversion completes. Reading ADRH latches the contents of ADRL until ADRL is read. Until ADRL is read, all subsequent ADC results will be lost. Address: Read: Write: Reset: R = Reserved $0042 Bit 7 AD1 R 6 AD0 R 5 0 R 4 0 R 3 0 R 2 0 R 1 0 R Bit 0 0 R Unaffected by reset Figure 3-7. ADC Data Register Low (ADRL) Left Justified Mode In right justified mode, this 8-bit result register holds the eight LSBs of the 10-bit result. This register is updated each time an ADC conversion completes. Reading ADRH latches the contents of ADRL until ADRL is read. Until ADRL is read, all subsequent ADC results will be lost. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 54 Freescale Semiconductor I/O Registers Address: Read: Write: Reset: $0042 Bit 7 AD7 R R 6 AD6 R = Reserved 5 AD5 R 4 AD4 R 3 AD3 R 2 AD2 R 1 AD1 R Bit 0 AD0 R Unaffected by reset Figure 3-8. ADC Data Register Low (ADRL) Right Justified Mode In 8-bit mode, this 8-bit result register holds the eight MSBs of the 10-bit result. This register is updated each time an ADC conversion completes. In 8-bit mode, this register contains no interlocking with ADRH. Address: Read: Write: Reset: R = Reserved $0042 Bit 7 AD9 R 6 AD8 R 5 AD7 R 4 AD6 R 3 AD5 R 2 AD4 R 1 AD3 R Bit 0 AD2 R Unaffected by reset Figure 3-9. ADC Data Register Low (ADRL) 8-Bit Mode 3.7.4 ADC Clock Register This register selects the clock frequency for the ADC, selecting between modes of operation. Address: Read: Write: Reset: $0043 Bit 7 ADIV2 0 R 6 ADIV1 0 = Reserved 5 ADIV0 0 4 ADICLK 0 3 MODE1 0 2 MODE0 1 1 0 0 Bit 0 0 R 0 Figure 3-10. ADC Clock Register (ADCLK) ADIV2:ADIV0 — ADC Clock Prescaler Bits ADIV2, ADIV1, and ADIV0 form a 3-bit field which selects the divide ratio used by the ADC to generate the internal ADC clock. Table 3-2 shows the available clock configurations. Table 3-2. ADC Clock Divide Ratio ADIV2 0 0 0 0 1 X = don’t care ADIV1 0 0 1 1 X ADIV0 0 1 0 1 X ADC Clock Rate ADC input clock ÷ 1 ADC input clock ÷ 2 ADC input clock ÷ 4 ADC input clock ÷ 8 ADC input clock ÷ 16 MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 55 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) ADICLK — ADC Input Clock Select Bit ADICLK selects either bus clock or CGMXCLK as the input clock source to generate the internal ADC clock. Reset selects CGMXCLK as the ADC clock source. If the external clock (CGMXCLK) is equal to or greater than 1 MHz, CGMXCLK can be used as the clock source for the ADC. If CGMXCLK is less than 1 MHz, use the PLL-generated bus clock as the clock source. As long as the internal ADC clock is at fADIC, correct operation can be guaranteed. See 19.13 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) Characteristics. 1 = Internal bus clock 0 = External clock, CGMXCLK CGMXCLK or bus frequency fADIC = ADIV[2:0] MODE1:MODE0 — Modes of Result Justification Bits MODE1:MODE0 selects among four modes of operation. The manner in which the ADC conversion results will be placed in the ADC data registers is controlled by these modes of operation. Reset returns right-justified mode. 00 = 8-bit truncation mode 01 = Right justified mode 10 = Left justified mode 11 = Left justified sign data mode MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 56 Freescale Semiconductor Chapter 4 Clock Generator Module (CGM) 4.1 Introduction This section describes the clock generator module (CGM, version A). The CGM generates the crystal clock signal, CGMXCLK, which operates at the frequency of the crystal. The CGM also generates the base clock signal, CGMOUT, from which the system integration module (SIM) derives the system clocks. CGMOUT is based on either the crystal clock divided by two or the phase-locked loop (PLL) clock, CGMVCLK, divided by two. The PLL is a frequency generator designed for use with crystals or ceramic resonators. The PLL can generate an 8-MHz bus frequency without using a 32-MHz external clock. 4.2 Features Features of the CGM include: • PLL with output frequency in integer multiples of the crystal reference • Programmable hardware voltage-controlled oscillator (VCO) for low-jitter operation • Automatic bandwidth control mode for low-jitter operation • Automatic frequency lock detector • Central processor unit (CPU) interrupt on entry or exit from locked condition 4.3 Functional Description The CGM consists of three major submodules: 1. Crystal oscillator circuit — The crystal oscillator circuit generates the constant crystal frequency clock, CGMXCLK. 2. Phase-locked loop (PLL) — The PLL generates the programmable VCO frequency clock, CGMVCLK. 3. Base clock selector circuit — This software-controlled circuit selects either CGMXCLK divided by two or the VCO clock, CGMVCLK, divided by two as the base clock, CGMOUT. The SIM derives the system clocks from CGMOUT. Figure 4-1 shows the structure of the CGM. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 57 Clock Generator Module (CGM) CRYSTAL OSCILLATOR OSC2 CGMXCLK OSC1 CLOCK SELECT CIRCUIT A B S* CGMOUT TO SIM TO SIM ÷2 SIMOSCEN CGMRDV CGMRCLK BCS *WHEN S = 1, CGMOUT = B VDDA CGMXFC VSS VRS[7:4] USER MODE PTC2 MONITOR MODE PHASE DETECTOR LOOP FILTER PLL ANALOG VOLTAGE CONTROLLED OSCILLATOR LOCK DETECTOR BANDWIDTH CONTROL INTERRUPT CONTROL CGMINT LOCK AUTO ACQ PLLIE PLLF MUL[7:4] CGMVDV FREQUENCY DIVIDER CGMVCLK Figure 4-1. CGM Block Diagram Addr. $005C Register Name PLL Control Register Read: (PCTL) Write: See page 66. Reset: PLL Bandwidth Control Register Read: (PBWC) Write: See page 67. Reset: PLL Programming Register Read: (PPG) Write: See page 68. Reset: Bit 7 PLLIE 0 AUTO 0 MUL7 0 R 6 PLLF R 0 LOCK R 0 MUL6 1 = Reserved 5 PLLON 1 ACQ 0 MUL5 1 4 BCS 0 XLD 0 MUL4 0 3 1 R 1 0 R 0 VRS7 0 2 1 R 1 0 R 0 VRS6 1 1 1 R 1 0 R 0 VRS5 1 Bit 0 1 R 1 0 R 0 VRS4 0 $005D $005E Figure 4-2. CGM I/O Register Summary MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 58 Freescale Semiconductor Functional Description 4.3.1 Crystal Oscillator Circuit The crystal oscillator circuit consists of an inverting amplifier and an external crystal. The OSC1 pin is the input to the amplifier and the OSC2 pin is the output. The SIMOSCEN signal from the system integration module (SIM) enables the crystal oscillator circuit. The CGMXCLK signal is the output of the crystal oscillator circuit and runs at a rate equal to the crystal frequency. CGMXCLK is then buffered to produce CGMRCLK, the PLL reference clock. CGMXCLK can be used by other modules which require precise timing for operation. The duty cycle of CGMXCLK is not guaranteed to be 50 percent and depends on external factors, including the crystal and related external components. An externally generated clock also can feed the OSC1 pin of the crystal oscillator circuit. Connect the external clock to the OSC1 pin and let the OSC2 pin float. 4.3.2 Phase-Locked Loop Circuit (PLL) The PLL is a frequency generator that can operate in either acquisition mode or tracking mode, depending on the accuracy of the output frequency. The PLL can change between acquisition and tracking modes either automatically or manually. 4.3.2.1 PLL Circuits The PLL consists of these circuits: • Voltage-controlled oscillator (VCO) • Modulo VCO frequency divider • Phase detector • Loop filter • Lock detector The operating range of the VCO is programmable for a wide range of frequencies and for maximum immunity to external noise, including supply and CGMXFC noise. The VCO frequency is bound to a range from roughly one-half to twice the center-of-range frequency, fVRS. Modulating the voltage on the CGMXFC pin changes the frequency within this range. By design, fVRS is equal to the nominal center-of-range frequency, fNOM, (4.9152 MHz) times a linear factor, L or (L) fNOM. CGMRCLK is the PLL reference clock, a buffered version of CGMXCLK. CGMRCLK runs at a frequency, fRCLK, and is fed to the PLL through a buffer. The buffer output is the final reference clock, CGMRDV, running at a frequency, fRDV = fRCLK. The VCO’s output clock, CGMVCLK, running at a frequency, fVCLK, is fed back through a programmable modulo divider. The modulo divider reduces the VCO clock by a factor, N. The divider’s output is the VCO feedback clock, CGMVDV, running at a frequency, fVDV = fVCLK/N. (See 4.3.2.4 Programming the PLL for more information.) The phase detector then compares the VCO feedback clock, CGMVDV, with the final reference clock, CGMRDV. A correction pulse is generated based on the phase difference between the two signals. The loop filter then slightly alters the dc voltage on the external capacitor connected to CGMXFC based on the width and direction of the correction pulse. The filter can make fast or slow corrections depending on its mode, described in 4.3.2.2 Acquisition and Tracking Modes. The value of the external capacitor and the reference frequency determines the speed of the corrections and the stability of the PLL. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 59 Clock Generator Module (CGM) The lock detector compares the frequencies of the VCO feedback clock, CGMVDV, and the final reference clock, CGMRDV. Therefore, the speed of the lock detector is directly proportional to the final reference frequency, fRDV. The circuit determines the mode of the PLL and the lock condition based on this comparison. 4.3.2.2 Acquisition and Tracking Modes The PLL filter is manually or automatically configurable into one of two operating modes: 1. Acquisition mode — In acquisition mode, the filter can make large frequency corrections to the VCO. This mode is used at PLL startup or when the PLL has suffered a severe noise hit and the VCO frequency is far off the desired frequency. When in acquisition mode, the ACQ bit is clear in the PLL bandwidth control register. See 4.5.2 PLL Bandwidth Control Register. 2. Tracking mode — In tracking mode, the filter makes only small corrections to the frequency of the VCO. PLL jitter is much lower in tracking mode, but the response to noise is also slower. The PLL enters tracking mode when the VCO frequency is nearly correct, such as when the PLL is selected as the base clock source. See 4.3.3 Base Clock Selector Circuit. The PLL is automatically in tracking mode when not in acquisition mode or when the ACQ bit is set. 4.3.2.3 Manual and Automatic PLL Bandwidth Modes The PLL can change the bandwidth or operational mode of the loop filter manually or automatically. In automatic bandwidth control mode (AUTO = 1), the lock detector automatically switches between acquisition and tracking modes. Automatic bandwidth control mode also is used to determine when the VCO clock, CGMVCLK, is safe to use as the source for the base clock, CGMOUT. See 4.5.2 PLL Bandwidth Control Register. If PLL interrupts are enabled, the software can wait for a PLL interrupt request and then check the LOCK bit. If interrupts are disabled, software can poll the LOCK bit continuously (during PLL startup, usually) or at periodic intervals. In either case, when the LOCK bit is set, the VCO clock is safe to use as the source for the base clock. See 4.3.3 Base Clock Selector Circuit. If the VCO is selected as the source for the base clock and the LOCK bit is clear, the PLL has suffered a severe noise hit and the software must take appropriate action, depending on the application. See 4.6 Interrupts for information and precautions on using interrupts. These conditions apply when the PLL is in automatic bandwidth control mode: • The ACQ bit (see 4.5.2 PLL Bandwidth Control Register) is a read-only indicator of the mode of the filter. For more information, see 4.3.2.2 Acquisition and Tracking Modes. • The ACQ bit is set when the VCO frequency is within a certain tolerance, ∆TRK, and is cleared when the VCO frequency is out of a certain tolerance, ∆UNT. For more information, see 4.8 Acquisition/Lock Time Specifications. • The LOCK bit is a read-only indicator of the locked state of the PLL. • The LOCK bit is set when the VCO frequency is within a certain tolerance, ∆Lock, and is cleared when the VCO frequency is out of a certain tolerance, ∆UNL. For more information, see 4.8 Acquisition/Lock Time Specifications. • CPU interrupts can occur if enabled (PLLIE = 1) when the PLL’s lock condition changes, toggling the LOCK bit. For more information, see 4.5.1 PLL Control Register. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 60 Freescale Semiconductor Functional Description The PLL also may operate in manual mode (AUTO = 0). Manual mode is used by systems that do not require an indicator of the lock condition for proper operation. Such systems typically operate well below fBUSMAX and require fast startup. These conditions apply when in manual mode: • ACQ is a writable control bit that controls the mode of the filter. Before turning on the PLL in manual mode, the ACQ bit must be clear. • Before entering tracking mode (ACQ = 1), software must wait a given time, tACQ (see 4.8 Acquisition/Lock Time Specifications), after turning on the PLL by setting PLLON in the PLL control register (PCTL). • Software must wait a given time, tAL, after entering tracking mode before selecting the PLL as the clock source to CGMOUT (BCS = 1). • The LOCK bit is disabled. • CPU interrupts from the CGM are disabled. 4.3.2.4 Programming the PLL Use this 9-step procedure to program the PLL. Table 4-1 lists the variables used and their meaning. Table 4-1. Variable Definitions Variable fBUSDES fVCLKDES fRCLK fVCLK fBUS fNOM fVRS Definition Desired bus clock frequency Desired VCO clock frequency Chosen reference crystal frequency Calculated VCO clock frequency Calculated bus clock frequency Nominal VCO center frequency Shifted FCO center frequency 1. Choose the desired bus frequency, fBUSDES. Example: fBUSDES = 8 MHz 2. Calculate the desired VCO frequency, fVCLKDES. fVCLKDES = 4 x fBUSDES Example: fVCLKDES = 4 x 8 MHz = 32 MHz 3. Using a reference frequency, fRCLK, equal to the crystal frequency, calculate the VCO frequency multiplier, N. Round the result to the nearest integer. fVCLKDES N= fRCLK Example: N = 32 MHz = 8 MHz 4 MHz 4. Calculate the VCO frequency, fVCLK. fVCLK = N x fRCLK Example: fVCLK = 8 x 4 MHz = 32 MHz MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 61 Clock Generator Module (CGM) 5. Calculate the bus frequency, fBUS, and compare fBUS with fBUSDES. fBUS = Example: N = fVCLK 4 32 MHz = 8 MHz 4 MHz 6. If the calculated fBUS is not within the tolerance limits of the application, select another fBUSDES or another fRCLK. 7. Using the value 4.9152 MHz for fNOM, calculate the VCO linear range multiplier, L. The linear range multiplier controls the frequency range of the PLL. fVCLK ) L = round ( f NOM Example: L = 32 MHz = 7 MHz 4.9152 MHz 8. Calculate the VCO center-of-range frequency, fVRS. The center-or-range frequency is the midpoint between the minimum and maximum frequencies attainable by the PLL. fVRS = L x fNOM Example: fVRS = 7 x 4.9152 MHz = 34.4 MHz For proper operation, fNOM fVRS – fVCLK | ≤ 2 CAUTION Exceeding the recommended maximum bus frequency or VCO frequency can crash the MCU. 9. Program the PLL registers accordingly: a. In the upper four bits of the PLL programming register (PPG), program the binary equivalent of N. b. In the lower four bits of the PLL programming register (PPG), program the binary equivalent of L. 4.3.2.5 Special Programming Exceptions The programming method described in 4.3.2.4 Programming the PLL does not account for possible exceptions. A value of 0 for N or L is meaningless when used in the equations given. To account for these exceptions: • A 0 value for N is interpreted exactly the same as a value of 1. • A 0 value for L disables the PLL and prevents its selection as the source for the base clock. See 4.3.3 Base Clock Selector Circuit. 4.3.3 Base Clock Selector Circuit This circuit is used to select either the crystal clock, CGMXCLK, or the VCO clock, CGMVCLK, as the source of the base clock, CGMOUT. The two input clocks go through a transition control circuit that waits up to three CGMXCLK cycles and three CGMVCLK cycles to change from one clock source to the other. During this time, CGMOUT is held in stasis. The output of the transition control circuit is then divided by MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 62 Freescale Semiconductor Functional Description two to correct the duty cycle. Therefore, the bus clock frequency, which is one-half of the base clock frequency, is one-fourth the frequency of the selected clock (CGMXCLK or CGMVCLK). The BCS bit in the PLL control register (PCTL) selects which clock drives CGMOUT. The VCO clock cannot be selected as the base clock source if the PLL is not turned on. The PLL cannot be turned off if the VCO clock is selected. The PLL cannot be turned on or off simultaneously with the selection or deselection of the VCO clock. The VCO clock also cannot be selected as the base clock source if the factor L is programmed to a 0. This value would set up a condition inconsistent with the operation of the PLL, so that the PLL would be disabled and the crystal clock would be forced as the source of the base clock. 4.3.4 CGM External Connections In its typical configuration, the CGM requires seven external components. Five of these are for the crystal oscillator and two are for the PLL. The crystal oscillator is normally connected in a Pierce oscillator configuration, as shown in Figure 4-3. Figure 4-3 shows only the logical representation of the internal components and may not represent actual circuitry. SIMOSCEN CGMXCLK OSC1 OSC2 VSS CGMXFC CF VDDA VDD CBYP R S* RB X1 *RS can be 0 (shorted) when used with higher frequency crystals. Refer to manufacturer’s data. C1 C2 Figure 4-3. CGM External Connections The oscillator configuration uses five components: 1. Crystal, X1 2. Fixed capacitor, C1 3. Tuning capacitor, C2 (can also be a fixed capacitor) 4. Feedback resistor, RB 5. Series resistor, RS (optional) The series resistor (RS) is included in the diagram to follow strict Pierce oscillator guidelines and may not be required for all ranges of operation, especially with high-frequency crystals. Refer to the crystal manufacturer’s data for more information. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 63 Clock Generator Module (CGM) Figure 4-3 also shows the external components for the PLL: • Bypass capacitor, CBYP • Filter capacitor, CF NOTE Routing should be done with great care to minimize signal cross talk and noise. (See 4.8 Acquisition/Lock Time Specifications for routing information and more information on the filter capacitor’s value and its effects on PLL performance.) 4.4 I/O Signals This section describes the CGM input/output (I/O) signals. 4.4.1 Crystal Amplifier Input Pin (OSC1) The OSC1 pin is an input to the crystal oscillator amplifier. 4.4.2 Crystal Amplifier Output Pin (OSC2) The OSC2 pin is the output of the crystal oscillator inverting amplifier. 4.4.3 External Filter Capacitor Pin (CGMXFC) The CGMXFC pin is required by the loop filter to filter out phase corrections. A small external capacitor is connected to this pin. NOTE To prevent noise problems, CF should be placed as close to the CGMXFC pin as possible, with minimum routing distances and no routing of other signals across the CF connection. 4.4.4 PLL Analog Power Pin (VDDA) VDDA is a power pin used by the analog portions of the PLL. Connect the VDDA pin to the same voltage potential as the VDD pin. NOTE Route VDDA carefully for maximum noise immunity and place bypass capacitors as close as possible to the package. 4.4.5 Oscillator Enable Signal (SIMOSCEN) The SIMOSCEN signal comes from the system integration module (SIM) and enables the oscillator and PLL. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 64 Freescale Semiconductor CGM Registers 4.4.6 Crystal Output Frequency Signal (CGMXCLK) CGMXCLK is the crystal oscillator output signal. It runs at the full speed of the crystal (fXCLK) and comes directly from the crystal oscillator circuit. Figure 4-3 shows only the logical relation of CGMXCLK to OSC1 and OSC2 and may not represent the actual circuitry. The duty cycle of CGMXCLK is unknown and may depend on the crystal and other external factors. Also, the frequency and amplitude of CGMXCLK can be unstable at startup. 4.4.7 CGM Base Clock Output (CGMOUT) CGMOUT is the clock output of the CGM. This signal goes to the SIM, which generates the MCU clocks. CGMOUT is a 50 percent duty cycle clock running at twice the bus frequency. CGMOUT is software programmable to be either the oscillator output, CGMXCLK, divided by two or the VCO clock, CGMVCLK, divided by two. 4.4.8 CGM CPU Interrupt (CGMINT) CGMINT is the interrupt signal generated by the PLL lock detector. 4.5 CGM Registers These registers control and monitor operation of the CGM: • PLL control register (PCTL) — see 4.5.1 PLL Control Register • PLL bandwidth control register (PBWC) — see 4.5.2 PLL Bandwidth Control Register • PLL programming register (PPG) — see 4.5.3 PLL Programming Register Figure 4-4 is a summary of the CGM registers. Addr. Register Name PLL Control Register (PCTL) See page 66. PLL Bandwidth Control Register (PBWC) See page 67. PLL Programming Register (PPG) See page 68. Read: PLLIE Write: Reset: Read: AUTO Write: Reset: Read: MUL7 Write: Reset: 0 R 1 = Reserved 1 0 0 1 1 0 MUL6 MUL5 MUL4 VRS7 VRS6 VRS5 VRS4 0 R 0 0 0 0 R 0 LOCK ACQ XLD R 0 R 0 R 0 R 0 1 0 Bit 7 6 PLLF PLLON BCS R 1 0 R 1 0 R 1 0 R 1 0 5 4 3 1 2 1 1 1 Bit 0 1 $005C $005D $005E Notes: 1. When AUTO = 0, PLLIE is forced to logic 0 and is read-only. 2. When AUTO = 0, PLLF and LOCK read as logic 0. 3. When AUTO = 1, ACQ is read-only. 4. When PLLON = 0 or VRS[7:4] = $0, BCS is forced to logic 0 and is read-only. 5. When PLLON = 1, the PLL programming register is read-only. 6. When BCS = 1, PLLON is forced set and is read-only. Figure 4-4. CGM I/O Register Summary MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 65 Clock Generator Module (CGM) 4.5.1 PLL Control Register The PLL control register (PCTL) contains the interrupt enable and flag bits, the on/off switch, and the base clock selector bit. Address: Read: Write: Reset: $005C Bit 7 PLLIE 0 R 6 PLLF R 0 = Reserved 5 PLLON 1 4 BCS 0 3 1 R 1 2 1 R 1 1 1 R 1 Bit 0 1 R 1 Figure 4-5. PLL Control Register (PCTL) PLLIE — PLL Interrupt Enable Bit This read/write bit enables the PLL to generate an interrupt request when the LOCK bit toggles, setting the PLL flag, PLLF. When the AUTO bit in the PLL bandwidth control register (PBWC) is clear, PLLIE cannot be written and reads as logic 0. Reset clears the PLLIE bit. 1 = PLL interrupts enabled 0 = PLL interrupts disabled PLLF — PLL Interrupt Flag This read-only bit is set whenever the LOCK bit toggles. PLLF generates an interrupt request if the PLLIE bit also is set. PLLF always reads as logic 0 when the AUTO bit in the PLL bandwidth control register (PBWC) is clear. Clear the PLLF bit by reading the PLL control register. Reset clears the PLLF bit. 1 = Change in lock condition 0 = No change in lock condition NOTE Do not inadvertently clear the PLLF bit. Any read or read-modify-write operation on the PLL control register clears the PLLF bit. PLLON — PLL On Bit This read/write bit activates the PLL and enables the VCO clock, CGMVCLK. PLLON cannot be cleared if the VCO clock is driving the base clock, CGMOUT (BCS = 1). See 4.3.3 Base Clock Selector Circuit. Reset sets this bit so that the loop can stabilize as the MCU is powering up. 1 = PLL on 0 = PLL off BCS — Base Clock Select Bit This read/write bit selects either the crystal oscillator output, CGMXCLK, or the VCO clock, CGMVCLK, as the source of the CGM output, CGMOUT. CGMOUT frequency is one-half the frequency of the selected clock. BCS cannot be set while the PLLON bit is clear. After toggling BCS, it may take up to three CGMXCLK and three CGMVCLK cycles to complete the transition from one source clock to the other. During the transition, CGMOUT is held in stasis. See 4.3.3 Base Clock Selector Circuit. Reset clears the BCS bit. 1 = CGMVCLK divided by two drives CGMOUT 0 = CGMXCLK divided by two drives CGMOUT NOTE PLLON and BCS have built-in protection that prevents the base clock selector circuit from selecting the VCO clock as the source of the base clock MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 66 Freescale Semiconductor CGM Registers if the PLL is off. Therefore, PLLON cannot be cleared when BCS is set, and BCS cannot be set when PLLON is clear. If the PLL is off (PLLON = 0), selecting CGMVCLK requires two writes to the PLL control register. See 4.3.3 Base Clock Selector Circuit. PCTL[3:0] — Unimplemented Bits These bits provide no function and always read as logic 1s. 4.5.2 PLL Bandwidth Control Register The PLL bandwidth control register (PBWC): • Selects automatic or manual (software-controlled) bandwidth control mode • Indicates when the PLL is locked • In automatic bandwidth control mode, indicates when the PLL is in acquisition or tracking mode • In manual operation, forces the PLL into acquisition or tracking mode Address: $005D Bit 7 Read: Write: Reset: AUTO 0 R 6 LOCK R 0 = Reserved 5 ACQ 0 4 XLD 0 3 0 R 0 2 0 R 0 1 0 R 0 Bit 0 0 R 0 Figure 4-6. PLL Bandwidth Control Register (PBWC) AUTO — Automatic Bandwidth Control Bit This read/write bit selects automatic or manual bandwidth control. When initializing the PLL for manual operation (AUTO = 0), clear the ACQ bit before turning on the PLL. Reset clears the AUTO bit. 1 = Automatic bandwidth control 0 = Manual bandwidth control LOCK — Lock Indicator Bit When the AUTO bit is set, LOCK is a read-only bit that becomes set when the VCO clock, CGMVCLK, is locked (running at the programmed frequency). When the AUTO bit is clear, LOCK reads as logic 0 and has no meaning. Reset clears the LOCK bit. 1 = VCO frequency correct or locked 0 = VCO frequency incorrect or unlocked ACQ — Acquisition Mode Bit When the AUTO bit is set, ACQ is a read-only bit that indicates whether the PLL is in acquisition mode or tracking mode. When the AUTO bit is clear, ACQ is a read/write bit that controls whether the PLL is in acquisition or tracking mode. In automatic bandwidth control mode (AUTO = 1), the last-written value from manual operation is stored in a temporary location and is recovered when manual operation resumes. Reset clears this bit, enabling acquisition mode. 1 = Tracking mode 0 = Acquisition mode MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 67 Clock Generator Module (CGM) XLD — Crystal Loss Detect Bit When the VCO output, CGMVCLK, is driving CGMOUT, this read/write bit can indicate whether the crystal reference frequency is active or not. To check the status of the crystal reference, follow these steps: 1. Write a logic 1 to XLD. 2. Wait N × 4 cycles. (N is the VCO frequency multiplier.) 3. Read XLD. The crystal loss detect function works only when the BCS bit is set, selecting CGMVCLK to drive CGMOUT. When BCS is clear, XLD always reads as logic 0. 1 = Crystal reference is not active. 0 = Crystal reference is active. PBWC[3:0] — Reserved for Test These bits enable test functions not available in user mode. To ensure software portability from development systems to user applications, software should write 0s to PBWC[3:0] whenever writing to PBWC. 4.5.3 PLL Programming Register The PLL programming register (PPG) contains the programming information for the modulo feedback divider and the programming information for the hardware configuration of the VCO. Address: $005E Bit 7 Read: Write: Reset: MUL7 0 6 MUL6 1 5 MUL5 1 4 MUL4 0 3 VRS7 0 2 VRS6 1 1 VRS5 1 Bit 0 VRS4 0 Figure 4-7. PLL Programming Register (PPG) MUL[7:4] — Multiplier Select Bits These read/write bits control the modulo feedback divider that selects the VCO frequency multiplier, N. See 4.3.2.1 PLL Circuits and 4.3.2.4 Programming the PLL. A value of $0 in the multiplier select bits configures the modulo feedback divider the same as a value of $1. Reset initializes these bits to $6 to give a default multiply value of 6. Table 4-2. VCO Frequency Multiplier (N) Selection MUL7:MUL6:MUL5:MUL4 0000 0001 0010 0011 VCO Frequency Multiplier (N) 1 1 2 3 1101 1110 1111 13 14 15 MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 68 Freescale Semiconductor Interrupts NOTE The multiplier select bits have built-in protection that prevents them from being written when the PLL is on (PLLON = 1). VRS[7:4] — VCO Range Select Bits These read/write bits control the hardware center-of-range linear multiplier L, which controls the hardware center-of-range frequency fVRS. See 4.3.2.1 PLL Circuits, 4.3.2.4 Programming the PLL and 4.5.1 PLL Control Register. VRS[7:4] cannot be written when the PLLON bit in the PLL control register (PCTL) is set. See 4.3.2.5 Special Programming Exceptions. A value of $0 in the VCO range select bits disables the PLL and clears the BCS bit in the PCTL. See 4.3.3 Base Clock Selector Circuit and 4.3.2.5 Special Programming Exceptions for more information. Reset initializes the bits to $6 to give a default range multiply value of 6. NOTE The VCO range select bits have built-in protection that prevents them from being written when the PLL is on (PLLON = 1) and prevents selection of the VCO clock as the source of the base clock (BCS = 1) if the VCO range select bits are all clear. The VCO range select bits must be programmed correctly. Incorrect programming may result in failure of the PLL to achieve lock. 4.6 Interrupts When the AUTO bit is set in the PLL bandwidth control register (PBWC), the PLL can generate a CPU interrupt request every time the LOCK bit changes state. The PLLIE bit in the PLL control register (PCTL) enables CPU interrupts from the PLL. PLLF, the interrupt flag in the PCTL, becomes set whether interrupts are enabled or not. When the AUTO bit is clear, CPU interrupts from the PLL are disabled and PLLF reads as logic 0. Software should read the LOCK bit after a PLL interrupt request to see if the request was due to an entry into lock or an exit from lock. When the PLL enters lock, the VCO clock, CGMVCLK, divided by two can be selected as the CGMOUT source by setting BCS in the PCTL. When the PLL exits lock, the VCO clock frequency is corrupt, and appropriate precautions should be taken. If the application is not frequency-sensitive, interrupts should be disabled to prevent PLL interrupt service routines from impeding software performance or from exceeding stack limitations. NOTE Software can select the CGMVCLK divided by two as the CGMOUT source even if the PLL is not locked (LOCK = 0). Therefore, software should make sure the PLL is locked before setting the BCS bit. 4.7 Wait Mode The WAIT instruction puts the MCU in low power-consumption standby mode. The WAIT instruction does not affect the CGM. Before entering wait mode, software can disengage and turn off the PLL by clearing the BCS and PLLON bits in the PLL control register (PCTL). Less power-sensitive applications can disengage the PLL without turning it off. Applications that require the PLL to wake the MCU from wait mode also can deselect the PLL output without turning off the PLL. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 69 Clock Generator Module (CGM) 4.8 Acquisition/Lock Time Specifications The acquisition and lock times of the PLL are, in many applications, the most critical PLL design parameters. Proper design and use of the PLL ensures the highest stability and lowest acquisition/lock times. 4.8.1 Acquisition/Lock Time Definitions Typical control systems refer to the acquisition time or lock time as the reaction time, within specified tolerances, of the system to a step input. In a PLL, the step input occurs when the PLL is turned on or when it suffers a noise hit. The tolerance is usually specified as a percent of the step input or when the output settles to the desired value plus or minus a percent of the frequency change. Therefore, the reaction time is constant in this definition, regardless of the size of the step input. For example, consider a system with a 5 percent acquisition time tolerance. If a command instructs the system to change from 0 Hz to 1 MHz, the acquisition time is the time taken for the frequency to reach 1 MHz ± 50 kHz. Fifty kHz = 5% of the 1-MHz step input. If the system is operating at 1 MHz and suffers a –100-kHz noise hit, the acquisition time is the time taken to return from 900 kHz to 1 MHz ±5 kHz. Five kHz = 5% of the 100-kHz step input. Other systems refer to acquisition and lock times as the time the system takes to reduce the error between the actual output and the desired output to within specified tolerances. Therefore, the acquisition or lock time varies according to the original error in the output. Minor errors may not even be registered. Typical PLL applications prefer to use this definition because the system requires the output frequency to be within a certain tolerance of the desired frequency regardless of the size of the initial error. The discrepancy in these definitions makes it difficult to specify an acquisition or lock time for a typical PLL. Therefore, the definitions for acquisition and lock times for this module are: • Acquisition time, tACQ, is the time the PLL takes to reduce the error between the actual output frequency and the desired output frequency to less than the tracking mode entry tolerance, ∆TRK. Acquisition time is based on an initial frequency error, (fDES – fORIG)/fDES, of not more than ±100 percent. In automatic bandwidth control mode (see 4.3.2.3 Manual and Automatic PLL Bandwidth Modes), acquisition time expires when the ACQ bit becomes set in the PLL bandwidth control register (PBWC). • Lock time, tLock, is the time the PLL takes to reduce the error between the actual output frequency and the desired output frequency to less than the lock mode entry tolerance, ∆Lock. Lock time is based on an initial frequency error, (fDES – fORIG)/fDES, of not more than ±100 percent. In automatic bandwidth control mode, lock time expires when the LOCK bit becomes set in the PLL bandwidth control register (PBWC). See 4.3.2.3 Manual and Automatic PLL Bandwidth Modes. Obviously, the acquisition and lock times can vary according to how large the frequency error is and may be shorter or longer in many cases. 4.8.2 Parametric Influences on Reaction Time Acquisition and lock times are designed to be as short as possible while still providing the highest possible stability. These reaction times are not constant, however. Many factors directly and indirectly affect the acquisition time. The most critical parameter which affects the reaction times of the PLL is the reference frequency, fRDV. This frequency is the input to the phase detector and controls how often the PLL makes corrections. For stability, the corrections must be small compared to the desired frequency, so several corrections are MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 70 Freescale Semiconductor Acquisition/Lock Time Specifications required to reduce the frequency error. Therefore, the slower the reference the longer it takes to make these corrections. This parameter is also under user control via the choice of crystal frequency, fXCLK. Another critical parameter is the external filter capacitor. The PLL modifies the voltage on the VCO by adding or subtracting charge from this capacitor. Therefore, the rate at which the voltage changes for a given frequency error (thus change in charge) is proportional to the capacitor size. The size of the capacitor also is related to the stability of the PLL. If the capacitor is too small, the PLL cannot make small enough adjustments to the voltage and the system cannot lock. If the capacitor is too large, the PLL may not be able to adjust the voltage in a reasonable time. See 4.8.3 Choosing a Filter Capacitor. Also important is the operating voltage potential applied to VDDA. The power supply potential alters the characteristics of the PLL. A fixed value is best. Variable supplies, such as batteries, are acceptable if they vary within a known range at very slow speeds. Noise on the power supply is not acceptable, because it causes small frequency errors which continually change the acquisition time of the PLL. Temperature and processing also can affect acquisition time because the electrical characteristics of the PLL change. The part operates as specified as long as these influences stay within the specified limits. External factors, however, can cause drastic changes in the operation of the PLL. These factors include noise injected into the PLL through the filter capacitor filter, capacitor leakage, stray impedances on the circuit board, and even humidity or circuit board contamination. 4.8.3 Choosing a Filter Capacitor As described in 4.8.2 Parametric Influences on Reaction Time, the external filter capacitor, CF, is critical to the stability and reaction time of the PLL. The PLL is also dependent on reference frequency and supply voltage. The value of the capacitor must, therefore, be chosen with supply potential and reference frequency in mind. For proper operation, the external filter capacitor must be chosen according to this equation: ⎛ V DDA⎞ C F = C FACT ⎜ --------------⎟ ⎝ f RDV ⎠ For acceptable values of CFACT, see 4.8 Acquisition/Lock Time Specifications. For the value of VDDA, choose the voltage potential at which the MCU is operating. If the power supply is variable, choose a value near the middle of the range of possible supply values. This equation does not always yield a commonly available capacitor size, so round to the nearest available size. If the value is between two different sizes, choose the higher value for better stability. Choosing the lower size may seem attractive for acquisition time improvement, but the PLL can become unstable. Also, always choose a capacitor with a tight tolerance (±20 percent or better) and low dissipation. 4.8.4 Reaction Time Calculation The actual acquisition and lock times can be calculated using the equations here. These equations yield nominal values under these conditions: • Correct selection of filter capacitor, CF, see 4.8.3 Choosing a Filter Capacitor • Room temperature operation • Negligible external leakage on CGMXFC • Negligible noise MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 71 Clock Generator Module (CGM) The K factor in the equations is derived from internal PLL parameters. KACQ is the K factor when the PLL is configured in acquisition mode, and KTRK is the K factor when the PLL is configured in tracking mode. See 4.3.2.2 Acquisition and Tracking Modes. ⎛ V DDA⎞ 8 t ACQ = ⎜ --------------⎟ ⎛ -------------- ⎞ f RDV ⎠ ⎝ K ACQ⎠ ⎝ ⎛ V DDA⎞ 4 t AL = ⎜ --------------⎟ ⎛ ------------- ⎞ ⎝ f RDV ⎠ ⎝ K TRK⎠ t Lock = t ACQ + t AL NOTE The inverse proportionality between the lock time and the reference frequency. In automatic bandwidth control mode, the acquisition and lock times are quantized into units based on the reference frequency. See 4.3.2.3 Manual and Automatic PLL Bandwidth Modes A certain number of clock cycles, nACQ, is required to ascertain that the PLL is within the tracking mode entry tolerance, ∆TRK, before exiting acquisition mode. A certain number of clock cycles, nTRK, is required to ascertain that the PLL is within the lock mode entry tolerance, ∆Lock. Therefore, the acquisition time, tACQ, is an integer multiple of nACQ/fRDV, and the acquisition to lock time, tAL, is an integer multiple of nTRK/fRDV. Also, since the average frequency over the entire measurement period must be within the specified tolerance, the total time usually is longer than tLock as calculated in the previous example. In manual mode, it is usually necessary to wait considerably longer than tLock before selecting the PLL clock (see 4.3.3 Base Clock Selector Circuit) because the factors described in 4.8.2 Parametric Influences on Reaction Time may slow the lock time considerably. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 72 Freescale Semiconductor Chapter 5 Configuration Register (CONFIG) 5.1 Introduction This section describes the configuration register (CONFIG). This register contains bits that configure these options: • Resets caused by the low-voltage inhibit (LVI) module • Power to the LVI module • Computer operating properly (COP) module • Top-side pulse-width modulator (PWM) polarity • Bottom-side PWM polarity • Edge-aligned versus center-aligned PWMs • Six independent PWMs versus three complementary PWM pairs 5.2 Functional Description The configuration register (CONFIG) is used in the initialization of various options. The configuration register can be written once after each reset. All of the configuration register bits are cleared during reset. Since the various options affect the operation of the microcontroller unit (MCU), it is recommended that this register be written immediately after reset. The configuration register is located at $001F and may be read at anytime. NOTE On a FLASH device, the options are one-time writeable by the user after each reset. The registers are not in the FLASH memory but are special registers containing one-time writeable latches after each reset. Upon a reset, the configuration register defaults to predetermined settings as shown in Figure 5-1. If the LVI module and the LVI reset signal are enabled, a reset occurs when VDD falls to a voltage, VLVRx, and remains at or below that level for at least nine consecutive central processor unit (CPU) cycles. Once an LVI reset occurs, the MCU remains in reset until VDD rises to a voltage, VLVRX. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 73 Configuration Register (CONFIG) 5.3 Configuration Register Address: Read: Write: Reset: $001F Bit 7 EDGE 0 6 BOTNEG 0 5 TOPNEG 0 4 INDEP 0 3 LVIRST 1 2 LVIPWR 1 1 STOPE 0 Bit 0 COPD 0 Figure 5-1. Configuration Register (CONFIG) EDGE — Edge-Align Enable Bit EDGE determines if the motor control PWM will operate in edge-aligned mode or center-aligned mode. See Chapter 12 Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC). 1 = Edge-aligned mode enabled 0 = Center-aligned mode enabled BOTNEG — Bottom-Side PWM Polarity Bit BOTNEG determines if the bottom-side PWMs will have positive or negative polarity. See Chapter 12 Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC). 1 = Negative polarity 0 = Positive polarity TOPNEG — Top-Side PWM Polarity Bit TOPNEG determines if the top-side PWMs will have positive or negative polarity. See Chapter 12 Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC). 1 = Negative polarity 0 = Positive polarity INDEP — Independent Mode Enable Bit INDEP determines if the motor control PWMs will be six independent PWMs or three complementary PWM pairs. See Chapter 12 Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC). 1 = Six independent PWMs 0 = Three complementary PWM pairs LVIRST — LVI Reset Enable Bit LVIRST enables the reset signal from the LVI module. See Chapter 9 Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI). 1 = LVI module resets enabled 0 = LVI module resets disabled LVIPWR — LVI Power Enable Bit LVIPWR enables the LVI module. Chapter 9 Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI) 1 = LVI module power enabled 0 = LVI module power disabled STOPE — Stop Enable Bit Writing a 0 or a 1 to bit 1 has no effect on MCU operation. Bit 1 operates the same as the other bits within this write-once register operate. 1 = STOP mode enabled 0 = STOP mode disabled COPD — COP Disable Bit COPD disables the COP module. See Chapter 6 Computer Operating Properly (COP). 1 = COP module disabled 0 = COP module enabled MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 74 Freescale Semiconductor Chapter 6 Computer Operating Properly (COP) 6.1 Introduction This section describes the computer operating properly module, a free-running counter that generates a reset if allowed to overflow. The computer operating properly (COP) module helps software recover from runaway code. Prevent a COP reset by periodically clearing the COP counter. 6.2 Functional Description Figure 6-1 shows the structure of the COP module. A summary of the input/output (I/O) register is shown in Figure 6-2. SIM CGMXCLK 13-BIT SIM COUNTER CLEAR ALL BITS CLEAR BITS 12–4 SIM RESET CIRCUIT SIM RESET STATUS REGISTER INTERNAL RESET SOURCES(1) RESET VECTOR FETCH COPCTL WRITE COP MODULE 6-BIT COP COUNTER COPD (FROM CONFIG) RESET COPCTL WRITE CLEAR COP COUNTER Note 1. See 14.3.2 Active Resets from Internal Sources. Figure 6-1. COP Block Diagram MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 75 Computer Operating Properly (COP) Addr. $FFFF Register Name COP Control Register (COPCTL) See page 77. Read: Write: Reset: Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 Low byte of reset vector Clear COP counter Unaffected by reset Figure 6-2. COP I/O Register Summary The COP counter is a free-running, 6-bit counter preceded by the 13-bit system integration module (SIM) counter. If not cleared by software, the COP counter overflows and generates an asynchronous reset after 218–24 CGMXCLK cycles. With a 4.9152-MHz crystal, the COP timeout period is 53.3 ms. Writing any value to location $FFFF before overflow occurs clears the COP counter and prevents reset. A COP reset pulls the RST pin low for 32 CGMXCLK cycles and sets the COP bit in the SIM reset status register (SRSR). See 14.7.2 SIM Reset Status Register. NOTE Place COP clearing instructions in the main program and not in an interrupt subroutine. Such an interrupt subroutine could keep the COP from generating a reset even while the main program is not working properly. 6.3 I/O Signals This section describes the signals shown in Figure 6-1. 6.3.1 CGMXCLK CGMXCLK is the crystal oscillator output signal. CGMXCLK frequency is equal to the crystal frequency. 6.3.2 COPCTL Write Writing any value to the COP control register (COPCTL) (see 6.4 COP Control Register) clears the COP counter and clears bits 12–4 of the SIM counter. Reading the COP control register returns the reset vector. 6.3.3 Power-On Reset The power-on reset (POR) circuit in the SIM clears the SIM counter 4096 CGMXCLK cycles after power-up. 6.3.4 Internal Reset An internal reset clears the SIM counter and the COP counter. 6.3.5 Reset Vector Fetch A reset vector fetch occurs when the vector address appears on the data bus. A reset vector fetch clears the SIM counter. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 76 Freescale Semiconductor COP Control Register 6.3.6 COPD (COP Disable) The COPD signal reflects the state of the COP disable bit (COPD) in the configuration register (CONFIG). See Chapter 5 Configuration Register (CONFIG). 6.4 COP Control Register The COP control register is located at address $FFFF and overlaps the reset vector. Writing any value to $FFFF clears the COP counter and starts a new timeout period. Reading location $FFFF returns the low byte of the reset vector. Address: Read: Write: Reset: $FFFF Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 Low byte of reset vector Clear COP counter Unaffected by reset Figure 6-3. COP Control Register (COPCTL) 6.5 Interrupts The COP does not generate CPU interrupt requests. 6.6 Monitor Mode The COP is disabled in monitor mode when VHI is present on the IRQ pin or on the RST pin. 6.7 Wait Mode The WAIT instruction puts the MCU in low power-consumption standby mode. The COP continues to operate during wait mode. 6.8 Stop Mode Stop mode turns off the CGMXCLK input to the COP and clears the COP prescaler. Service the COP immediately before entering or after exiting stop mode to ensure a full COP timeout period after entering or exiting stop mode. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 77 Computer Operating Properly (COP) MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 78 Freescale Semiconductor Chapter 7 Central Processor Unit (CPU) 7.1 Introduction The M68HC08 CPU (central processor unit) is an enhanced and fully object-code-compatible version of the M68HC05 CPU. The CPU08 Reference Manual (document order number CPU08RM/AD) contains a description of the CPU instruction set, addressing modes, and architecture. 7.2 Features Features of the CPU include: • Object code fully upward-compatible with M68HC05 Family • 16-bit stack pointer with stack manipulation instructions • 16-bit index register with x-register manipulation instructions • 8-MHz CPU internal bus frequency • 64-Kbyte program/data memory space • 16 addressing modes • Memory-to-memory data moves without using accumulator • Fast 8-bit by 8-bit multiply and 16-bit by 8-bit divide instructions • Enhanced binary-coded decimal (BCD) data handling • Modular architecture with expandable internal bus definition for extension of addressing range beyond 64 Kbytes • Low-power stop and wait modes 7.3 CPU Registers Figure 7-1 shows the five CPU registers. CPU registers are not part of the memory map. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 79 Central Processor Unit (CPU) 7 15 H 15 15 X 0 STACK POINTER (SP) 0 PROGRAM COUNTER (PC) 7 0 V11HINZC CONDITION CODE REGISTER (CCR) 0 ACCUMULATOR (A) 0 INDEX REGISTER (H:X) CARRY/BORROW FLAG ZERO FLAG NEGATIVE FLAG INTERRUPT MASK HALF-CARRY FLAG TWO’S COMPLEMENT OVERFLOW FLAG Figure 7-1. CPU Registers 7.3.1 Accumulator The accumulator is a general-purpose 8-bit register. The CPU uses the accumulator to hold operands and the results of arithmetic/logic operations. Bit 7 Read: Write: Reset: Unaffected by reset 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 Figure 7-2. Accumulator (A) 7.3.2 Index Register The 16-bit index register allows indexed addressing of a 64-Kbyte memory space. H is the upper byte of the index register, and X is the lower byte. H:X is the concatenated 16-bit index register. In the indexed addressing modes, the CPU uses the contents of the index register to determine the conditional address of the operand. The index register can serve also as a temporary data storage location. Bit 15 Read: Write: Reset: 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 X X X X X X X X X = Indeterminate 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 Figure 7-3. Index Register (H:X) MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 80 Freescale Semiconductor CPU Registers 7.3.3 Stack Pointer The stack pointer is a 16-bit register that contains the address of the next location on the stack. During a reset, the stack pointer is preset to $00FF. The reset stack pointer (RSP) instruction sets the least significant byte to $FF and does not affect the most significant byte. The stack pointer decrements as data is pushed onto the stack and increments as data is pulled from the stack. In the stack pointer 8-bit offset and 16-bit offset addressing modes, the stack pointer can function as an index register to access data on the stack. The CPU uses the contents of the stack pointer to determine the conditional address of the operand. Bit 15 Read: Write: Reset: 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 Figure 7-4. Stack Pointer (SP) NOTE The location of the stack is arbitrary and may be relocated anywhere in random-access memory (RAM). Moving the SP out of page 0 ($0000 to $00FF) frees direct address (page 0) space. For correct operation, the stack pointer must point only to RAM locations. 7.3.4 Program Counter The program counter is a 16-bit register that contains the address of the next instruction or operand to be fetched. Normally, the program counter automatically increments to the next sequential memory location every time an instruction or operand is fetched. Jump, branch, and interrupt operations load the program counter with an address other than that of the next sequential location. During reset, the program counter is loaded with the reset vector address located at $FFFE and $FFFF. The vector address is the address of the first instruction to be executed after exiting the reset state. Bit 15 Read: Write: Reset: Loaded with vector from $FFFE and $FFFF 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 Figure 7-5. Program Counter (PC) MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 81 Central Processor Unit (CPU) 7.3.5 Condition Code Register The 8-bit condition code register contains the interrupt mask and five flags that indicate the results of the instruction just executed. Bits 6 and 5 are set permanently to 1. The following paragraphs describe the functions of the condition code register. Bit 7 Read: Write: Reset: V X X = Indeterminate 6 1 1 5 1 1 4 H X 3 I 1 2 N X 1 Z X Bit 0 C X Figure 7-6. Condition Code Register (CCR) V — Overflow Flag The CPU sets the overflow flag when a two's complement overflow occurs. The signed branch instructions BGT, BGE, BLE, and BLT use the overflow flag. 1 = Overflow 0 = No overflow H — Half-Carry Flag The CPU sets the half-carry flag when a carry occurs between accumulator bits 3 and 4 during an add-without-carry (ADD) or add-with-carry (ADC) operation. The half-carry flag is required for binary-coded decimal (BCD) arithmetic operations. The DAA instruction uses the states of the H and C flags to determine the appropriate correction factor. 1 = Carry between bits 3 and 4 0 = No carry between bits 3 and 4 I — Interrupt Mask When the interrupt mask is set, all maskable CPU interrupts are disabled. CPU interrupts are enabled when the interrupt mask is cleared. When a CPU interrupt occurs, the interrupt mask is set automatically after the CPU registers are saved on the stack, but before the interrupt vector is fetched. 1 = Interrupts disabled 0 = Interrupts enabled NOTE To maintain M6805 Family compatibility, the upper byte of the index register (H) is not stacked automatically. If the interrupt service routine modifies H, then the user must stack and unstack H using the PSHH and PULH instructions. After the I bit is cleared, the highest-priority interrupt request is serviced first. A return-from-interrupt (RTI) instruction pulls the CPU registers from the stack and restores the interrupt mask from the stack. After any reset, the interrupt mask is set and can be cleared only by the clear interrupt mask software instruction (CLI). N — Negative Flag The CPU sets the negative flag when an arithmetic operation, logic operation, or data manipulation produces a negative result, setting bit 7 of the result. 1 = Negative result 0 = Non-negative result MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 82 Freescale Semiconductor Arithmetic/Logic Unit (ALU) Z — Zero Flag The CPU sets the zero flag when an arithmetic operation, logic operation, or data manipulation produces a result of $00. 1 = Zero result 0 = Non-zero result C — Carry/Borrow Flag The CPU sets the carry/borrow flag when an addition operation produces a carry out of bit 7 of the accumulator or when a subtraction operation requires a borrow. Some instructions — such as bit test and branch, shift, and rotate — also clear or set the carry/borrow flag. 1 = Carry out of bit 7 0 = No carry out of bit 7 7.4 Arithmetic/Logic Unit (ALU) The ALU performs the arithmetic and logic operations defined by the instruction set. Refer to the CPU08 Reference Manual (document order number CPU08RM/AD) for a description of the instructions and addressing modes and more detail about the architecture of the CPU. 7.5 Low-Power Modes The WAIT and STOP instructions put the MCU in low power-consumption standby modes. 7.5.1 Wait Mode The WAIT instruction: • Clears the interrupt mask (I bit) in the condition code register, enabling interrupts. After exit from wait mode by interrupt, the I bit remains clear. After exit by reset, the I bit is set. • Disables the CPU clock 7.5.2 Stop Mode The STOP instruction: • Clears the interrupt mask (I bit) in the condition code register, enabling external interrupts. After exit from stop mode by external interrupt, the I bit remains clear. After exit by reset, the I bit is set. • Disables the CPU clock After exiting stop mode, the CPU clock begins running after the oscillator stabilization delay. 7.6 CPU During Break Interrupts If a break module is present on the MCU, the CPU starts a break interrupt by: • Loading the instruction register with the SWI instruction • Loading the program counter with $FFFC:$FFFD or with $FEFC:$FEFD in monitor mode The break interrupt begins after completion of the CPU instruction in progress. If the break address register match occurs on the last cycle of a CPU instruction, the break interrupt begins immediately. A return-from-interrupt instruction (RTI) in the break routine ends the break interrupt and returns the MCU to normal operation if the break interrupt has been deasserted. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 83 Central Processor Unit (CPU) 7.7 Instruction Set Summary Table 7-1 provides a summary of the M68HC08 instruction set. Table 7-1. Instruction Set Summary (Sheet 1 of 6) Address Mode Opcode Source Form ADC #opr ADC opr ADC opr ADC opr,X ADC opr,X ADC ,X ADC opr,SP ADC opr,SP ADD #opr ADD opr ADD opr ADD opr,X ADD opr,X ADD ,X ADD opr,SP ADD opr,SP AIS #opr AIX #opr AND #opr AND opr AND opr AND opr,X AND opr,X AND ,X AND opr,SP AND opr,SP ASL opr ASLA ASLX ASL opr,X ASL ,X ASL opr,SP ASR opr ASRA ASRX ASR opr,X ASR opr,X ASR opr,SP BCC rel Operation Description VH I NZC Add with Carry A ← (A) + (M) + (C) – IMM DIR EXT IX2 IX1 IX SP1 SP2 IMM DIR EXT IX2 IX1 IX SP1 SP2 A9 B9 C9 D9 E9 F9 9EE9 9ED9 AB BB CB DB EB FB 9EEB 9EDB A7 AF A4 B4 C4 D4 E4 F4 9EE4 9ED4 ii dd hh ll ee ff ff ff ee ff ii dd hh ll ee ff ff ff ee ff ii ii ii dd hh ll ee ff ff ff ee ff Add without Carry A ← (A) + (M) – Add Immediate Value (Signed) to SP Add Immediate Value (Signed) to H:X SP ← (SP) + (16 « M) H:X ← (H:X) + (16 « M) – – – – – – IMM – – – – – – IMM IMM DIR EXT IX2 – IX1 IX SP1 SP2 DIR INH INH IX1 IX SP1 DIR INH INH IX1 IX SP1 Logical AND A ← (A) & (M) 0–– Arithmetic Shift Left (Same as LSL) C b7 b0 0 –– 38 dd 48 58 68 ff 78 9E68 ff 37 dd 47 57 67 ff 77 9E67 ff 24 11 13 15 17 19 1B 1D 1F 25 27 90 92 28 29 22 rr dd dd dd dd dd dd dd dd rr rr rr rr rr rr rr Arithmetic Shift Right b7 b0 C –– Branch if Carry Bit Clear PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (C) = 0 – – – – – – REL DIR (b0) DIR (b1) DIR (b2) – – – – – – DIR (b3) DIR (b4) DIR (b5) DIR (b6) DIR (b7) – – – – – – REL – – – – – – REL – – – – – – REL BCLR n, opr Clear Bit n in M Mn ← 0 BCS rel BEQ rel BGE opr BGT opr BHCC rel BHCS rel BHI rel Branch if Carry Bit Set (Same as BLO) Branch if Equal Branch if Greater Than or Equal To (Signed Operands) Branch if Greater Than (Signed Operands) Branch if Half Carry Bit Clear Branch if Half Carry Bit Set Branch if Higher PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (C) = 1 PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (Z) = 1 PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (N ⊕ V) = 0 PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (Z) | (N ⊕ V) = 0 – – – – – – REL PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (H) = 0 PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (H) = 1 PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (C) | (Z) = 0 – – – – – – REL – – – – – – REL – – – – – – REL 3 3 MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 84 Freescale Semiconductor Cycles 2 3 4 4 3 2 4 5 2 3 4 4 3 2 4 5 2 2 2 3 4 4 3 2 4 5 4 1 1 4 3 5 4 1 1 4 3 5 3 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 3 3 3 3 3 Effect on CCR Operand Instruction Set Summary Table 7-1. Instruction Set Summary (Sheet 2 of 6) Address Mode Opcode Source Form BHS rel BIH rel BIL rel BIT #opr BIT opr BIT opr BIT opr,X BIT opr,X BIT ,X BIT opr,SP BIT opr,SP BLE opr BLO rel BLS rel BLT opr BMC rel BMI rel BMS rel BNE rel BPL rel BRA rel Operation Branch if Higher or Same (Same as BCC) Branch if IRQ Pin High Branch if IRQ Pin Low Description PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (C) = 0 PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? IRQ = 1 PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? IRQ = 0 VH I NZC – – – – – – REL – – – – – – REL – – – – – – REL IMM DIR EXT – IX2 IX1 IX SP1 SP2 24 2F 2E A5 B5 C5 D5 E5 F5 9EE5 9ED5 93 25 23 91 2C 2B 2D 26 2A 20 01 03 05 07 09 0B 0D 0F 21 00 02 04 06 08 0A 0C 0E 10 12 14 16 18 1A 1C 1E AD 31 41 51 61 71 9E61 98 9A rr rr rr ii dd hh ll ee ff ff ff ee ff rr rr rr rr rr rr rr rr rr rr dd rr dd rr dd rr dd rr dd rr dd rr dd rr dd rr rr dd rr dd rr dd rr dd rr dd rr dd rr dd rr dd rr dd dd dd dd dd dd dd dd rr dd rr ii rr ii rr ff rr rr ff rr Bit Test (A) & (M) 0–– Branch if Less Than or Equal To (Signed Operands) Branch if Lower (Same as BCS) Branch if Lower or Same Branch if Less Than (Signed Operands) Branch if Interrupt Mask Clear Branch if Minus Branch if Interrupt Mask Set Branch if Not Equal Branch if Plus Branch Always PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (Z) | (N ⊕ V) = 1 – – – – – – REL PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (C) = 1 PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (C) | (Z) = 1 PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (N ⊕ V) =1 PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (I) = 0 PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (N) = 1 PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (I) = 1 PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (Z) = 0 PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (N) = 0 PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel – – – – – – REL – – – – – – REL – – – – – – REL – – – – – – REL – – – – – – REL – – – – – – REL – – – – – – REL – – – – – – REL – – – – – – REL DIR (b0) DIR (b1) DIR (b2) DIR (b3) DIR (b4) DIR (b5) DIR (b6) DIR (b7) DIR (b0) DIR (b1) DIR (b2) DIR (b3) DIR (b4) DIR (b5) DIR (b6) DIR (b7) BRCLR n,opr,rel Branch if Bit n in M Clear PC ← (PC) + 3 + rel ? (Mn) = 0 ––––– BRN rel Branch Never PC ← (PC) + 2 – – – – – – REL BRSET n,opr,rel Branch if Bit n in M Set PC ← (PC) + 3 + rel ? (Mn) = 1 ––––– BSET n,opr Set Bit n in M Mn ← 1 DIR (b0) DIR (b1) DIR (b2) – – – – – – DIR (b3) DIR (b4) DIR (b5) DIR (b6) DIR (b7) – – – – – – REL DIR IMM – – – – – – IMM IX1+ IX+ SP1 – – – – – 0 INH – – 0 – – – INH BSR rel Branch to Subroutine PC ← (PC) + 2; push (PCL) SP ← (SP) – 1; push (PCH) SP ← (SP) – 1 PC ← (PC) + rel PC ← (PC) + 3 + rel ? (A) – (M) = $00 PC ← (PC) + 3 + rel ? (A) – (M) = $00 PC ← (PC) + 3 + rel ? (X) – (M) = $00 PC ← (PC) + 3 + rel ? (A) – (M) = $00 PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (A) – (M) = $00 PC ← (PC) + 4 + rel ? (A) – (M) = $00 C←0 I←0 CBEQ opr,rel CBEQA #opr,rel CBEQX #opr,rel Compare and Branch if Equal CBEQ opr,X+,rel CBEQ X+,rel CBEQ opr,SP,rel CLC CLI Clear Carry Bit Clear Interrupt Mask MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 85 Cycles 3 3 3 2 3 4 4 3 2 4 5 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 3 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 5 4 4 5 4 6 1 2 Effect on CCR Operand Central Processor Unit (CPU) Table 7-1. Instruction Set Summary (Sheet 3 of 6) Address Mode Opcode Source Form CLR opr CLRA CLRX CLRH CLR opr,X CLR ,X CLR opr,SP CMP #opr CMP opr CMP opr CMP opr,X CMP opr,X CMP ,X CMP opr,SP CMP opr,SP COM opr COMA COMX COM opr,X COM ,X COM opr,SP CPHX #opr CPHX opr CPX #opr CPX opr CPX opr CPX ,X CPX opr,X CPX opr,X CPX opr,SP CPX opr,SP DAA Operation Description M ← $00 A ← $00 X ← $00 H ← $00 M ← $00 M ← $00 M ← $00 VH I NZC Clear DIR INH INH 0 – – 0 1 – INH IX1 IX SP1 IMM DIR EXT IX2 IX1 IX SP1 SP2 DIR INH INH 1 IX1 IX SP1 IMM DIR IMM DIR EXT IX2 IX1 IX SP1 SP2 INH 3F dd 4F 5F 8C 6F ff 7F 9E6F ff A1 B1 C1 D1 E1 F1 9EE1 9ED1 ii dd hh ll ee ff ff ff ee ff Compare A with M (A) – (M) –– Complement (One’s Complement) M ← (M) = $FF – (M) A ← (A) = $FF – (M) X ← (X) = $FF – (M) M ← (M) = $FF – (M) M ← (M) = $FF – (M) M ← (M) = $FF – (M) (H:X) – (M:M + 1) 0–– 33 dd 43 53 63 ff 73 9E63 ff 65 75 A3 B3 C3 D3 E3 F3 9EE3 9ED3 72 3B 4B 5B 6B 7B 9E6B dd rr rr rr ff rr rr ff rr ii ii+1 dd ii dd hh ll ee ff ff ff ee ff Compare H:X with M –– Compare X with M (X) – (M) –– Decimal Adjust A (A)10 U–– DBNZ opr,rel DBNZA rel DBNZX rel Decrement and Branch if Not Zero DBNZ opr,X,rel DBNZ X,rel DBNZ opr,SP,rel DEC opr DECA DECX DEC opr,X DEC ,X DEC opr,SP DIV EOR #opr EOR opr EOR opr EOR opr,X EOR opr,X EOR ,X EOR opr,SP EOR opr,SP INC opr INCA INCX INC opr,X INC ,X INC opr,SP A ← (A) – 1 or M ← (M) – 1 or X ← (X) – 1 PC ← (PC) + 3 + rel ? (result) ≠ 0 DIR PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (result) ≠ 0 INH PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (result) ≠ 0 – – – – – – INH PC ← (PC) + 3 + rel ? (result) ≠ 0 IX1 PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (result) ≠ 0 IX PC ← (PC) + 4 + rel ? (result) ≠ 0 SP1 M ← (M) – 1 A ← (A) – 1 X ← (X) – 1 M ← (M) – 1 M ← (M) – 1 M ← (M) – 1 A ← (H:A)/(X) H ← Remainder DIR INH INH – IX1 IX SP1 INH IMM DIR EXT – IX2 IX1 IX SP1 SP2 DIR INH – INH IX1 IX SP1 Decrement –– 3A dd 4A 5A 6A ff 7A 9E6A ff 52 A8 B8 C8 D8 E8 F8 9EE8 9ED8 ii dd hh ll ee ff ff ff ee ff Divide –––– Exclusive OR M with A A ← ( A ⊕ M) 0–– Increment M ← (M) + 1 A ← (A) + 1 X ← (X) + 1 M ← (M) + 1 M ← (M) + 1 M ← (M) + 1 –– 3C dd 4C 5C 6C ff 7C 9E6C ff MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 86 Freescale Semiconductor Cycles 3 1 1 1 3 2 4 2 3 4 4 3 2 4 5 4 1 1 4 3 5 3 4 2 3 4 4 3 2 4 5 2 5 3 3 5 4 6 4 1 1 4 3 5 7 2 3 4 4 3 2 4 5 4 1 1 4 3 5 Effect on CCR Operand Instruction Set Summary Table 7-1. Instruction Set Summary (Sheet 4 of 6) Address Mode Opcode Source Form JMP opr JMP opr JMP opr,X JMP opr,X JMP ,X JSR opr JSR opr JSR opr,X JSR opr,X JSR ,X LDA #opr LDA opr LDA opr LDA opr,X LDA opr,X LDA ,X LDA opr,SP LDA opr,SP LDHX #opr LDHX opr LDX #opr LDX opr LDX opr LDX opr,X LDX opr,X LDX ,X LDX opr,SP LDX opr,SP LSL opr LSLA LSLX LSL opr,X LSL ,X LSL opr,SP LSR opr LSRA LSRX LSR opr,X LSR ,X LSR opr,SP MOV opr,opr MOV opr,X+ MOV #opr,opr MOV X+,opr MUL NEG opr NEGA NEGX NEG opr,X NEG ,X NEG opr,SP NOP NSA ORA #opr ORA opr ORA opr ORA opr,X ORA opr,X ORA ,X ORA opr,SP ORA opr,SP PSHA PSHH PSHX Operation Description VH I NZC PC ← Jump Address Jump DIR EXT – – – – – – IX2 IX1 IX DIR EXT – – – – – – IX2 IX1 IX IMM DIR EXT IX2 – IX1 IX SP1 SP2 – IMM DIR BC CC DC EC FC BD CD DD ED FD A6 B6 C6 D6 E6 F6 9EE6 9ED6 45 55 AE BE CE DE EE FE 9EEE 9EDE dd hh ll ee ff ff dd hh ll ee ff ff ii dd hh ll ee ff ff ff ee ff ii jj dd ii dd hh ll ee ff ff ff ee ff Jump to Subroutine PC ← (PC) + n (n = 1, 2, or 3) Push (PCL); SP ← (SP) – 1 Push (PCH); SP ← (SP) – 1 PC ← Unconditional Address Load A from M A ← (M) 0–– Load H:X from M H:X ← (M:M + 1) 0–– Load X from M X ← (M) 0–– IMM DIR EXT IX2 – IX1 IX SP1 SP2 DIR INH INH IX1 IX SP1 DIR INH INH IX1 IX SP1 DD DIX+ – IMD IX+D DIR INH INH IX1 IX SP1 Logical Shift Left (Same as ASL) C b7 b0 0 –– 38 dd 48 58 68 ff 78 9E68 ff 34 dd 44 54 64 ff 74 9E64 ff 4E 5E 6E 7E 42 30 dd 40 50 60 ff 70 9E60 ff 9D 62 AA BA CA DA EA FA 9EEA 9EDA 87 8B 89 ii dd hh ll ee ff ff ff ee ff dd dd dd ii dd dd Logical Shift Right 0 b7 b0 C ––0 Move Unsigned multiply (M)Destination ← (M)Source H:X ← (H:X) + 1 (IX+D, DIX+) X:A ← (X) × (A) M ← –(M) = $00 – (M) A ← –(A) = $00 – (A) X ← –(X) = $00 – (X) M ← –(M) = $00 – (M) M ← –(M) = $00 – (M) None A ← (A[3:0]:A[7:4]) 0–– – 0 – – – 0 INH Negate (Two’s Complement) –– No Operation Nibble Swap A – – – – – – INH – – – – – – INH IMM DIR EXT IX2 – IX1 IX SP1 SP2 Inclusive OR A and M A ← (A) | (M) 0–– Push A onto Stack Push H onto Stack Push X onto Stack Push (A); SP ← (SP) – 1 Push (H); SP ← (SP) – 1 Push (X); SP ← (SP) – 1 – – – – – – INH – – – – – – INH – – – – – – INH MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 87 Cycles 2 3 4 3 2 4 5 6 5 4 2 3 4 4 3 2 4 5 3 4 2 3 4 4 3 2 4 5 4 1 1 4 3 5 4 1 1 4 3 5 5 4 4 4 5 4 1 1 4 3 5 1 3 2 3 4 4 3 2 4 5 2 2 2 Effect on CCR Operand Central Processor Unit (CPU) Table 7-1. Instruction Set Summary (Sheet 5 of 6) Address Mode Opcode Source Form PULA PULH PULX ROL opr ROLA ROLX ROL opr,X ROL ,X ROL opr,SP ROR opr RORA RORX ROR opr,X ROR ,X ROR opr,SP RSP Operation Pull A from Stack Pull H from Stack Pull X from Stack Description SP ← (SP + 1); Pull (A) SP ← (SP + 1); Pull (H) SP ← (SP + 1); Pull (X) VH I NZC – – – – – – INH – – – – – – INH – – – – – – INH DIR INH INH IX1 IX SP1 DIR INH INH IX1 IX SP1 86 8A 88 39 dd 49 59 69 ff 79 9E69 ff 36 dd 46 56 66 ff 76 9E66 ff 9C Rotate Left through Carry C b7 b0 –– Rotate Right through Carry b7 b0 C –– Reset Stack Pointer SP ← $FF SP ← (SP) + 1; Pull (CCR) SP ← (SP) + 1; Pull (A) SP ← (SP) + 1; Pull (X) SP ← (SP) + 1; Pull (PCH) SP ← (SP) + 1; Pull (PCL) SP ← SP + 1; Pull (PCH) SP ← SP + 1; Pull (PCL) – – – – – – INH RTI Return from Interrupt INH 80 RTS SBC #opr SBC opr SBC opr SBC opr,X SBC opr,X SBC ,X SBC opr,SP SBC opr,SP SEC SEI STA opr STA opr STA opr,X STA opr,X STA ,X STA opr,SP STA opr,SP STHX opr STOP STX opr STX opr STX opr,X STX opr,X STX ,X STX opr,SP STX opr,SP SUB #opr SUB opr SUB opr SUB opr,X SUB opr,X SUB ,X SUB opr,SP SUB opr,SP Return from Subroutine – – – – – – INH IMM DIR EXT IX2 IX1 IX SP1 SP2 81 A2 B2 C2 D2 E2 F2 9EE2 9ED2 99 9B B7 C7 D7 E7 F7 9EE7 9ED7 35 8E BF CF DF EF FF 9EEF 9EDF A0 B0 C0 D0 E0 F0 9EE0 9ED0 dd hh ll ee ff ff ff ee ff ii dd hh ll ee ff ff ff ee ff dd hh ll ee ff ff ff ee ff dd ii dd hh ll ee ff ff ff ee ff Subtract with Carry A ← (A) – (M) – (C) –– Set Carry Bit Set Interrupt Mask C←1 I←1 – – – – – 1 INH – – 1 – – – INH DIR EXT IX2 – IX1 IX SP1 SP2 – DIR Store A in M M ← (A) 0–– Store H:X in M Enable Interrupts, Stop Processing, Refer to MCU Documentation (M:M + 1) ← (H:X) I ← 0; Stop Processing 0–– – – 0 – – – INH DIR EXT IX2 – IX1 IX SP1 SP2 IMM DIR EXT IX2 IX1 IX SP1 SP2 Store X in M M ← (X) 0–– Subtract A ← (A) – (M) –– MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 88 Freescale Semiconductor Cycles 2 2 2 4 1 1 4 3 5 4 1 1 4 3 5 1 7 4 2 3 4 4 3 2 4 5 1 2 3 4 4 3 2 4 5 4 1 3 4 4 3 2 4 5 2 3 4 4 3 2 4 5 Effect on CCR Operand Opcode Map Table 7-1. Instruction Set Summary (Sheet 6 of 6) Address Mode Opcode Source Form Operation Description PC ← (PC) + 1; Push (PCL) SP ← (SP) – 1; Push (PCH) SP ← (SP) – 1; Push (X) SP ← (SP) – 1; Push (A) SP ← (SP) – 1; Push (CCR) SP ← (SP) – 1; I ← 1 PCH ← Interrupt Vector High Byte PCL ← Interrupt Vector Low Byte CCR ← (A) X ← (A) A ← (CCR) VH I NZC SWI Software Interrupt – – 1 – – – INH 83 TAP TAX TPA TST opr TSTA TSTX TST opr,X TST ,X TST opr,SP TSX TXA TXS WAIT A C CCR dd dd rr DD DIR DIX+ ee ff EXT ff H H hh ll I ii IMD IMM INH IX IX+ IX+D IX1 IX1+ IX2 M N Transfer A to CCR Transfer A to X Transfer CCR to A INH – – – – – – INH – – – – – – INH DIR INH INH – IX1 IX SP1 84 97 85 3D dd 4D 5D 6D ff 7D 9E6D ff 95 9F 94 8F Test for Negative or Zero (A) – $00 or (X) – $00 or (M) – $00 0–– Transfer SP to H:X Transfer X to A Transfer H:X to SP Enable Interrupts; Wait for Interrupt H:X ← (SP) + 1 A ← (X) (SP) ← (H:X) – 1 I bit ← 0; Inhibit CPU clocking until interrupted n opr PC PCH PCL REL rel rr SP1 SP2 SP U V X Z & | – – – – – – INH – – – – – – INH – – – – – – INH – – 0 – – – INH Accumulator Carry/borrow bit Condition code register Direct address of operand Direct address of operand and relative offset of branch instruction Direct to direct addressing mode Direct addressing mode Direct to indexed with post increment addressing mode High and low bytes of offset in indexed, 16-bit offset addressing Extended addressing mode Offset byte in indexed, 8-bit offset addressing Half-carry bit Index register high byte High and low bytes of operand address in extended addressing Interrupt mask Immediate operand byte Immediate source to direct destination addressing mode Immediate addressing mode Inherent addressing mode Indexed, no offset addressing mode Indexed, no offset, post increment addressing mode Indexed with post increment to direct addressing mode Indexed, 8-bit offset addressing mode Indexed, 8-bit offset, post increment addressing mode Indexed, 16-bit offset addressing mode Memory location Negative bit ⊕ () –( ) # ← ? : — « Any bit Operand (one or two bytes) Program counter Program counter high byte Program counter low byte Relative addressing mode Relative program counter offset byte Relative program counter offset byte Stack pointer, 8-bit offset addressing mode Stack pointer 16-bit offset addressing mode Stack pointer Undefined Overflow bit Index register low byte Zero bit Logical AND Logical OR Logical EXCLUSIVE OR Contents of Negation (two’s complement) Immediate value Sign extend Loaded with If Concatenated with Set or cleared Not affected 7.8 Opcode Map See Table 7-2. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 89 Cycles 9 2 1 1 3 1 1 3 2 4 2 1 2 1 Effect on CCR Operand 90 Bit Manipulation DIR DIR MSB LSB Central Processor Unit (CPU) Table 7-2. Opcode Map Branch REL 2 3 BRA 2 REL 3 BRN 2 REL 3 BHI 2 REL 3 BLS 2 REL 3 BCC 2 REL 3 BCS 2 REL 3 BNE 2 REL 3 BEQ 2 REL 3 BHCC 2 REL 3 BHCS 2 REL 3 BPL 2 REL 3 BMI 2 REL 3 BMC 2 REL 3 BMS 2 REL 3 BIL 2 REL 3 BIH 2 REL DIR 3 INH 4 Read-Modify-Write INH IX1 5 1 NEGX 1 INH 4 CBEQX 3 IMM 7 DIV 1 INH 1 COMX 1 INH 1 LSRX 1 INH 4 LDHX 2 DIR 1 RORX 1 INH 1 ASRX 1 INH 1 LSLX 1 INH 1 ROLX 1 INH 1 DECX 1 INH 3 DBNZX 2 INH 1 INCX 1 INH 1 TSTX 1 INH 4 MOV 2 DIX+ 1 CLRX 1 INH 6 4 NEG 2 IX1 5 CBEQ 3 IX1+ 3 NSA 1 INH 4 COM 2 IX1 4 LSR 2 IX1 3 CPHX 3 IMM 4 ROR 2 IX1 4 ASR 2 IX1 4 LSL 2 IX1 4 ROL 2 IX1 4 DEC 2 IX1 5 DBNZ 3 IX1 4 INC 2 IX1 3 TST 2 IX1 4 MOV 3 IMD 3 CLR 2 IX1 SP1 9E6 IX 7 Control INH INH 8 9 IMM A 2 SUB 2 IMM 2 CMP 2 IMM 2 SBC 2 IMM 2 CPX 2 IMM 2 AND 2 IMM 2 BIT 2 IMM 2 LDA 2 IMM 2 AIS 2 IMM 2 EOR 2 IMM 2 ADC 2 IMM 2 ORA 2 IMM 2 ADD 2 IMM DIR B EXT C 4 SUB 3 EXT 4 CMP 3 EXT 4 SBC 3 EXT 4 CPX 3 EXT 4 AND 3 EXT 4 BIT 3 EXT 4 LDA 3 EXT 4 STA 3 EXT 4 EOR 3 EXT 4 ADC 3 EXT 4 ORA 3 EXT 4 ADD 3 EXT 3 JMP 3 EXT 5 JSR 3 EXT 4 LDX 3 EXT 4 STX 3 EXT Register/Memory IX2 SP2 D 4 SUB 3 IX2 4 CMP 3 IX2 4 SBC 3 IX2 4 CPX 3 IX2 4 AND 3 IX2 4 BIT 3 IX2 4 LDA 3 IX2 4 STA 3 IX2 4 EOR 3 IX2 4 ADC 3 IX2 4 ORA 3 IX2 4 ADD 3 IX2 4 JMP 3 IX2 6 JSR 3 IX2 4 LDX 3 IX2 4 STX 3 IX2 9ED 5 SUB 4 SP2 5 CMP 4 SP2 5 SBC 4 SP2 5 CPX 4 SP2 5 AND 4 SP2 5 BIT 4 SP2 5 LDA 4 SP2 5 STA 4 SP2 5 EOR 4 SP2 5 ADC 4 SP2 5 ORA 4 SP2 5 ADD 4 SP2 IX1 E SP1 9EE 4 SUB 3 SP1 4 CMP 3 SP1 4 SBC 3 SP1 4 CPX 3 SP1 4 AND 3 SP1 4 BIT 3 SP1 4 LDA 3 SP1 4 STA 3 SP1 4 EOR 3 SP1 4 ADC 3 SP1 4 ORA 3 SP1 4 ADD 3 SP1 IX F 0 5 BRSET0 3 DIR 5 BRCLR0 3 DIR 5 BRSET1 3 DIR 5 BRCLR1 3 DIR 5 BRSET2 3 DIR 5 BRCLR2 3 DIR 5 BRSET3 3 DIR 5 BRCLR3 3 DIR 5 BRSET4 3 DIR 5 BRCLR4 3 DIR 5 BRSET5 3 DIR 5 BRCLR5 3 DIR 5 BRSET6 3 DIR 5 BRCLR6 3 DIR 5 BRSET7 3 DIR 5 BRCLR7 3 DIR 1 4 BSET0 2 DIR 4 BCLR0 2 DIR 4 BSET1 2 DIR 4 BCLR1 2 DIR 4 BSET2 2 DIR 4 BCLR2 2 DIR 4 BSET3 2 DIR 4 BCLR3 2 DIR 4 BSET4 2 DIR 4 BCLR4 2 DIR 4 BSET5 2 DIR 4 BCLR5 2 DIR 4 BSET6 2 DIR 4 BCLR6 2 DIR 4 BSET7 2 DIR 4 BCLR7 2 DIR 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F 4 1 NEG NEGA 2 DIR 1 INH 5 4 CBEQ CBEQA 3 DIR 3 IMM 5 MUL 1 INH 4 1 COM COMA 2 DIR 1 INH 4 1 LSR LSRA 2 DIR 1 INH 4 3 STHX LDHX 2 DIR 3 IMM 4 1 ROR RORA 2 DIR 1 INH 4 1 ASR ASRA 2 DIR 1 INH 4 1 LSL LSLA 2 DIR 1 INH 4 1 ROL ROLA 2 DIR 1 INH 4 1 DEC DECA 2 DIR 1 INH 5 3 DBNZ DBNZA 3 DIR 2 INH 4 1 INC INCA 2 DIR 1 INH 3 1 TST TSTA 2 DIR 1 INH 5 MOV 3 DD 3 1 CLR CLRA 2 DIR 1 INH 5 3 NEG NEG 3 SP1 1 IX 6 4 CBEQ CBEQ 4 SP1 2 IX+ 2 DAA 1 INH 5 3 COM COM 3 SP1 1 IX 5 3 LSR LSR 3 SP1 1 IX 4 CPHX 2 DIR 5 3 ROR ROR 3 SP1 1 IX 5 3 ASR ASR 3 SP1 1 IX 5 3 LSL LSL 3 SP1 1 IX 5 3 ROL ROL 3 SP1 1 IX 5 3 DEC DEC 3 SP1 1 IX 6 4 DBNZ DBNZ 4 SP1 2 IX 5 3 INC INC 3 SP1 1 IX 4 2 TST TST 3 SP1 1 IX 4 MOV 2 IX+D 4 2 CLR CLR 3 SP1 1 IX 7 3 RTI BGE 1 INH 2 REL 4 3 RTS BLT 1 INH 2 REL 3 BGT 2 REL 9 3 SWI BLE 1 INH 2 REL 2 2 TAP TXS 1 INH 1 INH 1 2 TPA TSX 1 INH 1 INH 2 PULA 1 INH 2 1 PSHA TAX 1 INH 1 INH 2 1 PULX CLC 1 INH 1 INH 2 1 PSHX SEC 1 INH 1 INH 2 2 PULH CLI 1 INH 1 INH 2 2 PSHH SEI 1 INH 1 INH 1 1 CLRH RSP 1 INH 1 INH 1 NOP 1 INH 1 STOP * 1 INH 1 1 WAIT TXA 1 INH 1 INH 3 SUB 2 DIR 3 CMP 2 DIR 3 SBC 2 DIR 3 CPX 2 DIR 3 AND 2 DIR 3 BIT 2 DIR 3 LDA 2 DIR 3 STA 2 DIR 3 EOR 2 DIR 3 ADC 2 DIR 3 ORA 2 DIR 3 ADD 2 DIR 2 JMP 2 DIR 4 4 BSR JSR 2 REL 2 DIR 2 3 LDX LDX 2 IMM 2 DIR 2 3 AIX STX 2 IMM 2 DIR MSB LSB 3 SUB 2 IX1 3 CMP 2 IX1 3 SBC 2 IX1 3 CPX 2 IX1 3 AND 2 IX1 3 BIT 2 IX1 3 LDA 2 IX1 3 STA 2 IX1 3 EOR 2 IX1 3 ADC 2 IX1 3 ORA 2 IX1 3 ADD 2 IX1 3 JMP 2 IX1 5 JSR 2 IX1 5 3 LDX LDX 4 SP2 2 IX1 5 3 STX STX 4 SP2 2 IX1 2 SUB 1 IX 2 CMP 1 IX 2 SBC 1 IX 2 CPX 1 IX 2 AND 1 IX 2 BIT 1 IX 2 LDA 1 IX 2 STA 1 IX 2 EOR 1 IX 2 ADC 1 IX 2 ORA 1 IX 2 ADD 1 IX 2 JMP 1 IX 4 JSR 1 IX 4 2 LDX LDX 3 SP1 1 IX 4 2 STX STX 3 SP1 1 IX MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor INH Inherent REL Relative IMM Immediate IX Indexed, No Offset DIR Direct IX1 Indexed, 8-Bit Offset EXT Extended IX2 Indexed, 16-Bit Offset DD Direct-Direct IMD Immediate-Direct IX+D Indexed-Direct DIX+ Direct-Indexed *Pre-byte for stack pointer indexed instructions SP1 Stack Pointer, 8-Bit Offset SP2 Stack Pointer, 16-Bit Offset IX+ Indexed, No Offset with Post Increment IX1+ Indexed, 1-Byte Offset with Post Increment 0 High Byte of Opcode in Hexadecimal Low Byte of Opcode in Hexadecimal 0 5 Cycles BRSET0 Opcode Mnemonic 3 DIR Number of Bytes / Addressing Mode Chapter 8 External Interrupt (IRQ) 8.1 Introduction This section describes the external interrupt (IRQ) module, which supports external interrupt functions. 8.2 Features Features of the IRQ module include: • A dedicated external interrupt pin, IRQ • Hysteresis buffers 8.3 Functional Description A logic 0 applied to any of the external interrupt pins can latch a CPU interrupt request. Figure 8-1 shows the structure of the IRQ module. ACK1 CLR VDD D IRQ Q CK IRQ LATCH IMASK1 SYNCHRONIZER IRQ INTERRUPT REQUEST MODE1 HIGH VOLTAGE DETECT TO MODE SELECT LOGIC Figure 8-1. IRQ Module Block Diagram Addr. $003F Register Name IRQ Status/Control Register (ISCR) See page 94. Read: Write: Reset: Bit 7 0 R 0 R 6 0 R 0 = Reserved 5 0 R 0 4 0 R 0 3 IRQF 0 2 0 ACK1 0 1 IMASK1 0 Bit 0 MODE1 0 Figure 8-2. IRQ I/O Register Summary MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 91 External Interrupt (IRQ) Interrupt signals on the IRQ pin are latched into the IRQ1 latch. An interrupt latch remains set until one of the following actions occurs: • Vector fetch — A vector fetch automatically generates an interrupt acknowledge signal that clears the latch that caused the vector fetch. • Software clear — Software can clear an interrupt latch by writing to the appropriate acknowledge bit in the interrupt status and control register (ISCR). Writing a logic 1 to the ACK1 bit clears the IRQ1 latch. • Reset — A reset automatically clears both interrupt latches. The external interrupt pins are falling-edge-triggered and are software-configurable to be both falling-edge and low-level-triggered. The MODE1 bit in the ISCR controls the triggering sensitivity of the IRQ pin. When the interrupt pin is edge-triggered only, the interrupt latch remains set until a vector fetch, software clear, or reset occurs. When the interrupt pin is both falling-edge and low-level-triggered, the interrupt latch remains set until both of these occur: • Vector fetch, software clear, or reset • Return of the interrupt pin to logic 1 The vector fetch or software clear can occur before or after the interrupt pin returns to logic 1. As long as the pin is low, the interrupt request remains pending. When set, the IMASK1 bit in the ISCR masks all external interrupt requests. A latched interrupt request is not presented to the interrupt priority logic unless the IMASK bit is clear. NOTE The interrupt mask (I) in the condition code register (CCR) masks all interrupt requests, including external interrupt requests. (See Figure 8-3.) 8.4 IRQ Pin A logic 0 on the IRQ pin can latch an interrupt request into the IRQ latch. A vector fetch, software clear, or reset clears the IRQ latch. If the MODE1 bit is set, the IRQ pin is both falling-edge-sensitive and low-level- sensitive. With MODE1 set, both of these actions must occur to clear the IRQ1 latch: • Vector fetch, software clear, or reset — A vector fetch generates an interrupt acknowledge signal to clear the latch. Software can generate the interrupt acknowledge signal by writing a logic 1 to the ACK1 bit in the interrupt status and control register (ISCR). The ACK1 bit is useful in applications that poll the IRQ pin and require software to clear the IRQ1 latch. Writing to the ACK1 bit can also prevent spurious interrupts due to noise. Setting ACK1 does not affect subsequent transitions on the IRQ pin. A falling edge that occurs after writing to the ACK1 bit latches another interrupt request. If the IRQ1 mask bit, IMASK1, is clear, the CPU loads the program counter with the vector address at locations $FFFA and $FFFB. • Return of the IRQ pin to logic 1 — As long as the IRQ pin is at logic 0, the IRQ1 latch remains set. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 92 Freescale Semiconductor IRQ Pin FROM RESET YES I BIT SET? NO INTERRUPT? YES NO STACK CPU REGISTERS SET I BIT LOAD PC WITH INTERRUPT VECTOR FETCH NEXT INSTRUCTION SWI INSTRUCTION? YES NO RTI INSTRUCTION? YES UNSTACK CPU REGISTERS NO EXECUTE INSTRUCTION Figure 8-3. IRQ Interrupt Flowchart MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 93 External Interrupt (IRQ) A logic 0 on the IRQ pin can latch an interrupt request into the IRQ latch. A vector fetch, software clear, or reset clears the IRQ latch. If the MODE1 bit is set, the IRQ pin is both falling-edge-sensitive and low-level- sensitive. With MODE1 set, both of these actions must occur to clear the IRQ1 latch: • Vector fetch, software clear, or reset — A vector fetch generates an interrupt acknowledge signal to clear the latch. Software can generate the interrupt acknowledge signal by writing a logic 1 to the ACK1 bit in the interrupt status and control register (ISCR). The ACK1 bit is useful in applications that poll the IRQ pin and require software to clear the IRQ1 latch. Writing to the ACK1 bit can also prevent spurious interrupts due to noise. Setting ACK1 does not affect subsequent transitions on the IRQ pin. A falling edge that occurs after writing to the ACK1 bit latches another interrupt request. If the IRQ1 mask bit, IMASK1, is clear, the CPU loads the program counter with the vector address at locations $FFFA and $FFFB. • Return of the IRQ pin to logic 1 — As long as the IRQ pin is at logic 0, the IRQ1 latch remains set. The vector fetch or software clear and the return of the IRQ pin to logic 1 can occur in any order. The interrupt request remains pending as long as the IRQ pin is at logic 0. If the MODE1 bit is clear, the IRQ pin is falling-edge-sensitive only. With MODE1 clear, a vector fetch or software clear immediately clears the IRQ1 latch. Use the branch if IRQ pin high (BIH) or branch if IRQ pin low (BIL) instruction to read the logic level on the IRQ pin. NOTE When using the level-sensitive interrupt trigger, avoid false interrupts by masking interrupt requests in the interrupt routine. 8.5 IRQ Status and Control Register The IRQ status and control register (ISCR) has these functions: • Clears the IRQ interrupt latch • Masks IRQ interrupt requests • Controls triggering sensitivity of the IRQ interrupt pin Address: Read: Write: Reset: $003F Bit 7 0 R 0 R 6 0 R 0 = Reserved 5 0 R 0 4 0 R 0 3 IRQF 0 2 0 ACK1 0 1 IMASK1 0 Bit 0 MODE1 0 Figure 8-4. IRQ Status and Control Register (ISCR) ACK1 — IRQ Interrupt Request Acknowledge Bit Writing a logic 1 to this write-only bit clears the IRQ latch. ACK1 always reads as logic 0. Reset clears ACK1. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 94 Freescale Semiconductor IRQ Status and Control Register IMASK1 — IRQ Interrupt Mask Bit Writing a logic 1 to this read/write bit disables IRQ interrupt requests. Reset clears IMASK1. 1 = IRQ interrupt requests disabled 0 = IRQ interrupt requests enabled MODE1 — IRQ Edge/Level Select Bit This read/write bit controls the triggering sensitivity of the IRQ pin. Reset clears MODE1. 1 = IRQ interrupt requests on falling edges and low levels 0 = IRQ interrupt requests on falling edges only IRQF — IRQ Flag This read-only bit acts as a status flag, indicating an IRQ event occurred. 1 = External IRQ event occurred. 0 = External IRQ event did not occur. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 95 External Interrupt (IRQ) MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 96 Freescale Semiconductor Chapter 9 Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI) 9.1 Introduction This section describes the low-voltage inhibit (LVI) module, which monitors the voltage on the VDD pin and can force a reset when the VDD voltage falls to the LVI trip voltage. 9.2 Features Features of the LVI module include: • Programmable LVI reset • Programmable power consumption • Digital filtering of VDD pin level • Selectable LVI trip voltage 9.3 Functional Description Figure 9-1 shows the structure of the LVI module. The LVI is enabled out of reset. The LVI module contains a bandgap reference circuit and comparator. The LVI power bit, LVIPWR, enables the LVI to monitor VDD voltage. The LVI reset bit, LVIRST, enables the LVI module to generate a reset when VDD falls below a voltage, VLVRX, and remains at or below that level for nine or more consecutive CGMXCLK. VLVRX and VLVHX are determined by the TRPSEL bit in the LVISCR (see Figure 9-2). LVIPWR and LVIRST are in the configuration register (CONFIG). See Chapter 5 Configuration Register (CONFIG). VDD LVIPWR FROM CONFIG CPU CLOCK LOW VDD DETECTOR VDD > LVItrip = 0 VDD < LVItrip = 1 VDD DIGITAL FILTER FROM CONFIG LVIRST LVI RESET TRPSEL FROM LVISCR ANLGTRIP LVIOUT Figure 9-1. LVI Module Block Diagram MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 97 Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI) Once an LVI reset occurs, the MCU remains in reset until VDD rises above a voltage, VLVRX + VLVHX. VDD must be above VLVRX + VLVHX for only one CPU cycle to bring the MCU out of reset. See 14.3.2.6 Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI) Reset. The output of the comparator controls the state of the LVIOUT flag in the LVI status register (LVISCR). An LVI reset also drives the RST pin low to provide low-voltage protection to external peripheral devices. See 19.5 DC Electrical Characteristics. Addr. Register Name Bit 7 6 0 TRPSEL R 0 = Reserved 0 R 0 R 0 R 0 R 0 R 0 5 4 0 3 0 2 0 1 0 Bit 0 0 $FE0F Read: LVIOUT LVI Status and Control Register (LVISCR) Write: R See page 99. Reset: 0 R Figure 9-2. LVI I/O Register Summary 9.3.1 Polled LVI Operation In applications that can operate at VDD levels below VLVRX, software can monitor VDD by polling the LVIOUT bit. In the configuration register, the LVIPWR bit must be 1 to enable the LVI module, and the LVIRST bit must be 0 to disable LVI resets. See Chapter 5 Configuration Register (CONFIG). TRPSEL in the LVISCR selects VLVRX. 9.3.2 Forced Reset Operation In applications that require VDD to remain above VLVRX, enabling LVI resets allows the LVI module to reset the MCU when VDD falls to the VLVRX level and remains at or below that level for nine or more consecutive CPU cycles. In the CONFIG register, the LVIPWR and LVIRST bits must be 1s to enable the LVI module and to enable LVI resets. TRPSEL in the LVISCR selects VLVRX. 9.3.3 False Reset Protection The VDD pin level is digitally filtered to reduce false resets due to power supply noise. In order for the LVI module to reset the MCU, VDD must remain at or below VLVRX for nine or more consecutive CPU cycles. VDD must be above VLVRX + VLVHX for only one CPU cycle to bring the MCU out of reset. TRPSEL in the LVISCR selects VLVRX + VLVHX. 9.3.4 LVI Trip Selection The TRPSEL bit allows the user to chose between 5 percent and 10 percent tolerance when monitoring the supply voltage. The 10 percent option is enabled out of reset. Writing a 1 to TRPSEL will enable 5 percent option. NOTE The microcontroller is guaranteed to operate at a minimum supply voltage. The trip point (VLVR1 or VLVR2) may be lower than this. See 19.5 DC Electrical Characteristics. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 98 Freescale Semiconductor LVI Status and Control Register 9.4 LVI Status and Control Register The LVI status register (LVISCR) flags VDD voltages below the VLVRX level. Address: Read: Write: Reset: $FE0F Bit 7 LVIOUT R 0 6 0 R 0 = Reserved 5 TRPSEL 0 4 0 R 0 3 0 R 0 2 0 R 0 1 0 R 0 Bit 0 0 R 0 R Figure 9-3. LVI Status and Control Register (LVISCR) LVIOUT — LVI Output Bit This read-only flag becomes set when the VDD voltage falls below the VLVRX voltage for 32 to 40 CGMXCLK cycles. See Table 9-1. Reset clears the LVIOUT bit. Table 9-1. LVIOUT Bit Indication VDD At Level: VDD > VLVRX + VLVHX VDD < VLVRX VDD < VLVRX VDD < VLVRX VLVRX < VDD < VLVRX + VLVHX For Number of CGMXCLK Cycles: Any < 32 CGMXCLK cycles Between 32 & 40 CGMXCLK cycles > 40 CGMXCLK cycles Any 0 0 0 or 1 1 Previous value LVIOUT TRPSEL — LVI Trip Select Bit This bit selects the LVI trip point. Reset clears this bit. 1 = 5 percent tolerance. The trip point and recovery point are determined by VLVR1 and VLVH1, respectively. 0 = 10 percent tolerance. The trip point and recovery point are determined by VLVR2 and VLVH2, respectively. NOTE If LVIRST and LVIPWR are 0s, note that when changing the tolerance, LVI reset will be generated if the supply voltage is below the trip point. 9.5 LVI Interrupts The LVI module does not generate interrupt requests. 9.6 Wait Mode The WAIT instruction puts the MCU in low power-consumption standby mode. With the LVIPWR bit in the configuration register programmed to 1, the LVI module is active after a WAIT instruction. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 99 Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI) With the LVIRST bit in the configuration register programmed to 1, the LVI module can generate a reset and bring the MCU out of wait mode. 9.7 Stop Mode If enabled, the LVI module remains active in stop mode. If enabled to generate resets, the LVI module can generate a reset and bring the MCU out of stop mode. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 100 Freescale Semiconductor Chapter 10 Input/Output (I/O) Ports (PORTS) 10.1 Introduction Thirty-seven bidirectional input-output (I/O) pins and seven input pins form six parallel ports. All I/O pins are programmable as inputs or outputs. When using the 56-pin package version: • Set the data direction register bits in DDRC such that bit 1 is written to a logic 1 (along with any other output bits on port C). • Set the data direction register bits in DDRE such that bits 0, 1, and 2 are written to a logic 1 (along with any other output bits on port E). • Set the data direction register bits in DDRF such that bits 0, 1, 2, and 3 are written to a logic 1 (along with any other output bits on port F). NOTE Connect any unused I/O pins to an appropriate logic level, either VDD or VSS. Although PWM6–PWM1 do not require termination for proper operation, termination reduces excess current consumption and the possibility of electrostatic damage. Addr. $0000 Register Name Port A Data Register (PTA) See page 103. Port B Data Register (PTB) See page 104. Port C Data Register (PTC) See page 106. Port D Data Register (PTD) See page 107. Data Direction Register A (DDRA) See page 103. Read: Write: Reset: Read: Write: Reset: Read: Write: Reset: Read: Write: Reset: Read: Write: Reset: DDRA7 0 R DDRA6 0 = Reserved DDRA5 0 0 R PTD6 R PTD5 R 0 R PTC6 PTC5 PTB7 PTB6 PTB5 Bit 7 PTA7 6 PTA6 5 PTA5 4 PTA4 3 PTA3 2 PTA2 1 PTA1 Bit 0 PTA0 Unaffected by reset PTB4 PTB3 PTB2 PTB1 PTB0 $0001 Unaffected by reset PTC4 PTC3 PTC2 PTC1 PTC0 $0002 Unaffected by reset PTD4 R PTD3 R PTD2 R PTD1 R PTD0 R $0003 Unaffected by reset DDRA4 0 DDRA3 0 DDRA2 0 DDRA1 0 DDRA0 0 $0004 = Unimplemented Figure 10-1. I/O Port Register Summary MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 101 Input/Output (I/O) Ports (PORTS) Addr. $0005 Register Name Data Direction Register B (DDRB) See page 105. Data Direction Register C (DDRC) See page 106. Read: Write: Reset: Read: Write: Reset: Bit 7 DDRB7 0 0 R 0 6 DDRB6 0 DDRC6 0 5 DDRB5 0 DDRC5 0 4 DDRB4 0 DDRC4 0 3 DDRB3 0 DDRC3 0 2 DDRB2 0 DDRC2 0 1 DDRB1 0 DDRC1 0 Bit 0 DDRB0 0 DDRC0 0 $0006 $0007 Unimplemented Port E Data Register (PTE) See page 108. Port F Data Register (PTF) See page 110. Unimplemented Unimplemented Data Direction Register E (DDRE) See page 109. Data Direction Register F (DDRF) See page 110. Read: Write: Reset: Read: Write: Reset: R = Reserved Read: Write: Reset: Read: Write: Reset: 0 R 0 R PTF5 $0008 PTE7 PTE6 PTE5 PTE4 PTE3 PTE2 PTE1 PTE0 Unaffected by reset PTF4 PTF3 PTF2 PTF1 PTF0 $0009 Unaffected by reset $000A $000B $000C DDRE7 0 0 R DDRE6 0 0 R DDRE5 0 DDRF5 0 DDRE4 0 DDRF4 0 DDRE3 0 DDRF3 0 DDRE2 0 DDRF2 0 DDRE1 0 DDRF1 0 DDRE0 0 DDRF0 0 $000D = Unimplemented Figure 10-1. I/O Port Register Summary (Continued) MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 102 Freescale Semiconductor Port A 10.2 Port A Port A is an 8-bit, general-purpose, bidirectional I/O port. 10.2.1 Port A Data Register The port A data register (PTA) contains a data latch for each of the eight port A pins. Address: Read: Write: Reset: $0000 Bit 7 PTA7 6 PTA6 5 PTA5 4 PTA4 3 PTA3 2 PTA2 1 PTA1 Bit 0 PTA0 Unaffected by reset Figure 10-2. Port A Data Register (PTA) PTA[7:0] — Port A Data Bits These read/write bits are software programmable. Data direction of each port A pin is under the control of the corresponding bit in data direction register A. Reset has no effect on port A data. 10.2.2 Data Direction Register A Data direction register A (DDRA) determines whether each port A pin is an input or an output. Writing a logic 1 to a DDRA bit enables the output buffer for the corresponding port A pin; a logic 0 disables the output buffer. Address: Read: Write: Reset: $0004 Bit 7 DDRA7 0 6 DDRA6 0 5 DDRA5 0 4 DDRA4 0 3 DDRA3 0 2 DDRA2 0 1 DDRA1 0 Bit 0 DDRA0 0 Figure 10-3. Data Direction Register A (DDRA) DDRA[7:0] — Data Direction Register A Bits These read/write bits control port A data direction. Reset clears DDRA[7:0], configuring all port A pins as inputs. 1 = Corresponding port A pin configured as output 0 = Corresponding port A pin configured as input NOTE Avoid glitches on port A pins by writing to the port A data register before changing data direction register A bits from 0 to 1. Figure 10-4 shows the port A I/O logic. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 103 Input/Output (I/O) Ports (PORTS) READ DDRA ($0004) WRITE DDRA ($0004) INTERNAL DATA BUS RESET WRITE PTA ($0000) PTAx PTAx DDRAx READ PTA ($0000) Figure 10-4. Port A I/O Circuit When bit DDRAx is a logic 1, reading address $0000 reads the PTAx data latch. When bit DDRAx is a logic 0, reading address $0000 reads the voltage level on the pin. The data latch can always be written, regardless of the state of its data direction bit. Table 10-1 summarizes the operation of the port A pins. Table 10-1. Port A Pin Functions DDRA Bit 0 1 PTA Bit X (1) I/O Pin Mode Input, Hi-Z(2) Accesses to DDRA Read/Write DDRA[7:0] DDRA[7:0] Accesses to PTA Read Pin PTA[7:0] Write PTA[7:0](3) PTA[7:0] X Output 1. X = don’t care 2. Hi-Z = high impedance 3. Writing affects data register, but does not affect input. 10.3 Port B Port B is an 8-bit, general-purpose, bidirectional I/O port that shares its pins with the analog-to-digital convertor (ADC) module. 10.3.1 Port B Data Register The port B data register (PTB) contains a data latch for each of the eight port B pins. Address: Read: Write: Reset: $0001 Bit 7 PTB7 6 PTB6 5 PTB5 4 PTB4 3 PTB3 2 PTB2 1 PTB1 Bit 0 PTB0 Unaffected by reset Figure 10-5. Port B Data Register (PTB) PTB[7:0] — Port B Data Bits These read/write bits are software-programmable. Data direction of each port B pin is under the control of the corresponding bit in data direction register B. Reset has no effect on port B data. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 104 Freescale Semiconductor Port B 10.3.2 Data Direction Register B Data direction register B (DDRB) determines whether each port B pin is an input or an output. Writing a logic 1 to a DDRB bit enables the output buffer for the corresponding port B pin; a logic 0 disables the output buffer. Address: Read: Write: Reset: $0005 Bit 7 DDRB7 0 6 DDRB6 0 5 DDRB5 0 4 DDRB4 0 3 DDRB3 0 2 DDRB2 0 1 DDRB1 0 Bit 0 DDRB0 0 Figure 10-6. Data Direction Register B (DDRB) DDRB[7:0] — Data Direction Register B Bits These read/write bits control port B data direction. Reset clears DDRB[7:0], configuring all port B pins as inputs. 1 = Corresponding port B pin configured as output 0 = Corresponding port B pin configured as input NOTE Avoid glitches on port B pins by writing to the port B data register before changing data direction register B bits from 0 to 1. Figure 10-7 shows the port B I/O logic. READ DDRB ($0005) WRITE DDRB ($0005) INTERNAL DATA BUS RESET WRITE PTB ($0001) PTBx PTBx DDRBx READ PTB ($0001) Figure 10-7. Port B I/O Circuit When bit DDRBx is a logic 1, reading address $0001 reads the PTBx data latch. When bit DDRBx is a logic 0, reading address $0001 reads the voltage level on the pin. The data latch can always be written, regardless of the state of its data direction bit. Table 10-2 summarizes the operation of the port B pins. Table 10-2. Port B Pin Functions DDRB Bit 0 1 PTB Bit X(1) X I/O Pin Mode Input, Hi-Z(2) Output Accesses to DDRB Read/Write DDRB[7:0] DDRB[7:0] Accesses to PTB Read Write Pin PTB[7:0] PTB[7:0](3) PTB[7:0] 1. X = don’t care 2. Hi-Z = high impedance 3. Writing affects data register, but does not affect input. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 105 Input/Output (I/O) Ports (PORTS) 10.4 Port C Port C is a 7-bit, general-purpose, bidirectional I/O port that shares two of its pins with the analog-to-digital convertor module (ADC). 10.4.1 Port C Data Register The port C data register (PTC) contains a data latch for each of the seven port C pins. Address: $0002 Bit 7 Read: Write: Reset: R = Reserved 0 R 6 PTC6 5 PTC5 4 PTC4 3 PTC3 2 PTC2 1 PTC1 Bit 0 PTC0 Unaffected by reset Figure 10-8. Port C Data Register (PTC) PTC[6:0] — Port C Data Bits These read/write bits are software-programmable. Data direction of each port C pin is under the control of the corresponding bit in data direction register C. Reset has no effect on port C data. 10.4.2 Data Direction Register C Data direction register C (DDRC) determines whether each port C pin is an input or an output. Writing a logic 1 to a DDRC bit enables the output buffer for the corresponding port C pin; a logic 0 disables the output buffer. Address: $0006 Bit 7 Read: Write: Reset: 0 R 0 R 6 DDRC6 0 = Reserved 5 DDRC5 0 4 DDRC4 0 3 DDRC3 0 2 DDRC2 0 1 DDRC1 0 Bit 0 DDRC0 0 Figure 10-9. Data Direction Register C (DDRC) DDRC[6:0] — Data Direction Register C Bits These read/write bits control port C data direction. Reset clears DDRC[6:0], configuring all port C pins as inputs. 1 = Corresponding port C pin configured as output 0 = Corresponding port C pin configured as input NOTE Avoid glitches on port C pins by writing to the port C data register before changing data direction register C bits from 0 to 1. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 106 Freescale Semiconductor Port D Figure 10-10 shows the port C I/O logic. READ DDRC ($0006) WRITE DDRC ($0006) INTERNAL DATA BUS RESET WRITE PTC ($0002) PTCx PTCx DDRCx READ PTC ($0002) Figure 10-10. Port C I/O Circuit When bit DDRCx is a logic 1, reading address $0002 reads the PTCx data latch. When bit DDRCx is a logic 0, reading address $0002 reads the voltage level on the pin. The data latch can always be written, regardless of the state of its data direction bit. Table 10-3 summarizes the operation of the port C pins. Table 10-3. Port C Pin Functions DDRC Bit PTC Bit X(1) X I/O Pin Mode Input, Hi-Z(2) Output Accesses to DDRC Read/Write 0 1 DDRC[6:0] DDRC[6:0] Accesses to PTC Read Pin PTC[6:0] Write PTC[6:0](3) PTC[6:0] 1. X = don’t care 2. Hi-Z = high impedance 3. Writing affects data register, but does not affect input. 10.5 Port D Port D is a 7-bit, input-only port that shares its pins with the pulse width modulator for motor control module (PMC). The port D data register (PTD) contains a data latch for each of the seven port pins. Address: $0003 Bit 7 Read: Write: Reset: R = Reserved 0 R 6 PTD6 R 5 PTD5 R 4 PTD4 R 3 PTD3 R 2 PTD2 R 1 PTD1 R Bit 0 PTD0 R Unaffected by reset Figure 10-11. Port D Data Register (PTD) PTD[6:0] — Port D Data Bits These read/write bits are software programmable. Reset has no effect on port D data. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 107 Input/Output (I/O) Ports (PORTS) Figure 10-12 shows the port D input logic. INTERNAL DATA BUS READ PTD ($0003) PTDx Figure 10-12. Port D Input Circuit Reading address $0003 reads the voltage level on the pin. Table 10-4 summarizes the operation of the port D pins. Table 10-4. Port D Pin Functions PTD Bit X (1) Pin Mode Input, Hi-Z(2) Accesses to PTD Read Pin Write PTD[6:0](3) 1. X = don’t care 2. Hi-Z = high impedance 3. Writing affects data register, but does not affect input. 10.6 Port E Port E is an 8-bit, special function port that shares five of its pins with the timer interface module (TIM) and two of its pins with the serial communications interface module (SCI). 10.6.1 Port E Data Register The port E data register (PTE) contains a data latch for each of the eight port E pins. Address: Read: Write: Reset: $0008 Bit 7 PTE7 6 PTE6 5 PTE5 4 PTE4 3 PTE3 2 PTE2 1 PTE1 Bit 0 PTE0 Unaffected by reset Figure 10-13. Port E Data Register (PTE) PTE[7:0] — Port E Data Bits PTE[7:0] are read/write, software-programmable bits. Data direction of each port E pin is under the control of the corresponding bit in data direction register E. NOTE Data direction register E (DDRE) does not affect the data direction of port E pins that are being used by the TIMA or TIMB. However, the DDRE bits always determine whether reading port E returns the states of the latches or the states of the pins. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 108 Freescale Semiconductor Port E 10.6.2 Data Direction Register E Data direction register E (DDRE) determines whether each port E pin is an input or an output. Writing a logic 1 to a DDRE bit enables the output buffer for the corresponding port E pin; a logic 0 disables the output buffer. Address: Read: Write: Reset: $000C Bit 7 DDRE7 0 6 DDRE6 0 5 DDRE5 0 4 DDRE4 0 3 DDRE3 0 2 DDRE2 0 1 DDRE1 0 Bit 0 DDRE0 0 Figure 10-14. Data Direction Register E (DDRE) DDRE[7:0] — Data Direction Register E Bits These read/write bits control port E data direction. Reset clears DDRE[7:0], configuring all port E pins as inputs. 1 = Corresponding port E pin configured as output 0 = Corresponding port E pin configured as input NOTE Avoid glitches on port E pins by writing to the port E data register before changing data direction register E bits from 0 to 1. Figure 10-15 shows the port E I/O logic. READ DDRE ($000C) WRITE DDRE ($000C) INTERNAL DATA BUS RESET WRITE PTE ($0008) PTEx PTEx DDREx READ PTE ($0008) Figure 10-15. Port E I/O Circuit When bit DDREx is a logic 1, reading address $0008 reads the PTEx data latch. When bit DDREx is a logic 0, reading address $0008 reads the voltage level on the pin. The data latch can always be written, regardless of the state of its data direction bit. Table 10-5 summarizes the operation of the port E pins. Table 10-5. Port E Pin Functions DDRE Bit 0 1 PTE Bit X(1) X I/O Pin Mode Input, Hi-Z(2) Output Accesses to DDRE Read/Write DDRE[7:0] DDRE[7:0] Accesses to PTE Read Pin PTE[7:0] Write PTE[7:0](3) PTE[7:0] 1. X = don’t care 2. Hi-Z = high impedance 3. Writing affects data register, but does not affect input. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 109 Input/Output (I/O) Ports (PORTS) 10.7 Port F Port F is a 6-bit, special function port that shares four of its pins with the serial peripheral interface module (SPI) and two pins with the serial communications interface (SCI). 10.7.1 Port F Data Register The port F data register (PTF) contains a data latch for each of the six port F pins. Address: Read: Write: Reset: R = Reserved $0009 Bit 7 0 R 6 0 R 5 PTF5 4 PTF4 3 PTF3 2 PTF2 1 PTF1 Bit 0 PTF0 Unaffected by reset Figure 10-16. Port F Data Register (PTF) PTF[5:0] — Port F Data Bits These read/write bits are software programmable. Data direction of each port F pin is under the control of the corresponding bit in data direction register F. Reset has no effect on PTF[5:0]. NOTE Data direction register F (DDRF) does not affect the data direction of port F pins that are being used by the SPI or SCI module. However, the DDRF bits always determine whether reading port F returns the states of the latches or the states of the pins. 10.7.2 Data Direction Register F Data direction register F (DDRF) determines whether each port F pin is an input or an output. Writing a logic 1 to a DDRF bit enables the output buffer for the corresponding port F pin; a logic 0 disables the output buffer. Address: Read: Write: Read: R = Reserved $000D Bit 7 0 R 6 0 R 5 DDRF5 0 4 DDRF4 0 3 DDRF3 0 2 DDRF2 0 1 DDRF1 0 Bit 0 DDRF0 0 Figure 10-17. Data Direction Register F (DDRF) DDRF[5:0] — Data Direction Register F Bits These read/write bits control port F data direction. Reset clears DDRF[5:0], configuring all port F pins as inputs. 1 = Corresponding port F pin configured as output 0 = Corresponding port F pin configured as input NOTE Avoid glitches on port F pins by writing to the port F data register before changing data direction register F bits from 0 to 1. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 110 Freescale Semiconductor Port F Figure 10-18 shows the port F I/O logic. READ DDRF ($000D) WRITE DDRF ($000D) INTERNAL DATA BUS RESET WRITE PTF ($0009) PTFx PTFx DDRFx READ PTF ($0009) Figure 10-18. Port F I/O Circuit When bit DDRFx is a logic 1, reading address $0009 reads the PTFx data latch. When bit DDRFx is a logic 0, reading address $0009 reads the voltage level on the pin. The data latch can always be written, regardless of the state of its data direction bit. Table 10-6 summarizes the operation of the port F pins. Table 10-6. Port F Pin Functions DDRF Bit 0 1 PTF Bit X(1) X I/O Pin Mode Input, Hi-Z(2) Output Accesses to DDRF Read/Write DDRF[6:0] DDRF[6:0] Accesses to PTF Read Pin PTF[6:0] Write PTF[6:0](3) PTF[6:0] 1. X = don’t care 2. Hi-Z = high impedance 3. Writing affects data register, but does not affect input. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 111 Input/Output (I/O) Ports (PORTS) MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 112 Freescale Semiconductor Chapter 11 Power-On Reset (POR) 11.1 Introduction This section describes the power-on reset (POR) module. 11.2 Functional Description The POR module provides a known, stable signal to the microcontroller unit (MCU) at power-on. This signal tracks VDD until the MCU generates a feedback signal to indicate that it is properly initialized. At this time, the POR drives its output low. The POR is not a brown-out detector, low-voltage detector, or glitch detector. VDD at the POR must go completely to 0 to reset the microcontroller unit (MCU). To detect power-loss conditions, use a low-voltage inhibit module (LVI) or other suitable circuit. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 113 Power-On Reset (POR) MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 114 Freescale Semiconductor Chapter 12 Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC) 12.1 Introduction This section describes the pulse-width modulator for motor control (PWMMC, version A). The PWM module can generate three complementary PWM pairs or six independent PWM signals. These PWM signals can be center-aligned or edge-aligned. A block diagram of the PWM module is shown in Figure 12-2. A12-bit timer PWM counter is common to all six channels. PWM resolution is one clock period for edge-aligned operation and two clock periods for center-aligned operation. The clock period is dependent on the internal operating frequency (fOP) and a programmable prescaler. The highest resolution for edge-aligned operation is 125 ns (fOP = 8 MHz). The highest resolution for center-aligned operation is 250 ns (fOP = 8 MHz). When generating complementary PWM signals, the module features automatic dead-time insertion to the PWM output pairs and transparent toggling of PWM data based upon sensed motor phase current polarity. A summary of the PWM registers is shown in Figure 12-3. 12.2 Features Features of the PWMMC include: • Three complementary PWM pairs or six independent PWM signals • Edge-aligned PWM signals or center-aligned PWM signals • PWM signal polarity control • 20-mA current sink capability on PWM pins • Manual PWM output control through software • Programmable fault protection • Complementary mode featuring: – Dead-time insertion – Separate top/bottom pulse width correction via current sensing or programmable software bits MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 115 DDRA PTA DDRB USER FLASH — 32,256 BYTES TIMER INTERFACE MODULE A USER RAM — 768 BYTES TIMER INTERFACE MODULE B PTB DDRC USER FLASH VECTOR SPACE — 46 BYTES OSC1 OSC2 CGMXFC SERIAL COMMUNICATIONS INTERFACE MODULE PTC RST SYSTEM INTEGRATION MODULE IRQ MODULE ANALOG-TO-DIGITAL CONVERTER MODULE POWER-ON RESET MODULE PTD DDRE VSS VDD VDDAD VSSAD PTF0/SPSCK(1) POWER Notes: 1. These pins are not available in the 56-pin SDIP package. 2. This module is not available in the 56-pin SDIP package. 3. In the 56-pin SDIP package, these pins are bonded together. Figure 12-1. Block Diagram Highlighting PWMMC Block and Pins DDRF PTF PWMGND PWM6–PWM1 PULSE-WIDTH MODULATOR MODULE PTF5/TxD PTF4/RxD PTF3/MISO(1) PTF2/MOSI(1) PTF1/SS(1) PTE 116 M68HC08 CPU CPU REGISTERS ARITHMETIC/LOGIC UNIT CONTROL AND STATUS REGISTERS — 112 BYTES Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC) INTERNAL BUS PTA7–PTA0 PTB7/ATD7 PTB6/ATD6 PTB5/ATD5 PTB4/ATD4 PTB3/ATD3 PTB2/ATD2 PTB1/ATD1 PTB0/ATD0 PTC6 PTC5 PTC4 PTC3 PTC2 PTC1/ATD9(1) PTC0/ATD8 PTD6/IS3 PTD5/IS2 PTD4/IS1 PTD3/FAULT4 PTD2/FAULT3 PTD1/FAULT2 PTD0/FAULT1 PTE7/TCH3A PTE6/TCH2A PTE5/TCH1A PTE4/TCH0A PTE3/TCLKA PTE2/TCH1B(1) PTE1/TCH0B(1) PTE0/TCLKB(1) LOW-VOLTAGE INHIBIT MODULE COMPUTER OPERATING PROPERLY MODULE MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor MONITOR ROM — 240 BYTES CLOCK GENERATOR MODULE SERIAL PERIPHERAL INTERFACE MODULE(2) IRQ VDDA VSSA(3) VREFL(3) VREFH SINGLE BREAK MODULE Features 8 CPU BUS PWM1 PIN PWM CHANNELS 1 AND 2 OUTPUT CONTROL FAULT PROTECTION PWM2 PIN CONTROL LOGIC BLOCK PWM3 PIN PWM4 PIN PWM CHANNELS 3 AND 4 PWM5 PIN PWM CHANNELS 5 AND 6 PWM6 PIN FAULT INTERRUPT PINS 12 4 TIMEBASE 3 COIL CURRENT POLARITY PINS Figure 12-2. PWM Module Block Diagram Addr. Register Name PWM Control Register 1 (PCTL1) See page 146. PWM Control Register 2 (PCTL2) See page 148. Fault Control Register (FCR) See page 150. Fault Status Register (FSR) See page 152. Fault Acknowledge Register (FTACK) See page 153. Read: Bit 7 DISX Write: Reset: Read: LDFQ1 Write: Reset: Read: FINT4 Write: Reset: Read: Write: Reset: Read: Write: Reset: 0 R U 0 0 FPIN4 0 0 6 DISY 0 LDFQ0 0 FMODE4 0 FFLAG4 5 PWMINT 0 0 4 PWMF 0 IPOL1 3 ISENS1 0 IPOL2 0 FINT2 0 FPIN2 2 ISENS0 0 IPOL3 0 FMODE2 0 FFLAG2 1 LDOK 0 PRSC1 0 FINT1 0 FPIN1 Bit 0 PWMEN 0 PRSC0 0 FMODE1 0 FFLAG1 $0020 $0021 0 FINT3 0 FPIN3 0 FMODE3 0 FFLAG3 $0022 $0023 0 0 FTACK4 0 = Reserved U DT6 0 DT5 FTACK3 U DT4 0 DT3 FTACK2 U DT2 0 DT1 FTACK1 $0024 0 0 Bold 0 = Buffered 0 0 0 X = Indeterminate Figure 12-3. Register Summary (Sheet 1 of 3) MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 117 Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC) Addr. Register Name PWM Output Control Register (PWMOUT) See page 154. PWM Counter Register High (PCNTH) See page 143. PWM Counter Register Low (PCNTL) See page 143. PWM Counter Modulo Register High (PMODH) See page 144. PWM Counter Modulo Register Low (PMODL) See page 144. PWM 1 Value Register High (PVAL1H) See page 145. PWM 1 Value Register Low (PVAL1L) See page 145. PWM 2 Value Register High (PVAL2H) See page 145. PWM 2 Value Register Low (PVAL2L) See page 145. PWM 3 Value Register High (PVAL3H) See page 145. PWM 3 Value Register Low (PVAL3L) See page 145. Read: Write: Reset: Read: Write: Reset: Read: Write: Reset: Read: Write: Reset: Read: Bit 7 Write: Reset: Read: Bit 15 Write: Reset: Read: Bit 7 Write: Reset: Read: Bit 15 Write: Reset: Read: Bit 7 Write: Reset: Read: Bit 15 Write: Reset: Read: Bit 7 Write: Reset: 0 R 0 = Reserved 0 0 Bold 0 = Buffered 0 0 0 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bit 14 Bit 13 Bit 12 Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9 Bit 8 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bit 14 Bit 13 Bit 12 Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9 Bit 8 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bit 14 Bit 13 Bit 12 Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9 Bit 8 X X X X X X X X Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 0 0 0 0 X X X X 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9 Bit 8 0 0 0 0 0 Bit 7 0 Bit 6 0 Bit 5 0 Bit 4 0 Bit 3 0 Bit 2 0 Bit 1 0 Bit 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bit 11 0 Bit 10 0 Bit 9 0 Bit 8 Bit 7 0 OUTCTL OUT6 OUT5 OUT4 OUT3 OUT2 OUT1 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 $0025 $0026 $0027 $0028 $0029 $002A $002B $002C $002D $002E $002F X = Indeterminate Figure 12-3. Register Summary (Sheet 2 of 3) MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 118 Freescale Semiconductor Features Addr. Register Name PWM 4 Value Register High (PVAL4H) See page 145. PWM 4 Value Register Low (PVAL4L) See page 145. PWM 5 Value Register High (PVAL5H) See page 145. PWM 5 Value Register Low (PVAL5L) See page 145. PWM 6 Value Register High (PVAL6H) See page 145. PWM 6 Value Register Low (PMVAL6L) See page 145. Dead-Time Write-Once Register (DEADTM) See page 150. PWM Disable Mapping Write-Once Register (DISMAP) See page 150. Read: Bit 15 Write: Reset: Read: Bit 7 Write: Reset: Read: Bit 15 Write: Reset: Read: Bit 7 Write: Reset: Read: Bit 15 Write: Reset: Read: Bit 7 Write: Reset: Read: Bit 7 Write: Reset: Read: Bit 7 Write: Reset: 1 R 1 = Reserved 1 1 Bold 1 = Buffered 1 1 1 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bit 14 Bit 13 Bit 12 Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9 Bit 8 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bit 14 Bit 13 Bit 12 Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9 Bit 8 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bit 14 Bit 13 Bit 12 Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9 Bit 8 Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 $0030 $0031 $0032 $0033 $0034 $0035 $0036 $0037 X = Indeterminate Figure 12-3. Register Summary (Sheet 3 of 3) MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 119 Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC) 12.3 Timebase This section provides a discussion of the timebase. 12.3.1 Resolution In center-aligned mode, a 12-bit up/down counter is used to create the PWM period. Therefore, the PWM resolution in center-aligned mode is two clocks (highest resolution is 250 ns @ fOP = 8 MHz) as shown in Figure 12-4. The up/down counter uses the value in the timer modulus register to determine its maximum count. The PWM period will equal: [(timer modulus) x (PWM clock period) x 2]. UP/DOWN COUNTER MODULUS = 4 PERIOD = 8 X (PWM CLOCK PERIOD) PWM = 0 PWM = 1 PWM = 2 PWM = 3 PWM = 4 Figure 12-4. Center-Aligned PWM (Positive Polarity) MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 120 Freescale Semiconductor Timebase For edge-aligned mode, a 12-bit up-only counter is used to create the PWM period. Therefore, the PWM resolution in edge-aligned mode is one clock (highest resolution is125 ns @ fOP = 8 MHz) as shown in Figure 12-5. Again, the timer modulus register is used to determine the maximum count. The PWM period will equal: (timer modulus) x (PWM clock period) Center-aligned operation versus edge-aligned operation is determined by the option EDGE. See 5.2 Functional Description. UP-ONLY COUNTER MODULUS = 4 PERIOD = 4 X (PWM CLOCK PERIOD) PWM = 0 PWM = 1 PWM = 2 PWM = 3 PWM = 4 Figure 12-5. Edge-Aligned PWM (Positive Polarity) MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 121 Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC) 12.3.2 Prescaler To permit lower PWM frequencies, a prescaler is provided which will divide the PWM clock frequency by 1, 2, 4, or 8. Table 12-1 shows how setting the prescaler bits in PWM control register 2 affects the PWM clock frequency. This prescaler is buffered and will not be used by the PWM generator until the LDOK bit is set and a new PWM reload cycle begins. Table 12-1. PWM Prescaler Prescaler Bits PRSC1 and PRSC0 00 01 10 11 PWM Clock Frequency fOP fOP/2 fOP/4 fOP/8 12.4 PWM Generators Pulse-width modulator (PWM) generators are discussed in this subsection. 12.4.1 Load Operation To help avoid erroneous pulse widths and PWM periods, the modulus, prescaler, and PWM value registers are buffered. New PWM values, counter modulus values, and prescalers can be loaded from their buffers into the PWM module every one, two, four, or eight PWM cycles. LDFQ1 and LDFQ0 in PWM control register 2 are used to control this reload frequency, as shown in Table 12-2. When a reload cycle arrives, regardless of whether an actual reload occurs (as determined by the LDOK bit), the PWM reload flag bit in PWM control register 1 will be set. If the PWMINT bit in PWM control register 1 is set, a CPU interrupt request will be generated when PWMF is set. Software can use this interrupt to calculate new PWM parameters in real time for the PWM module. Table 12-2. PWM Reload Frequency Reload Frequency Bits LDFQ1 and LDFQ0 00 01 10 11 PWM Reload Frequency Every PWM cycle Every 2 PWM cycles Every 4 PWM cycles Every 8 PWM cycles MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 122 Freescale Semiconductor PWM Generators For ease of software, the LDFQx bits are buffered. When the LDFQx bits are changed, the reload frequency will not change until the previous reload cycle is completed. See Figure 12-6. NOTE When reading the LDFQx bits, the value is the buffered value (for example, not necessarily the value being acted upon). RELOAD RELOAD RELOAD RELOAD RELOADRELOADRELOAD CHANGE RELOAD FREQUENCY TO EVERY CYCLE CHANGE RELOAD FREQUENCY TO EVERY 4 CYCLES Figure 12-6. Reload Frequency Change PWMINT enables CPU interrupt requests as shown in Figure 12-7. When this bit is set, CPU interrupt requests are generated when the PWMF bit is set. When the PWMINT bit is clear, PWM interrupt requests are inhibited. PWM reloads will still occur at the reload rate, but no interrupt requests will be generated. READ PWMF AS 1, WRITE PWMF AS 0 OR RESET RESET PWMF D LATCH CPU INTERRUPT REQUEST VDD PWM RELOAD CK PWMINT Figure 12-7. PWM Interrupt Requests To prevent a partial reload of PWM parameters from occurring while the software is still calculating them, an interlock bit controlled from software is provided. This bit informs the PWM module that all the PWM parameters have been calculated, and it is “okay” to use them. A new modulus, prescaler, and/or PWM value cannot be loaded into the PWM module until the LDOK bit in PWM control register 1 is set. When the LDOK bit is set, these new values are loaded into a second set of registers and used by the PWM generator at the beginning of the next PWM reload cycle as shown in Figure 12-8, Figure 12-9, Figure 12-10, and Figure 12-11. After these values are loaded, the LDOK bit is cleared. NOTE When the PWM module is enabled (via the PWMEN bit), a load will occur if the LDOK bit is set. Even if it is not set, an interrupt will occur if the PWMINT bit is set. To prevent this, the software should clear the PWMINT bit before enabling the PWM module. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 123 Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC) LDFQ1:LDFQ0 = 00 (RELOAD EVERY CYCLE) UP/DOWN COUNTER LDOK = 1 MODULUS = 3 PWM VALUE = 1 PWMF SET PWM LDOK = 0 MODULUS = 3 PWM VALUE = 2 PWMF SET LDOK = 1 MODULUS = 3 PWM VALUE = 2 PWMF SET LDOK = 0 MODULUS = 3 PWM VALUE = 1 PWMF SET Figure 12-8. Center-Aligned PWM Value Loading LDFQ1:LDFQ0 = 00 (RELOAD EVERY CYCLE) UP/DOWN COUNTER LDOK = 1 MODULUS = 2 PWM VALUE = 1 PWMF SET PWM LDOK = 1 MODULUS = 3 PWM VALUE = 1 PWMF SET LDOK = 1 LDOK = 1 LDOK = 0 MODULUS = 2 MODULUS = 1 MODULUS = 2 PWMVALUE = 1 PWM VALUE = 1 PWM VALUE = 1 PWMF SET PWMF SET PWMF SET Figure 12-9. Center-Aligned Loading of Modulus LDFQ1:LDFQ0 = 00 (RELOAD EVERY CYCLE) UP-ONLY COUNTER LDOK = 1 LDOK = 0 LDOK = 1 LDOK = 0 LDOK = 0 MODULUS = 3 MODULUS = 3 MODULUS = 3 MODULUS = 3 MODULUS = 3 PWM VALUE = 1 PWM VALUE = 2 PWM VALUE = 2 PWM VALUE = 1 PWM VALUE = 1 PWMF SET PWMF SET PWMF SET PWMF SET PWMF SET PWM Figure 12-10. Edge-Aligned PWM Value Loading MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 124 Freescale Semiconductor PWM Generators LDFQ1:LDFQ0 = 00 (RELOAD EVERY CYCLE) UP-ONLY COUNTER LDOK = 1 MODULUS = 3 PWM VALUE = 2 PWMF SET LDOK = 1 MODULUS = 4 PWM VALUE = 2 PWMF SET LDOK = 1 MODULUS = 2 PWM VALUE = 2 PWMF SET LDOK = 0 MODULUS = 1 PWM VALUE = 2 PWMF SET PWM Figure 12-11. Edge-Aligned Modulus Loading 12.4.2 PWM Data Overflow and Underflow Conditions The PWM value registers are 16-bit registers. Although the counter is only 12 bits, the user may write a 16-bit signed value to a PWM value register. As shown in Figure 12-4 and Figure 12-5, if the PWM value is less than or equal to zero, the PWM will be inactive for the entire period. Conversely, if the PWM value is greater than or equal to the timer modulus, the PWM will be active for the entire period. Refer to Table 12-3. NOTE The terms “active” and “inactive” refer to the asserted and negated states of the PWM signals and should not be confused with the high-impedance state of the PWM pins. Table 12-3. PWM Data Overflow and Underflow Conditions PWMVALxH:PWMVALxL $0000–$0FFF $1000–$7FFF $8000–$FFFF Condition Normal Overflow Underflow PWM Value Used Per register contents $FFF $000 MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 125 Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC) 12.5 Output Control This subsection discusses output control. 12.5.1 Selecting Six Independent PWMs or Three Complementary PWM Pairs The PWM outputs can be configured as six independent PWM channels or three complementary channel pairs. The option INDEP determines which mode is used (see 5.2 Functional Description). If complementary operation is chosen, the PWM pins are paired as shown in Figure 12-12. Operation of one pair is then determined by one PWM value register. This type of operation is meant for use in motor drive circuits such as the one in Figure 12-13. PWM1 PIN PWM VALUE REGISTER PWMS 1 AND 2 PWM2 PIN OUTPUT CONTROL POLARITY & DEAD-TIME INSERTION PWM3 PIN PWM4 PIN PWM VALUE REGISTER PWMS 3 AND 4 PWM5 PIN PWM VALUE REGISTER PWMS 5 AND 6 PWM6 PIN Figure 12-12. Complementary Pairing PWM 1 PWM 3 PWM 5 AC INPUTS PWM 2 PWM 4 PWM 6 TO MOTOR Figure 12-13. Typical AC Motor Drive MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 126 Freescale Semiconductor Output Control When complementary operation is used, two additional features are provided: • Dead-time insertion • Separate top/bottom pulse width correction to correct for distortions caused by the motor drive characteristics If independent operation is chosen, each PWM has its own PWM value register. 12.5.2 Dead-Time Insertion As shown in Figure 12-13, in complementary mode, each PWM pair can be used to drive top-side/bottom-side transistors. When controlling dc-to-ac inverters such as this, the top and bottom PWMs in one pair should never be active at the same time. In Figure 12-13, if PWM1 and PWM2 were on at the same time, large currents would flow through the two transistors as they discharge the bus capacitor. The IGBTs could be weakened or destroyed. Simply forcing the two PWMs to be inversions of each other is not always sufficient. Since a time delay is associated with turning off the transistors in the motor drive, there must be a dead-time between the deactivation of one PWM and the activation of the other. A dead-time can be specified in the dead-time write-once register. This 8-bit value specifies the number of CPU clock cycles to use for the dead-time. The dead-time is not affected by changes in the PWM period caused by the prescaler. Dead-time insertion is achieved by feeding the top PWM outputs of the PWM generator into dead-time generators, as shown in Figure 12-14. Current sensing determines which PWM value of a PWM generator pair to use for the top PWM in the next PWM cycle. See 12.5.3 Top/Bottom Correction with Motor Phase Current Polarity Sensing. When output control is enabled, the odd OUT bits, rather than the PWM generator outputs, are fed into the dead-time generators. See 12.5.5 PWM Output Port Control. Whenever an input to a dead-time generator transitions, a dead-time is inserted (for example, both PWMs in the pair are forced to their inactive state). The bottom PWM signal is generated from the top PWM and the dead-time. In the case of output control enabled, the odd OUTx bits control the top PWMs, the even OUTx bits control the bottom PWMs with respect to the odd OUTx bits (see Table 12-6). Figure 12-15 shows the effects of the dead-time insertion. As seen in Figure 12-15, some pulse width distortion occurs when the dead-time is inserted. The active pulse widths are reduced. For example, in Figure 12-15, when the PWM value register is equal to two, the ideal waveform (with no dead-time) has pulse widths equal to four. However, the actual pulse widths shrink to two after a dead-time of two was inserted. In this example, with the prescaler set to divide by one and center-aligned operation selected, this distortion can be compensated for by adding or subtracting half the dead-time value to or from the PWM register value. This correction is further described in 12.5.3 Top/Bottom Correction with Motor Phase Current Polarity Sensing. Further examples of dead-time insertion are shown in Figure 12-16 and Figure 12-17. Figure 12-16 shows the effects of dead-time insertion at the duty cycle boundaries (near 0 percent and 100 percent duty cycles). Figure 12-17 shows the effects of dead-time insertion on pulse widths smaller than the dead-time. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 127 Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC) OUTPUT CONTROL (OUTCTL) OUTCTL OUT5 OUT3 OUT1 OUT2 OUT4 OUT6 DEAD-TIME PWMPAIR12 (TOP) TOP/BOTTOM GENERATION MUX PWM (TOP) PREDT (TOP) OUTX SELECT PWMGEN CURRENT SENSING DEAD-TIME POSTDT (TOP) TOP (PWM1) BOTTOM (PWM2) POLARITY/OUTPUT DRIVE PWM1 PWM2 PWM GENERATOR 6 PREDT (TOP) OUTX SELECT DEAD-TIME POSTDT (TOP) BOTTOM (PWM4) FAULT PWM (TOP) DEAD-TIME PWMPAIR34 (TOP) TOP/BOTTOM GENERATION MUX TOP (PWM3) PWM3 PWM4 PWM (TOP) PREDT (TOP) OUTX SELECT DEAD-TIME PWMPAIR56 (TOP) TOP/BOTTOM GENERATION MUX DEAD-TIME POSTDT (TOP) TOP (PWM5) BOTTOM (PWM6) PWM5 PWM6 Figure 12-14. Dead-Time Generators MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 128 Freescale Semiconductor Output Control UP/DOWN COUNTER MODULUS = 4 PWM VALUE = 2 PWM VALUE = 2 PWM VALUE = 3 PWM1 W/ NO DEAD-TIME PWM2 W/ NO DEAD-TIME PWM1 W/ DEAD-TIME = 2 PWM2 W/ DEAD-TIME = 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 Figure 12-15. Effects of Dead-Time Insertion UP/DOWN COUNTER MODULUS = 3 PWM VALUE = 1 PWM VALUE = 1 PWM VALUE = 3 PWM VALUE = 3 PWM1 W/ NO DEAD-TIME PWM2 W/ NO DEAD-TIME PWM1 W/ DEAD-TIME = 2 PWM2 W/ DEAD-TIME = 2 2 2 2 2 Figure 12-16. Dead-Time at Duty Cycle Boundaries MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 129 Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC) UP/DOWN COUNTER MOUDULUS = 3 PWM VALUE = 2 PWM1 W/ NO DEAD-TIME PWM2 W/ NO DEAD-TIME PWM1 W/ DEAD-TIME = 3 PWM2 W/ DEAD-TIME = 3 PWM VALUE = 3 PWM VALUE = 2 PWM VALUE = 1 3 3 3 3 3 3 Figure 12-17. Dead-Time and Small Pulse Widths 12.5.3 Top/Bottom Correction with Motor Phase Current Polarity Sensing Ideally, when complementary pairs are used, the PWM pairs are inversions of each other, as shown in Figure 12-18. When PWM1 is active, PWM2 is inactive, and vice versa. In this case, the motor terminal voltage is never allowed to float and is strictly controlled by the PWM waveforms. UP/DOWN COUNTER MODULUS = 4 PWM1 PWM VALUE = 1 PWM2 PWM3 PWM VALUE = 2 PWM4 PWM5 PWM VALUE = 3 PWM6 Figure 12-18. Ideal Complementary Operation (Dead-Time = 0) However, when dead-time is inserted, the motor voltage is allowed to float momentarily during the dead-time interval, creating a distortion in the motor current waveform. This distortion is aggravated by dissimilar turn-on and turn-off delays of each of the transistors. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 130 Freescale Semiconductor Output Control For a typical motor drive inverter as shown in Figure 12-13, for a given top/bottom transistor pair, only one of the transistors will be effective in controlling the output voltage at any given time depending on the direction of the motor current for that pair. To achieve distortion correction, one of two different correction factors must be added to the desired PWM value, depending on whether the top or bottom transistor is controlling the output voltage. Therefore, the software is responsible for calculating both compensated PWM values and placing them in an odd/even PWM register pair. By supplying the PWM module with information regarding which transistor (top or bottom) is controlling the output voltage at any given time (for instance, the current polarity for that motor phase), the PWM module selects either the odd or even numbered PWM value register to be used by the PWM generator. Current sensing or programmable software bits are then used to determine which PWM value to use. If the current sensed at the motor for that PWM pair is positive (voltage on current pin ISx is low) or bit IPOLx in PWM control register 2 is low, the top PWM value is used for the PWM pair. Likewise, if the current sensed at the motor for that PWM pair is negative (voltage on current pin ISx is high) or bit IPOLx in PWM control register 2 is high, the bottom PWM value is used. See Table 12-4. NOTE This text assumes the user will provide current sense circuitry which causes the voltage at the corresponding input pin to be low for positive current and high for negative current. See Figure 12-19 for current convention. In addition, it assumes the top PWMs are PWMs 1, 3, and 5 while the bottom PWMs are PWMs 2, 4, and 6. Table 12-4. Current Sense Pins Current Sense Pin or Bit IS1 or IPOL1 IS1 or IPOL1 Voltage on Current Sense Pin or IPOLx Bit Logic 0 Logic 1 PWM Value Register Used PWM value register 1 PWM value register 2 PWMs Affected PWMs 1 and 2 PWMs 1 and 2 I+ I- Figure 12-19. Current Convention MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 131 Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC) To allow for correction based on different current sensing methods or correction controlled by software, the ISENS1 and ISENS0 bits in PWM control register 1 are provided to choose the correction method. These bits provide correction according to Table 12-5. Table 12-5. Correction Methods Current Correction Bits ISENS1 and ISENS0 00 01 10 Correction Method Bits IPOL1, IPOL2, and IPOL3 used for correction Current sensing on pins IS1, IS2, and IS3 occurs during the dead-time. Current sensing on pins IS1, IS2, and IS3 occurs at the half cycle in center-aligned mode and at the end of the cycle in edge-aligned mode. 11 If correction is to be done in software or is not necessary, setting ISENS1:ISENS0 = 00 or = 01 causes the correction to be based on bits IPOL1, IPOL2, and IPOL3 in PWM control register 2. If correction is not required, the user can initialize the IPOLx bits and then only load one PWM value register per PWM pair. To allow the user to use a current sense scheme based upon sensed phase voltage during dead-time, setting ISENS1:ISENS0 = 10 causes the polarity of the Ix pin to be latched when both the top and bottom PWMs are off (for example, during the dead-time). At the 0 percent and 100 percent duty cycle boundaries, there is no dead-time so no new current value is sensed. To accommodate other current sensing schemes, setting ISENS1:ISENS0 = 11 causes the polarity of the current sense pin to be latched half-way into the PWM cycle in center-aligned mode and at the end of the cycle in edge-aligned mode. Therefore, even at 0 percent and 100 percent duty cycle, the current is sensed. Distortion correction is only available in complementary mode. At the beginning of the PWM period, the PWM uses this latched current value or polarity bit to decide whether the top PWM value or bottom PWM value is used. Figure 12-20 shows an example of top/bottom correction for PWMs 1 and 2. NOTE The IPOLx bits and the values latched on the ISx pins are buffered so that only one PWM register is used per PWM cycle. If the IPOLx bits or the current sense values change during a PWM period, this new value will not be used until the next PWM period. The ISENSx bits are NOT buffered; therefore, changing the current sensing method could affect the present PWM cycle. When the PWM is first enabled by setting PWMEN, PWM value registers 1, 3, and 5 will be used if the ISENSx bits are configured for current sensing correction. This is because no current will have previously been sensed. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 132 Freescale Semiconductor Output Control PWM VALUE REG. 1 = 1 PWM VALUE REG. 2 = 2 IS1 POSITIVE PWM = 1 PWM1 IS1 POSITIVE PWM = 1 IS1 NEGATIVE PWM = 2 IS1 NEGATIVE PWM = 2 PWM2 Figure 12-20. Top/Bottom Correction for PWMs 1 and 2 12.5.4 Output Polarity The output polarity of the PWMs is determined by two options: TOPNEG and BOTNEG. The top polarity option, TOPNEG, controls the polarity of PWMs 1, 3, and 5. The bottom polarity option, BOTNEG, controls the polarity of PWMs 2, 4, and 6. Positive polarity means that when the PWM is active, the PWM output is high. Conversely, negative polarity means that when the PWM is active, PWM output is low. See Figure 12-21. NOTE Both bits are found in the CONFIG register, which is a write-once register. This reduces the chances of the software inadvertently changing the polarity of the PWM signals and possibly damaging the motor drive hardware. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 133 Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC) CENTER-ALIGNED POSITIVE POLARITY UP/DOWN COUNTER MODULUS = 4 EDGE-ALIGNED POSITIVE POLARITY UP-ONLY COUNTER MODULUS = 4 PWM = 4 CENTER-ALIGNED NEGATIVE POLARITY EDGE-ALIGNED NEGATIVE POLARITY UP-ONLY COUNTER MODULUS = 4 UP/DOWN COUNTER MODULUS = 4 PWM = 4 Figure 12-21. PWM Polarity MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 134 Freescale Semiconductor Output Control 12.5.5 PWM Output Port Control Conditions may arise in which the PWM pins need to be individually controlled. This is made possible by the PWM output control register (PWMOUT) shown in Figure 12-22. Address: Read: Write: Reset: 0 $0025 Bit 7 0 6 OUTCTL 0 5 OUT6 0 4 OUT5 0 3 OUT4 0 2 OUT3 0 1 OUT2 0 Bit 0 OUT1 0 = Unimplemented Figure 12-22. PWM Output Control Register (PWMOUT) If the OUTCTL bit is set, the PWM pins can be controlled by the OUTx bits. These bits behave according to Table 12-6. Table 12-6. OUTx Bits OUTx Bit OUT1 OUT2 OUT3 OUT4 OUT5 OUT6 Complementary Mode 1 — PWM1 is active. 0 — PWM1 is inactive. 1 — PWM2 is complement of PWM 1. 0 — PWM2 is inactive. 1 — PWM3 is active. 0 — PWM3 is inactive. 1 — PWM4 is complement of PWM 3. 0 — PWM4 is inactive. 1 — PWM5 is active. 0 — PWM5 is inactive. 1 — PWM 6 is complement of PWM 5. 0 — PWM6 is inactive. Independent Mode 1 — PWM1 is active. 0 — PWM1 is inactive. 1 — PWM2 is active. 0 — PWM2 is inactive. 1 — PWM3 is active. 0 — PWM3 is inactive. 1 — PWM4 is active. 0 — PWM4 is inactive. 1 — PWM5 is active. 0 — PWM5 is inactive. 1 — PWM6 is active. 0 — PWM6 is inactive. When OUTCTL is set, the polarity options TOPPOL and BOTPOL will still affect the outputs. In addition, if complementary operation is in use, the PWM pairs will not be allowed to be active simultaneously, and dead-time will still not be violated. When OUTCTL is set and complementary operation is in use, the odd OUTx bits are inputs to the dead-time generators as shown in Figure 12-15. Dead-time is inserted whenever the odd OUTx bit toggles as shown in Figure 12-23. Although dead-time is not inserted when the even OUTx bits change, there will be no dead-time violation as shown in Figure 12-24. Setting the OUTCTL bit does not disable the PWM generator and current sensing circuitry. They continue to run, but are no longer controlling the output pins. In addition, OUTCTL will control the PWM pins even when PWMEN = 0. When OUTCTL is cleared, the outputs of the PWM generator become the inputs to the dead-time and output circuitry at the beginning of the next PWM cycle. NOTE To avoid an unexpected dead-time occurrence, it is recommended that the OUTx bits be cleared prior to entering and prior to exiting individual PWM output control mode. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 135 Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC) UP/DOWN COUNTER MODULUS = 4 DEAD-TIME = 2 PWM VALUE = 3 OUTCTL OUT1 OUT2 PWM1 PWM2 PWM1/PWM2 DEAD-TIME 2 2 2 DEAD-TIME INSERTED DUE TO CLEARING OF OUT1 BIT DEAD-TIME INSERTED AS PART OF DEAD-TIME INSERTED DUE NORMAL PWM OPERATION AS TO SETTING OF OUT1 BIT CONTROLLED BY CURRENT SENSING AND PWM GENERATOR Figure 12-23. Dead-Time Insertion During OUTCTL = 1 UP/DOWN COUNTER MODULUS = 4 DEAD-TIME = 2 PWM VALUE = 3 OUTCTL OUT1 OUT2 PWM1 PWM2 PWM1/PWM2 DEAD-TIME 2 2 DEAD-TIME INSERTED BECAUSE WHEN OUTCTL WAS SET, THE STATE OF OUT1 WAS SUCH THAT PWM1 WAS DIRECTED TO TOGGLE 2 2 NO DEAD-TIME INSERTED BECAUSE OUT1 IS NOT TOGGLING DEAD-TIME INSERTED BECAUSE OUT1 TOGGLES, DIRECTING PWM1 TO TOGGLE Figure 12-24. Dead-Time Insertion During OUTCTL = 1 MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 136 Freescale Semiconductor Fault Protection 12.6 Fault Protection Conditions may arise in the external drive circuitry which require that the PWM signals become inactive immediately, such as an overcurrent fault condition. Furthermore, it may be desirable to selectively disable PWM(s) solely with software. One or more PWM pins can be disabled (forced to their inactive state) by applying a logic high to any of the four external fault pins or by writing a logic high to either of the disable bits (DISX and DISY in PWM control register 1). Figure 12-26 shows the structure of the PWM disabling scheme. While the PWM pins are disabled, they are forced to their inactive state. The PWM generator continues to run — only the output pins are disabled. To allow for different motor configurations and the controlling of more than one motor, the PWM disabling function is organized as two banks, bank X and bank Y. Bank information combines with information from the disable mapping register to allow selective PWM disabling. Fault pin 1, fault pin 2, and PWM disable bit X constitute the disabling function of bank X. Fault pin 3, fault pin 4, and PWM disable bit Y constitute the disabling function of bank Y. Figure 12-25 and Figure 12-27 show the disable mapping write-once register and the decoding scheme of the bank which selectively disables PWM(s). When all bits of the disable mapping register are set, any disable condition will disable all PWMs. A fault can also generate a CPU interrupt. Each fault pin has its own interrupt vector. Address: $0037 Bit 7 Read: Write: Reset: Bit 7 1 6 Bit 6 1 5 Bit 5 1 4 Bit 4 1 3 Bit 3 1 2 Bit 2 1 1 Bit 1 1 Bit 0 Bit 0 1 Figure 12-25. PWM Disable Mapping Write-Once Register (DISMAP) 12.6.1 Fault Condition Input Pins A logic high level on a fault pin disables the respective PWM(s) determined by the bank and the disable mapping register. Each fault pin incorporates a filter to assist in rejecting spurious faults. All of the external fault pins are software-configurable to re-enable the PWMs either with the fault pin (automatic mode) or with software (manual mode). Each fault pin has an associated FMODE bit to control the PWM re-enabling method. Automatic mode is selected by setting the FMODEx bit in the fault control register. Manual mode is selected when FMODEx is clear. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 137 Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC) DISX CYCLE START SOFTWARE X DISABLE S R BANK X DISABLE Q FMODE2 LOGIC HIGH FOR FAULT TWO SAMPLE FILTER ONE SHOT FPIN2 S R CLEAR BY WRITING 1 TO FTACK4 Q FFLAG2 AUTO MODE FAULT PIN 2 DISABLE S R MANUAL MODE Q FAULT PIN2 INTERRUPT REQUEST FINT2 The example is of fault pin 2 with DISX. Fault pin 4 with DISY is logically similar and affects BANK Y disable. Note: In manual mode (FMODE = 0), faults 2 and 4 may be cleared only if a logic level low at the input of the fault pin is present. CYCLE START FMODE1 FPIN1 LOGIC HIGH FOR FAULT FAULT PIN1 TWO SAMPLE FILTER ONE SHOT S R CLEAR BY WRITING 1 TO FTACK1 FINT1 Q FFLAG1 AUTO MODE FAULT PIN 1 DISABLE S R MANUAL MODE Q BANK X DISABLE INTERRUPT REQUEST The example is of fault pin 1. Fault pin 3 is logically similar and affects BANK Y disable. Note: In manual mode (FMODE = 0), faults 1 and 3 may be cleared regardless of the logic level at the input of the fault pin. Figure 12-26. PWM Disabling Scheme MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 138 Freescale Semiconductor Fault Protection BIT 7 DISABLE PWM PIN 1 BIT 6 BIT 5 DISABLE PWM PIN 2 BANK X DISABLE BANK Y DISABLE BIT 4 BIT 3 DISABLE PWM PIN 3 DISABLE PWM PIN 4 BIT 2 BIT 1 BIT 0 DISABLE PWM PIN 6 DISABLE PWM PIN 5 Figure 12-27. PWM Disabling Decode Scheme 12.6.1.1 Fault Pin Filter Each fault pin incorporates a filter to assist in determining a genuine fault condition. After a fault pin has been logic low for one CPU cycle, a rising edge (logic high) will be synchronously sampled once per CPU cycle for two cycles. If both samples are detected logic high, the corresponding FPIN bit and FFLAG bit will be set. The FPIN bit will remain set until the corresponding fault pin is logic low and synchronously sampled once in the following CPU cycle. 12.6.1.2 Automatic Mode In automatic mode, the PWM(s) are disabled immediately once a filtered fault condition is detected (logic high). The PWM(s) remain disabled until the filtered fault condition is cleared (logic low) and a new PWM cycle begins as shown in Figure 12-28. Clearing the corresponding FFLAGx event bit will not enable the PWMs in automatic mode. The filtered fault pin’s logic state is reflected in the respective FPINx bit. Any write to this bit is overwritten by the pin state. The FFLAGx event bit is set with each rising edge of the respective fault pin after filtering has been applied. To clear the FFLAGx bit, the user must write a 1 to the corresponding FTACKx bit. f the FINTx bit is set, a fault condition resulting in setting the corresponding FFLAG bit will also latch a CPU interrupt request. The interrupt request latch is not cleared until one of these actions occurs: • The FFLAGx bit is cleared by writing a 1 to the corresponding FTACKx bit. • The FINTx bit is cleared. This will not clear the FFLAGx bit. • A reset automatically clears all four interrupt latches. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 139 Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC) FILTERED FAULT PIN PWM(S) ENABLED PWM(S) DISABLED (INACTIVE) PWM(S) ENABLED Figure 12-28. PWM Disabling in Automatic Mode IIf prior to a vector fetch, the interrupt request latch is cleared by one of the actions listed, a CPU interrupt will no longer be requested. A vector fetch does not alter the state of the PWMs, the FFLAGx event flag, or FINTx. NOTE If the FFLAGx or FINTx bits are not cleared during the interrupt service routine, the interrupt request latch will not be cleared. 12.6.1.3 Manual Mode In manual mode, the PWM(s) are disabled immediately once a filtered fault condition is detected (logic high). The PWM(s) remain disabled until software clears the corresponding FFLAGx event bit and a new PWM cycle begins. In manual mode, the fault pins are grouped in pairs, each pair sharing common functionality. A fault condition on pins 1 and 3 may be cleared, allowing the PWM(s) to enable at the start of a PWM cycle regardless of the logic level at the fault pin. See Figure 12-29. A fault condition on pins 2 and 4 can only be cleared, allowing the PWM(s) to enable, if a logic low level at the fault pin is present at the start of a PWM cycle. See Figure 12-30. The function of the fault control and event bits is the same as in automatic mode except that the PWMs are not re-enabled until the FFLAGx event bit is cleared by writing to the FTACKx bit and the filtered fault condition is cleared (logic low). FILTERED FAULT PIN 1 OR 3 PWM(S) ENABLED PWM(S) DISABLED PWM(S) ENABLED FFLAGX CLEARED Figure 12-29. PWM Disabling in Manual Mode (Example 1) MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 140 Freescale Semiconductor Fault Protection FILTERED FAULT PIN 2 OR 4 PWM(S) ENABLED PWM(S) DISABLED PWM(S) ENABLED FFLAGX CLEARED Figure 12-30. PWM Disabling in Manual Mode (Example 2) 12.6.2 Software Output Disable Setting PWM disable bit DISX or DISY in PWM control register 1 immediately disables the corresponding PWM pins as determined by the bank and disable mapping register. The PWM pin(s) remain disabled until the PWM disable bit is cleared and a new PWM cycle begins as shown in Figure 12-31. Setting a PWM disable bit does not latch a CPU interrupt request, and there are no event flags associated with the PWM disable bits. 12.6.3 Output Port Control When operating the PWMs using the OUTx bits (OUTCTL = 1), fault protection applies as described in this section. Due to the absence of periodic PWM cycles, fault conditions are cleared upon each CPU cycle and the PWM outputs are re-enabled, provided all fault clearing conditions are satisfied. DISABLE BIT PWM(S) ENABLED PWM(S) DISABLED PWM(S) ENABLED Figure 12-31. PWM Software Disable MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 141 Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC) 12.7 Initialization and the PWMEN Bit For proper operation, all registers should be initialized and the LDOK bit should be set before enabling the PWM via the PWMEN bit. When the PWMEN bit is first set, a reload will occur immediately, setting the PWMF flag and generating an interrupt if PWMINT is set. In addition, in complementary mode, PWM value registers 1, 3, and 5 will be used for the first PWM cycle if current sensing is selected. NOTE If the LDOK bit is not set when PWMEN is set after a RESET, the prescaler and PWM values will be 0, but the modulus will be unknown. If the LDOK bit is not set after the PWMEN bit has been cleared then set (without a RESET), the modulus value that was last loaded will be used. If the dead-time register (DEADTM) is changed after PWMEN or OUTCTL is set, an improper dead-time insertion could occur. However, the dead-time can never be shorter than the specified value. Because of the equals-comparator architecture of this PWM, the modulus = 0 case is considered illegal. Therefore, the modulus register is not reset, and a modulus value of 0 will result in waveforms inconsistent with the other modulus waveforms. See 12.9.2 PWM Counter Modulo Registers. When PWMEN is set, the PWM pins change from high impedance to outputs. At this time, assuming no fault condition is present, the PWM pins will drive according to the PWM values, polarity, and dead-time. See the timing diagram in Figure 12-32. CPU CLOCK PWMEN DRIVE ACCORDING TO PWM VALUE, POLARITY, AND DEAD-TIME PWM PINS HI-Z IF OUTCTL = 0 HI-Z IF OUTCTL = 0 Figure 12-32. PWMEN and PWM Pins When the PWMEN bit is cleared, this will occur: • PWM pins will be three-stated unless OUTCTL = 1. • PWM counter is cleared and will not be clocked. • Internally, the PWM generator will force its outputs to 0 to avoid glitches when the PWMEN is set again. When PWMEN is cleared, these features remain active: • All fault circuitry • Manual PWM pin control via the PWMOUT register • Dead-time insertion when PWM pins change via the PWMOUT register NOTE The PWMF flag and pending CPU interrupts are NOT cleared when PWMEN = 0. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 142 Freescale Semiconductor PWM Operation in Wait Mode 12.8 PWM Operation in Wait Mode When the microcontroller is put in low-power wait mode via the WAIT instruction, all clocks to the PWM module will continue to run. If an interrupt is issued from the PWM module (via a reload or a fault), the microcontroller will exit wait mode. Clearing the PWMEN bit before entering wait mode will reduce power consumption in wait mode because the counter, prescaler divider, and LDFQ divider will no longer be clocked. In addition, power will be reduced because the PWMs will no longer toggle. 12.9 Control Logic Block This subsection provides a description of the control logic block. 12.9.1 PWM Counter Registers The PWM counter registers (PCNTH and PCNTL) display the 12-bit up/down or up-only counter. When the high byte of the counter is read, the lower byte is latched. PCNTL will hold this latched value until it is read. See Figure 12-33 and Figure 12-34. Address: Read: Write: Reset: 0 0 = Unimplemented 0 0 0 0 0 0 $0026 Bit 7 0 6 0 5 0 4 0 3 Bit 11 2 Bit 10 1 Bit 9 Bit 0 Bit 8 Figure 12-33. PWM Counter Register High (PCNTH) Address: Read: Write: Reset: 0 0 = Unimplemented 0 0 0 0 0 0 $0027 Bit 7 Bit 7 6 Bit 6 5 Bit 5 4 Bit 4 3 Bit 3 2 Bit 2 1 Bit 1 Bit 0 Bit 0 Figure 12-34. PWM Counter Register Low (PCNTL) MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 143 Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC) 12.9.2 PWM Counter Modulo Registers The PWM counter modulus registers (PMODH and PMODL) hold a 12-bit unsigned number that determines the maximum count for the up/down or up-only counter. In center-aligned mode, the PWM period will be twice the modulus (assuming no prescaler). In edge-aligned mode, the PWM period will equal the modulus. See Figure 12-35 and Figure 12-36. Address: Read: Write: Reset: 0 0 = Unimplemented 0 0 X = Indeterminate $0028 Bit 7 0 6 0 5 0 4 0 3 Bit 11 X 2 Bit 10 X 1 Bit 9 X Bit 0 Bit 8 X Figure 12-35. PWM Counter Modulo Register High (PMODH) Address: Read: Write: Reset: $0029 Bit 7 Bit 7 X X = Indeterminate 6 Bit 6 X 5 Bit 5 X 4 Bit 4 X 3 Bit 3 X 2 Bit 2 X 1 Bit 1 X Bit 0 Bit 0 X Figure 12-36. PWM Counter Modulo Register Low (PMODL) To avoid erroneous PWM periods, this value is buffered and will not be used by the PWM generator until the LDOK bit has been set and the next PWM load cycle begins. NOTE When reading this register, the value read is the buffer (not necessarily the value the PWM generator is currently using). Because of the equals-comparator architecture of this PWM, the modulus = 0 case is considered illegal. Therefore, the modulus register is not reset, and a modulus value of 0 will result in waveforms inconsistent with the other modulus waveforms. If a modulus of 0 is loaded, the counter will continually count down from $FFF. This operation will not be tested or guaranteed (the user should consider it illegal). However, the dead-time constraints and fault conditions will still be guaranteed. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 144 Freescale Semiconductor Control Logic Block 12.9.3 PWMx Value Registers Each of the six PWMs has a 16-bit PWM value register. Bit 7 Read: Write: Reset: 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 Bit 15 0 Bold Bit 14 0 = Buffered Bit 13 0 Bit 12 0 Bit 11 0 Bit 10 0 Bit 9 0 Bit 8 0 Figure 12-37. PWMx Value Registers High (PVALxH) Bit 7 Read: Write: Reset: 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 Bit 7 0 Bold Bit 6 0 = Buffered Bit 5 0 Bit 4 0 Bit 3 0 Bit 2 0 Bit 1 0 Bit 0 0 Figure 12-38. PWMx Value Registers Low (PVALxL) The 16-bit signed value stored in this register determines the duty cycle of the PWM. The duty cycle is defined as: (PWM value/modulus) x 100. Writing a number less than or equal to 0 causes the PWM to be off for the entire PWM period. Writing a number greater than or equal to the 12-bit modulus causes the PWM to be on for the entire PWM period. If the complementary mode is selected, the PWM pairs share PWM value registers. To avoid erroneous PWM pulses, this value is buffered and will not be used by the PWM generator until the LDOK bit has been set and the next PWM load cycle begins. NOTE When reading these registers, the value read is the buffer (not necessarily the value the PWM generator is currently using). MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 145 Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC) 12.9.4 PWM Control Register 1 PWM control register 1 (PCTL1) controls PWM enabling/disabling, the loading of new modulus, prescaler, PWM values, and the PWM correction method. In addition, this register contains the software disable bits to force the PWM outputs to their inactive states (according to the disable mapping register). Address: Read: Write: Reset: $0020 Bit 7 DISX 0 6 DISY 0 5 PWMINT 0 4 PWMF 0 3 ISENS1 0 2 ISENS0 0 1 LDOK 0 Bit 0 PWMEN 0 Figure 12-39. PWM Control Register 1 (PCTL1) DISX — Software Disable Bit for Bank X Bit This read/write bit allows the user to disable one or more PWM pins in bank X. The pins that are disabled are determined by the disable mapping write-once register. 1 = Disable PWM pins in bank X. 0 = Re-enable PWM pins at beginning of next PWM cycle. DISY — Software Disable Bit for Bank Y Bit This read/write bit allows the user to disable one or more PWM pins in bank Y. The pins that are disabled are determined by the disable mapping write-once register. 1 = Disable PWM pins in bank Y. 0 = Re-enable PWM pins at beginning of next PWM cycle. PWMINT — PWM Interrupt Enable Bit This read/write bit allows the user to enable and disable PWM CPU interrupts. If set, a CPU interrupt will be pending when the PWMF flag is set. 1 = Enable PWM CPU interrupts. 0 = Disable PWM CPU interrupts. NOTE When PWMINT is cleared, pending CPU interrupts are inhibited. PWMF — PWM Reload Flag This read/write bit is set at the beginning of every reload cycle regardless of the state of the LDOK bit. This bit is cleared by reading PWM control register 1 with the PWMF flag set, then writing a logic 0 to PWMF. If another reload occurs before the clearing sequence is complete, then writing logic 0 to PWMF has no effect. 1 = New reload cycle began. 0 = New reload cycle has not begun. NOTE When PWMF is cleared, pending PWM CPU interrupts are cleared (not including fault interrupts). ISENS1 and ISENS0 — Current Sense Correction Bits These read/write bits select the top/bottom correction scheme as shown in Table 12-7. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 146 Freescale Semiconductor Control Logic Block Table 12-7. Correction Methods Current Correction Bits ISENS1 and ISENS0 00 01 10 Correction Method Bits IPOL1, IPOL2, and IPOL3 are used for correction. Current sensing on pins IS1, IS2, and IS3 occurs during the dead-time. Current sensing on pins IS1, IS2, and IS3 occurs at the half cycle in center-aligned mode and at the end of the cycle in edge-aligned mode. 11 1. The polarity of the ISx pin is latched when both the top and bottom PWMs are off. At the 0% and 100% duty cycle boundaries, there is no dead-time, so no new current value is sensed. 2. Current is sensed even with 0% and 100% duty cycle. NOTE The ISENSx bits are not buffered. Changing the current sensing method can affect the present PWM cycle. LDOK— Load OK Bit This read/write bit loads the prescaler bits of the PMCTL2 register and the entire PMMODH/L and PWMVALH/L registers into a set of buffers. The buffered prescaler divisor, PWM counter modulus value, and PWM pulse will take effect at the next PWM load. Set LDOK by reading it when it is logic 0 and then writing a logic 1 to it. LDOK is automatically cleared after the new values are loaded or can be manually cleared before a reload by writing a 0 to it. Reset clears LDOK. 1 = Load prescaler, modulus, and PWM values. 0 = Do not load new modulus, prescaler, and PWM values. NOTE The user should initialize the PWM registers and set the LDOK bit before enabling the PWM. A PWM CPU interrupt request can still be generated when LDOK is 0. PWMEN — PWM Module Enable Bit This read/write bit enables and disables the PWM generator and the PWM pins. When PWMEN is clear, the PWM generator is disabled and the PWM pins are in the high-impedance state (unless OUTCTL = 1). When the PWMEN bit is set, the PWM generator and PWM pins are activated. For more information, see 12.7 Initialization and the PWMEN Bit. 1 = PWM generator and PWM pins enabled 0 = PWM generator and PWM pins disabled MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 147 Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC) 12.9.5 PWM Control Register 2 PWM control register 2 (PCTL2) controls the PWM load frequency, the PWM correction method, and the PWM counter prescaler. For ease of software and to avoid erroneous PWM periods, some of these register bits are buffered. The PWM generator will not use the prescaler value until the LDOK bit has been set, and a new PWM cycle is starting. The correction bits are used at the beginning of each PWM cycle (if the ISENSx bits are configured for software correction). The load frequency bits are not used until the current load cycle is complete. See Figure 12-40. NOTE The user should initialize this register before enabling the PWM. Address: Read: Write: Reset: $0021 Bit 7 LDFQ1 0 6 LDFQ0 0 5 0 0 4 IPOL1 0 Bold 3 IPOL2 0 = Buffered 2 IPOL3 0 1 PRSC1 0 Bit 0 PRSC0 0 = Unimplemented Figure 12-40. PWM Control Register 2 (PCTL2) LDFQ1 and LDFQ0 — PWM Load Frequency Bits These buffered read/write bits select the PWM CPU load frequency according to Table 12-8. NOTE When reading these bits, the value read is the buffer value (not necessarily the value the PWM generator is currently using). The LDFQx bits take effect when the current load cycle is complete regardless of the state of the load okay bit, LDOK. Table 12-8. PWM Reload Frequency Reload Frequency Bits LDFQ1 and LDFQ0 00 01 10 11 PWM Reload Frequency Every PWM cycle Every 2 PWM cycles Every 4 PWM cycles Every 8 PWM cycles NOTE Reading the LPFQx bit reads the buffered values and not necessarily the values currently in effect. IPOL1 — Top/Bottom Correction Bit for PWM Pair 1 (PWMs 1 and 2) This buffered read/write bit selects which PWM value register is used if top/bottom correction is to be achieved without current sensing. 1 = Use PWM value register 2. 0 = Use PWM value register 1. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 148 Freescale Semiconductor Control Logic Block NOTE When reading this bit, the value read is the buffer value (not necessarily the value the output control block is currently using). The IPOLx bits take effect at the beginning of the next load cycle, regardless of the state of the load okay bit, LDOK. IPOL2 — Top/Bottom Correction Bit for PWM Pair 2 (PWMs 3 and 4) This buffered read/write bit selects which PWM value register is used if top/bottom correction is to be achieved without current sensing. 1 = Use PWM value register 4. 0 = Use PWM value register 3. NOTE When reading this bit, the value read is the buffer value (not necessarily the value the output control block is currently using). IPOL3 — Top/Bottom Correction Bit for PWM Pair 3 (PWMs 5 and 6) This buffered read/write bit selects which PWM value register is used if top/bottom correction is to be achieved without current sensing. 1 = Use PWM value register 6. 0 = Use PWM value register 5. NOTE When reading this bit, the value read is the buffer value (not necessarily the value the output control block is currently using). PRSC1 and PRSC0 — PWM Prescaler Bits These buffered read/write bits allow the PWM clock frequency to be modified as shown in Table 12-9. NOTE When reading these bits, the value read is the buffer value (not necessarily the value the PWM generator is currently using). Table 12-9. PWM Prescaler Prescaler Bits PRSC1 and PRSC0 00 01 10 11 PWM Clock Frequency fOP fOP/2 fOP/4 fOP/8 MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 149 Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC) 12.9.6 Dead-Time Write-Once Register The dead-time write-once register (DEADTM) holds an 8-bit value which specifies the number of CPU clock cycles to use for the dead-time when complementary PWM mode is selected. After this register is written for the first time, it cannot be rewritten unless a reset occurs. Dead-time is not affected by changes to the prescaler value. Address: Read: Write: Reset: $0036 Bit 7 Bit 7 1 6 Bit 6 1 5 Bit 5 1 4 Bit 4 1 3 Bit 3 1 2 Bit 2 1 1 Bit 1 1 Bit 0 Bit 0 1 Figure 12-41. Dead-Time Write-Once Register (DEADTM) 12.9.7 PWM Disable Mapping Write-Once Register The PWM disable mapping write-once register (DISMAP) holds an 8-bit value which determines which PWM pins will be disabled if an external fault or software disable occurs. For a further description of disable mapping, see 12.6 Fault Protection. After this register is written for the first time, it cannot be rewritten unless a reset occurs. Address: Read: Write: Reset: $0037 Bit 7 Bit 7 1 6 Bit 6 1 5 Bit 5 1 4 Bit 4 1 3 Bit 3 1 2 Bit 2 1 1 Bit 1 1 Bit 0 Bit 0 1 Figure 12-42. PWM Disable Mapping Write-Once Register (DISMAP) 12.9.8 Fault Control Register The fault control register (FCR) controls the fault-protection circuitry. Address: $0022 Bit 7 Read: Write: Reset: FINT4 0 6 FMODE4 0 5 FINT3 0 4 FMODE3 0 3 FINT2 0 2 FMODE2 0 1 FINT1 0 Bit 0 FMODE1 0 Figure 12-43. Fault Control Register (FCR) FINT4 — Fault 4 Interrupt Enable Bit This read/write bit allows the CPU interrupt caused by faults on fault pin 4 to be enabled. The fault protection circuitry is independent of this bit and will always be active. If a fault is detected, the PWM pins will still be disabled according to the disable mapping register. 1 = Fault pin 4 will cause CPU interrupts. 0 = Fault pin 4 will not cause CPU interrupts. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 150 Freescale Semiconductor Control Logic Block FMODE4 —Fault Mode Selection for Fault Pin 4 Bit (automatic versus manual mode) This read/write bit allows the user to select between automatic and manual mode faults. For further descriptions of each mode, see 12.6 Fault Protection. 1 = Automatic mode 0 = Manual mode FINT3 — Fault 3 Interrupt Enable Bit This read/write bit allows the CPU interrupt caused by faults on fault pin 3 to be enabled. The fault protection circuitry is independent of this bit and will always be active. If a fault is detected, the PWM pins will still be disabled according to the disable mapping register. 1 = Fault pin 3 will cause CPU interrupts. 0 = Fault pin 3 will not cause CPU interrupts. FMODE3 —Fault Mode Selection for Fault Pin 3 Bit (automatic versus manual mode) This read/write bit allows the user to select between automatic and manual mode faults. For further descriptions of each mode, see 12.6 Fault Protection. 1 = Automatic mode 0 = Manual mode FINT2 — Fault 2 Interrupt Enable Bit This read/write bit allows the CPU interrupt caused by faults on fault pin 2 to be enabled. The fault protection circuitry is independent of this bit and will always be active. If a fault is detected, the PWM pins will still be disabled according to the disable mapping register. 1 = Fault pin 2 will cause CPU interrupts. 0 = Fault pin 2 will not cause CPU interrupts. FMODE2 —Fault Mode Selection for Fault Pin 2 Bit (automatic versus manual mode) This read/write bit allows the user to select between automatic and manual mode faults. For further descriptions of each mode, see 12.6 Fault Protection. 1 = Automatic mode 0 = Manual mode FINT1 — Fault 1 Interrupt Enable Bit This read/write bit allows the CPU interrupt caused by faults on fault pin 1 to be enabled. The fault protection circuitry is independent of this bit and will always be active. If a fault is detected, the PWM pins will still be disabled according to the disable mapping register. 1 = Fault pin 1 will cause CPU interrupts. 0 = Fault pin 1 will not cause CPU interrupts. FMODE1 —Fault Mode Selection for Fault Pin 1 Bit (automatic versus manual mode) This read/write bit allows the user to select between automatic and manual mode faults. For further descriptions of each mode, see 12.6 Fault Protection. 1 = Automatic mode 0 = Manual mode MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 151 Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC) 12.9.9 Fault Status Register The fault status register (FSR) is a read-only register that indicates the current fault status. Address: Read: Write: Reset: U 0 U 0 U = Unaffected U 0 U 0 = Unimplemented $0023 Bit 7 FPIN4 6 FFLAG4 5 FPIN3 4 FFLAG3 3 FPIN2 2 FFLAG2 1 FPIN1 Bit 0 FFLAG1 Figure 12-44. Fault Status Register (FSR) FPIN4 — State of Fault Pin 4 Bit This read-only bit allows the user to read the current state of fault pin 4. 1 = Fault pin 4 is at logic 1. 0 = Fault pin 4 is at logic 0. FFLAG4 — Fault Event Flag 4 The FFLAG4 event bit is set within two CPU cycles after a rising edge on fault pin 4. To clear the FFLAG4 bit, the user must write a 1 to the FTACK4 bit in the fault acknowledge register. 1 = A fault has occurred on fault pin 4. 0 = No new fault on fault pin 4 FPIN3 — State of Fault Pin 3 Bit This read-only bit allows the user to read the current state of fault pin 3. 1 = Fault pin 3 is at logic 1. 0 = Fault pin 3 is at logic 0. FFLAG3 — Fault Event Flag 3 The FFLAG3 event bit is set within two CPU cycles after a rising edge on fault pin 3. To clear the FFLAG3 bit, the user must write a 1 to the FTACK3 bit in the fault acknowledge register. 1 = A fault has occurred on fault pin 3. 0 = No new fault on fault pin 3. FPIN2 — State of Fault Pin 2 Bit This read-only bit allows the user to read the current state of fault pin 2. 1 = Fault pin 2 is at logic 1. 0 = Fault pin 2 is at logic 0. FFLAG2 — Fault Event Flag 2 The FFLAG2 event bit is set within two CPU cycles after a rising edge on fault pin 2. To clear the FFLAG2 bit, the user must write a 1 to the FTACK2 bit in the fault acknowledge register. 1 = A fault has occurred on fault pin 2. 0 = No new fault on fault pin 2 FPIN1 — State of Fault Pin 1 Bit This read-only bit allows the user to read the current state of fault pin 1. 1 = Fault pin 1 is at logic 1. 0 = Fault pin 1 is at logic 0. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 152 Freescale Semiconductor Control Logic Block FFLAG1 — Fault Event Flag 1 The FFLAG1 event bit is set within two CPU cycles after a rising edge on fault pin 1. To clear the FFLAG1 bit, the user must write a 1 to the FTACK1 bit in the fault acknowledge register. 1 = A fault has occurred on fault pin 1. 0 = No new fault on fault pin 1. 12.9.10 Fault Acknowledge Register The fault acknowledge register (FTACK) is used to acknowledge and clear the FFLAGs. In addition, it is used to monitor the current sensing bits to test proper operation. Address: $0024 Bit 7 Read: Write: Reset: 0 0 6 0 FTACK4 0 0 = Unimplemented 5 DT6 4 DT5 FTACK3 0 0 3 DT4 2 DT3 FTACK2 0 0 1 DT2 Bit 0 DT1 FTACK1 0 Figure 12-45. Fault Acknowledge Register (FTACK) FTACK4 — Fault Acknowledge 4 Bit The FTACK4 bit is used to acknowledge and clear FFLAG4. This bit will always read 0. Writing a 1 to this bit will clear FFLAG4. Writing a 0 will have no effect. FTACK3 — Fault Acknowledge 3 Bit The FTACK3 bit is used to acknowledge and clear FFLAG3. This bit will always read 0. Writing a 1 to this bit will clear FFLAG3. Writing a 0 will have no effect. FTACK2 — Fault Acknowledge 2 Bit The FTACK2 bit is used to acknowledge and clear FFLAG2. This bit will always read 0. Writing a 1 to this bit will clear FFLAG2. Writing a 0 will have no effect. FTACK1 — Fault Acknowledge 1 Bit The FTACK1 bit is used to acknowledge and clear FFLAG1. This bit will always read 0. Writing a 1 to this bit will clear FFLAG1. Writing a 0 will have no effect. DT6 — Dead-Time 6 Bit Current sensing pin IS3 is monitored immediately before dead-time ends due to the assertion of PWM6. DT5 — Dead-Time 5 Bit Current sensing pin IS3 is monitored immediately before dead-time ends due to the assertion of PWM5. DT4 — Dead-Time 4 Bit Current sensing pin IS2 is monitored immediately before dead-time ends due to the assertion of PWM4. DT3 — Dead-Time 3 Bit Current sensing pin IS2 is monitored immediately before dead-time ends due to the assertion of PWM3. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 153 Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC) DT2 — Dead-Time 2 Bit Current sensing pin IS1 is monitored immediately before dead-time ends due to the assertion of PWM2. DT1 — Dead-Time 1 Bit Current sensing pin IS1 is monitored immediately before dead-time ends due to the assertion of PWM1. 12.9.11 PWM Output Control Register The PWM output control register (PWMOUT) is used to manually control the PWM pins. Address: $0025 Bit 7 Read: Write: Reset: 0 0 6 OUTCTL 0 5 OUT6 0 4 OUT5 0 3 OUT4 0 2 OUT3 0 1 OUT2 0 Bit 0 OUT1 0 = Unimplemented Figure 12-46. PWM Output Control Register (PWMOUT) OUTCTL— Output Control Enable Bit This read/write bit allows the user to manually control the PWM pins. When set, the PWM generator is no longer the input to the dead-time and output circuitry. The OUTx bits determine the state of the PWM pins. Setting the OUTCTL bit does not disable the PWM generator. The generator continues to run, but is no longer the input to the PWM dead-time and output circuitry. When OUTCTL is cleared, the outputs of the PWM generator immediately become the inputs to the dead-time and output circuitry. 1 = PWM outputs controlled manually 0 = PWM outputs determined by PWM generator OUT6–OUT1— PWM Pin Output Control Bits These read/write bits control the PWM pins according to Table 12-10. Table 12-10. OUTx Bits OUTx Bit OUT1 OUT2 OUT3 OUT4 OUT5 OUT6 Complementary Mode 1 — PWM1 is active. 0 — PWM1 is inactive. 1 — PWM2 is complement of PWM 1. 0 — PWM2 is inactive. 1 — PWM3 is active. 0 — PWM3 is inactive. 1 — PWM4 is complement of PWM 3. 0 — PWM4 is inactive. 1 — PWM5 is active. 0 — PWM5 is inactive. 1 — PWM 6 is complement of PWM 5. 0 — PWM6 is inactive. Independent Mode 1 — PWM1 is active. 0 — PWM1 is inactive. 1 — PWM2 is active. 0 — PWM2 is inactive. 1 — PWM3 is active. 0 — PWM3 is inactive. 1 — PWM4 is active. 0 — PWM4 is inactive. 1 — PWM5 is active. 0 — PWM5 is inactive. 1 — PWM6 is active. 0 — PWM6 is inactive. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 154 Freescale Semiconductor PWM Glossary 12.10 PWM Glossary CPU cycle — One internal bus cycle (1/fOP) PWM clock cycle (or period) — One tick of the PWM counter (1/fOP with no prescaler). See Figure 12-47. PWM cycle (or period) • Center-aligned mode: The time it takes the PWM counter to count up and count down (modulus * 2/fOP assuming no prescaler). See Figure 12-47. • Edge-aligned mode: The time it takes the PWM counter to count up (modulus/fOP). See Figure 12-47. Center-Aligned Mode PWM CLOCK CYCLE PWM CYCLE (OR PERIOD) Edge-Aligned Mode PWM CLOCK CYCLE PWM CYCLE (OR PERIOD) Figure 12-47. PWM Clock Cycle and PWM Cycle Definitions MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 155 Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC) PWM Load Frequency — Frequency at which new PWM parameters get loaded into the PWM. See Figure 12-48. LDFQ1:LDFQ0 = 01 — Reload Every Two Cycles PWM LOAD CYCLE (1/PWM LOAD FREQUENCY) RELOAD NEW MODULUS, PRESCALER, & PWM VALUES IF LDOK = 1 RELOAD NEW MODULUS, PRESCALER, & PWM VALUES IF LDOK = 1 Figure 12-48. PWM Load Cycle/Frequency Definition MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 156 Freescale Semiconductor Chapter 13 Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI) 13.1 Introduction This section describes the serial communications interface module (SCI, version D), which allows high-speed asynchronous communications with peripheral devices and other microcontroller units (MCUs). 13.2 Features Features of the SCI module include: • Full-duplex operation • Standard mark/space non-return-to-zero (NRZ) format • 32 programmable baud rates • Programmable 8-bit or 9-bit character length • Separately enabled transmitter and receiver • Separate receiver and transmitter CPU interrupt requests • Separate receiver and transmitter • Programmable transmitter output polarity • Two receiver wakeup methods: – Idle line wakeup – Address mark wakeup • Interrupt-driven operation with eight interrupt flags: – Transmitter empty – Transmission complete – Receiver full – Idle receiver input – Receiver overrun – Noise error – Framing error – Parity error • Receiver framing error detection • Hardware parity checking • 1/16 bit-time noise detection MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 157 DDRA PTA DDRB USER FLASH — 32,256 BYTES TIMER INTERFACE MODULE A USER RAM — 768 BYTES TIMER INTERFACE MODULE B PTB DDRC USER FLASH VECTOR SPACE — 46 BYTES OSC1 OSC2 CGMXFC SERIAL COMMUNICATIONS INTERFACE MODULE PTC RST SYSTEM INTEGRATION MODULE IRQ MODULE ANALOG-TO-DIGITAL CONVERTER MODULE POWER-ON RESET MODULE PTD DDRE VSS VDD VDDAD VSSAD PTF0/SPSCK(1) POWER Notes: 1. These pins are not available in the 56-pin SDIP package. 2. This module is not available in the 56-pin SDIP package. 3. In the 56-pin SDIP package, these pins are bonded together. Figure 13-1. Block Diagram Highlighting SCI Block and Pins DDRF PTF PWMGND PWM6–PWM1 PULSE-WIDTH MODULATOR MODULE PTF5/TxD PTF4/RxD PTF3/MISO(1) PTF2/MOSI(1) PTF1/SS(1) PTE 158 M68HC08 CPU CPU REGISTERS ARITHMETIC/LOGIC UNIT CONTROL AND STATUS REGISTERS — 112 BYTES Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI) INTERNAL BUS PTA7–PTA0 PTB7/ATD7 PTB6/ATD6 PTB5/ATD5 PTB4/ATD4 PTB3/ATD3 PTB2/ATD2 PTB1/ATD1 PTB0/ATD0 PTC6 PTC5 PTC4 PTC3 PTC2 PTC1/ATD9(1) PTC0/ATD8 PTD6/IS3 PTD5/IS2 PTD4/IS1 PTD3/FAULT4 PTD2/FAULT3 PTD1/FAULT2 PTD0/FAULT1 PTE7/TCH3A PTE6/TCH2A PTE5/TCH1A PTE4/TCH0A PTE3/TCLKA PTE2/TCH1B(1) PTE1/TCH0B(1) PTE0/TCLKB(1) LOW-VOLTAGE INHIBIT MODULE COMPUTER OPERATING PROPERLY MODULE MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor MONITOR ROM — 240 BYTES CLOCK GENERATOR MODULE SERIAL PERIPHERAL INTERFACE MODULE(2) IRQ VDDA VSSA(3) VREFL(3) VREFH SINGLE BREAK MODULE Functional Description 13.3 Functional Description Figure 13-2 shows the structure of the SCI module. The SCI allows full-duplex, asynchronous, NRZ serial communication among the MCU and remote devices, including other MCUs. The transmitter and receiver of the SCI operate independently, although they use the same baud rate generator. During normal operation, the CPU monitors the status of the SCI, writes the data to be transmitted, and processes received data. INTERNAL BUS TRANSMITTER INTERRUPT CONTROL SCI DATA REGISTER RECEIVE SHIFT REGISTER SCI DATA REGISTER RECEIVER INTERRUPT CONTROL ERROR INTERRUPT CONTROL TRANSMIT SHIFT REGISTER TXINV PTF4/RxD PTF5/TxD SCTIE TCIE SCRIE ILIE TE RE RWU SBK SCTE TC SCRF IDLE OR NF FE PE LOOPS LOOPS WAKEUP CONTROL RECEIVE CONTROL BKF RPF BAUD RATE GENERATOR FLAG CONTROL M WAKE ILTY fOP ÷4 PRESCALER PEN PTY DATA SELECTION CONTROL ENSCI R8 T8 ORIE NEIE FEIE PEIE TRANSMIT CONTROL ENSCI ÷ 16 Figure 13-2. SCI Module Block Diagram MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 159 Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI) Addr. $0038 Register Name SCI Control Register 1 (SCC1) See page 169. SCI Control Register 2 (SCC2) See page 171. SCI Control Register 3 (SCC3) See page 173. SCI Status Register 1 (SCS1) See page 174. SCI Status Register 2 (SCS2) See page 176. SCI Data Register (SCDR) See page 177. SCI Baud Rate Register (SCBR) See page 177. Read: Write: Reset: Read: Write: Reset: Read: Write: Reset: Read: Write: Reset: Read: Write: Reset: Read: Write: Reset: Read: Write: Reset: Bit 7 LOOPS 0 SCTIE 0 R8 R U SCTE R 1 0 R 0 R7 T7 0 R 0 6 ENSCI 0 TCIE 0 T8 U TC R 1 0 R 0 R6 T6 0 R 0 = Reserved 5 TXINV 0 SCRIE 0 0 R 0 SCRF R 0 0 R 0 R5 T5 4 M 0 ILIE 0 0 R 0 IDLE R 0 0 R 0 R4 T4 3 WAKE 0 TE 0 ORIE 0 OR R 0 0 R 0 R3 T3 0 R 0 U = Unaffected 2 ILTY 0 RE 0 NEIE 0 NF R 0 0 R 0 R2 T2 1 PEN 0 RWU 0 FEIE 0 FE R 0 BKF R 0 R1 T1 Bit 0 PTY 0 SBK 0 PEIE 0 PE R 0 RPF R 0 R0 T0 $0039 $003A $003B $003C $003D Unaffected by reset SCP1 0 SCP0 0 SCR2 0 SCR1 0 SCR0 0 $003E R Figure 13-3. SCI I/O Register Summary 13.3.1 Data Format The SCI uses the standard non-return-to-zero mark/space data format illustrated in Figure 13-4. 8-BIT DATA FORMAT BIT M IN SCC1 CLEAR START BIT POSSIBLE PARITY BIT BIT 6 BIT 7 STOP BIT POSSIBLE PARITY BIT BIT 6 BIT 7 BIT 8 BIT 0 BIT 1 BIT 2 BIT 3 BIT 4 BIT 5 NEXT START BIT 9-BIT DATA FORMAT BIT M IN SCC1 SET START BIT BIT 0 BIT 1 BIT 2 BIT 3 BIT 4 BIT 5 STOP BIT NEXT START BIT Figure 13-4. SCI Data Formats MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 160 Freescale Semiconductor Functional Description 13.3.2 Transmitter Figure 13-5 shows the structure of the SCI transmitter. INTERNAL BUS ÷4 fOP PRESCALER BAUD DIVIDER ÷ 16 SCI DATA REGISTER SCP1 SCP0 SCR2 SCR1 SCR0 TXINV MSB STOP START 11-BIT TRANSMIT SHIFT REGISTER 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 H L PTF5/TxD M PEN PTY PARITY GENERATION LOAD FROM SCDR SHIFT ENABLE PREAMBLE ALL 1s T8 TRANSMITTER CPU INTERRUPT REQUEST TRANSMITTER CONTROL LOGIC SCTE SCTE SCTIE TC TCIE LOOPS SCTIE TC TCIE ENSCI TE Figure 13-5. SCI Transmitter MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 161 BREAK ALL 0s SBK Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI) 13.3.2.1 Character Length The transmitter can accommodate either 8-bit or 9-bit data. The state of the M bit in SCI control register 1 (SCC1) determines character length. When transmitting 9-bit data, bit T8 in SCI control register 3 (SCC3) is the ninth bit (bit 8). 13.3.2.2 Character Transmission During an SCI transmission, the transmit shift register shifts a character out to the PTF5/TxD pin. The SCI data register (SCDR) is the write-only buffer between the internal data bus and the transmit shift register. To initiate an SCI transmission: 1. Enable the SCI by writing a 1 to the enable SCI bit (ENSCI) in SCI control register 1 (SCC1). 2. Enable the transmitter by writing a 1 to the transmitter enable bit (TE) in SCI control register 2 (SCC2). 3. Clear the SCI transmitter empty bit by first reading SCI status register 1 (SCS1) and then writing to the SCDR. 4. Repeat step 3 for each subsequent transmission. At the start of a transmission, transmitter control logic automatically loads the transmit shift register with a preamble of 1s. After the preamble shifts out, control logic transfers the SCDR data into the transmit shift register. A 0 start bit automatically goes into the least significant bit (LSB) position of the transmit shift register. A 1 stop bit goes into the most significant bit (MSB) position. The SCI transmitter empty bit, SCTE, in SCS1 becomes set when the SCDR transfers a byte to the transmit shift register. The SCTE bit indicates that the SCDR can accept new data from the internal data bus. If the SCI transmit interrupt enable bit, SCTIE, in SCC2 is also set, the SCTE bit generates a transmitter CPU interrupt request. When the transmit shift register is not transmitting a character, the PTF5/TxD pin goes to the idle condition, logic 1. If at any time software clears the ENSCI bit in SCI control register 1 (SCC1), the transmitter and receiver relinquish control of the port E pins. 13.3.2.3 Break Characters Writing a 1 to the send break bit, SBK, in SCC2 loads the transmit shift register with a break character. A break character contains all 0s and has no start, stop, or parity bit. Break character length depends on the M bit in SCC1. As long as SBK is at 1, transmitter logic continuously loads break characters into the transmit shift register. After software clears the SBK bit, the shift register finishes transmitting the last break character and then transmits at least one logic 1. The automatic logic 1 at the end of a break character guarantees the recognition of the start bit of the next character. The SCI recognizes a break character when a start bit is followed by eight or nine logic 0 data bits and a logic 0 where the stop bit should be. Receiving a break character has these effects on SCI registers: • Sets the framing error bit (FE) in SCS1 • Sets the SCI receiver full bit (SCRF) in SCS1 • Clears the SCI data register (SCDR) • Clears the R8 bit in SCC3 • Sets the break flag bit (BKF) in SCS2 • May set the overrun (OR), noise flag (NF), parity error (PE), or reception-in-progress flag (RPF) bits MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 162 Freescale Semiconductor Functional Description 13.3.2.4 Idle Characters An idle character contains all 1s and has no start, stop, or parity bit. Idle character length depends on the M bit in SCC1. The preamble is a synchronizing idle character that begins every transmission. If the TE bit is cleared during a transmission, the PTF5/TxD pin becomes idle after completion of the transmission in progress. Clearing and then setting the TE bit during a transmission queues an idle character to be sent after the character currently being transmitted. NOTE When a break sequence is followed immediately by an idle character, this SCI design exhibits a condition in which the break character length is reduced by one half bit time. In this instance, the break sequence will consist of a valid start bit, eight or nine data bits (as defined by the M bit in SCC1) of logic 0 and one half data bit length of logic 0 in the stop bit position followed immediately by the idle character. To ensure a break character of the proper length is transmitted, always queue up a byte of data to be transmitted while the final break sequence is in progress. When queueing an idle character, return the TE bit to 1 before the stop bit of the current character shifts out to the PTF5/TxD pin. Setting TE after the stop bit appears on PTF5/TxD causes data previously written to the SCDR to be lost. A good time to toggle the TE bit is when the SCTE bit becomes set and just before writing the next byte to the SCDR. 13.3.2.5 Inversion of Transmitted Output The transmit inversion bit (TXINV) in SCI control register 1 (SCC1) reverses the polarity of transmitted data. All transmitted values, including idle, break, start, and stop bits, are inverted when TXINV is at 1. See 13.7.1 SCI Control Register 1. 13.3.2.6 Transmitter Interrupts These conditions can generate CPU interrupt requests from the SCI transmitter: • SCI transmitter empty (SCTE) — The SCTE bit in SCS1 indicates that the SCDR has transferred a character to the transmit shift register. SCTE can generate a transmitter CPU interrupt request. Setting the SCI transmit interrupt enable bit, SCTIE, in SCC2 enables the SCTE bit to generate transmitter CPU interrupt requests. • Transmission complete (TC) — The TC bit in SCS1 indicates that the transmit shift register and the SCDR are empty and that no break or idle character has been generated. The transmission complete interrupt enable bit, TCIE, in SCC2 enables the TC bit to generate transmitter CPU interrupt requests. 13.3.3 Receiver Figure 13-6 shows the structure of the SCI receiver. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 163 Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI) INTERNAL BUS SCR2 SCP1 SCP0 ÷4 fOP PTF4/RxD BAUD PRESCALER DIVIDER SCR1 SCR0 START 0 L RWU ÷ 16 DATA RECOVERY ALL 0s ALL 1s MSB SCI DATA REGISTER STOP 11-BIT RECEIVE SHIFT REGISTER 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 H BKF ERROR CPU INTERRUPT REQUEST RPF CPU INTERRUPT REQUEST M WAKE ILTY PEN PTY WAKEUP LOGIC PARITY CHECKING IDLE ILIE SCRF SCRIE SCRF IDLE R8 ILIE SCRIE OR ORIE NF NEIE FE FEIE PE PEIE OR ORIE NF NEIE FE FEIE PE PEIE Figure 13-6. SCI Receiver Block Diagram 13.3.3.1 Character Length The receiver can accommodate either 8-bit or 9-bit data. The state of the M bit in SCI control register 1 (SCC1) determines character length. When receiving 9-bit data, bit R8 in SCI control register 2 (SCC2) is the ninth bit (bit 8). When receiving 8-bit data, bit R8 is a copy of the eighth bit (bit 7). MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 164 Freescale Semiconductor Functional Description 13.3.3.2 Character Reception During an SCI reception, the receive shift register shifts characters in from the PTF4/RxD pin. The SCI data register (SCDR) is the read-only buffer between the internal data bus and the receive shift register. After a complete character shifts into the receive shift register, the data portion of the character transfers to the SCDR. The SCI receiver full bit, SCRF, in SCI status register 1 (SCS1) becomes set, indicating that the received byte can be read. If the SCI receive interrupt enable bit, SCRIE, in SCC2 is also set, the SCRF bit generates a receiver CPU interrupt request. 13.3.3.3 Data Sampling The receiver samples the PTF4/RxD pin at the RT clock rate. The RT clock is an internal signal with a frequency 16 times the baud rate. To adjust for baud rate mismatch, the RT clock is resynchronized at these times (see Figure 13-7): • After every start bit • After the receiver detects a data bit change from 1 to 0 (after the majority of data bit samples at RT8, RT9, and RT10 return a valid 1 and the majority of the next RT8, RT9, and RT10 samples return a valid 0) START BIT PTF4/RxD LSB SAMPLES START BIT QUALIFICATION START BIT VERIFICATION DATA SAMPLING RT CLOCK RT10 RT11 RT12 RT13 RT14 RT15 RT CLOCK STATE RT CLOCK RESET RT1 RT1 RT1 RT1 RT1 RT1 RT1 RT1 RT1 RT2 RT3 RT4 RT5 RT6 RT7 RT8 RT9 RT16 RT1 RT2 RT3 RT4 Figure 13-7. Receiver Data Sampling To locate the start bit, data recovery logic does an asynchronous search for a 0 preceded by three 1s. When the falling edge of a possible start bit occurs, the RT clock begins to count to 16. To verify the start bit and to detect noise, data recovery logic takes samples at RT3, RT5, and RT7. Table 13-1 summarizes the results of the start bit verification samples. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 165 Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI) Table 13-1. Start Bit Verification RT3, RT5, and RT7 Samples 000 001 010 011 100 101 110 111 Start Bit Verification Yes Yes Yes No Yes No No No Noise Flag 0 1 1 0 1 0 0 0 If start bit verification is not successful, the RT clock is reset and a new search for a start bit begins. To determine the value of a data bit and to detect noise, recovery logic takes samples at RT8, RT9, and RT10. Table 13-2 summarizes the results of the data bit samples. Table 13-2. Data Bit Recovery RT8, RT9, and RT10 Samples 000 001 010 011 100 101 110 111 Data Bit Determination 0 0 0 1 0 1 1 1 Noise Flag 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 NOTE The RT8, RT9, and RT10 samples do not affect start bit verification. If any or all of the RT8, RT9, and RT10 start bit samples are 1s following a successful start bit verification, the noise flag (NF) is set and the receiver assumes that the bit is a start bit. To verify a stop bit and to detect noise, recovery logic takes samples at RT8, RT9, and RT10. Table 13-3 summarizes the results of the stop bit samples. Table 13-3. Stop Bit Recovery RT8, RT9, and RT10 Samples 000 001 010 011 100 101 110 111 Framing Error Flag 1 1 1 0 1 0 0 0 Noise Flag 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 166 Freescale Semiconductor Functional Description 13.3.3.4 Framing Errors If the data recovery logic does not detect a 1 where the stop bit should be in an incoming character, it sets the framing error bit, FE, in SCS1. The FE flag is set at the same time that the SCRF bit is set. A break character that has no stop bit also sets the FE bit. 13.3.3.5 Receiver Wakeup So that the MCU can ignore transmissions intended only for other receivers in multiple-receiver systems, the receiver can be put into a standby state. Setting the receiver wakeup bit, RWU, in SCC2 puts the receiver into a standby state during which receiver interrupts are disabled. Depending on the state of the WAKE bit in SCC1, either of two conditions on the PTF4/RxD pin can bring the receiver out of the standby state: • Address mark — An address mark is a 1 in the most significant bit position of a received character. When the WAKE bit is set, an address mark wakes the receiver from the standby state by clearing the RWU bit. The address mark also sets the SCI receiver full bit, SCRF. Software can then compare the character containing the address mark to the user-defined address of the receiver. If they are the same, the receiver remains awake and processes the characters that follow. If they are not the same, software can set the RWU bit and put the receiver back into the standby state. • Idle input line condition — When the WAKE bit is clear, an idle character on the PTF4/RxD pin wakes the receiver from the standby state by clearing the RWU bit. The idle character that wakes the receiver does not set the receiver idle bit, IDLE, or the SCI receiver full bit, SCRF. The idle line type bit, ILTY, determines whether the receiver begins counting 1s as idle character bits after the start bit or after the stop bit. NOTE Clearing the WAKE bit after the PTF4/RxD pin has been idle can cause the receiver to wake up immediately. 13.3.3.6 Receiver Interrupts These sources can generate CPU interrupt requests from the SCI receiver: • SCI receiver full (SCRF) — The SCRF bit in SCS1 indicates that the receive shift register has transferred a character to the SCDR. SCRF can generate a receiver CPU interrupt request. Setting the SCI receive interrupt enable bit, SCRIE, in SCC2 enables the SCRF bit to generate receiver CPU interrupts. • Idle input (IDLE) — The IDLE bit in SCS1 indicates that 10 or 11 consecutive 1s shifted in from the PTF4/RxD pin. The idle line interrupt enable bit, ILIE, in SCC2 enables the IDLE bit to generate CPU interrupt requests. 13.3.3.7 Error Interrupts These receiver error flags in SCS1 can generate CPU interrupt requests: • Receiver overrun (OR) — The OR bit indicates that the receive shift register shifted in a new character before the previous character was read from the SCDR. The previous character remains in the SCDR, and the new character is lost. The overrun interrupt enable bit, ORIE, in SCC3 enables OR to generate SCI error CPU interrupt requests. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 167 Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI) • • • Noise flag (NF) — The NF bit is set when the SCI detects noise on incoming data or break characters, including start, data, and stop bits. The noise error interrupt enable bit, NEIE, in SCC3 enables NF to generate SCI error CPU interrupt requests. Framing error (FE) — The FE bit in SCS1 is set when a 0 occurs where the receiver expects a stop bit. The framing error interrupt enable bit, FEIE, in SCC3 enables FE to generate SCI error CPU interrupt requests. Parity error (PE) — The PE bit in SCS1 is set when the SCI detects a parity error in incoming data. The parity error interrupt enable bit, PEIE, in SCC3 enables PE to generate SCI error CPU interrupt requests. 13.4 Wait Mode The WAIT and STOP instructions put the MCU in low power-consumption standby modes. The SCI module remains active after the execution of a WAIT instruction. In wait mode the SCI module registers are not accessible by the CPU. Any enabled CPU interrupt request from the SCI module can bring the MCU out of wait mode. If SCI module functions are not required during wait mode, reduce power consumption by disabling the module before executing the WAIT instruction. 13.5 SCI During Break Module Interrupts The system integration module (SIM) controls whether status bits in other modules can be cleared during interrupts generated by the break module. The BCFE bit in the SIM break flag control register (SBFCR) enables software to clear status bits during the break state. To allow software to clear status bits during a break interrupt, write a 1 to the BCFE bit. If a status bit is cleared during the break state, it remains cleared when the MCU exits the break state. To protect status bits during the break state, write a 0 to the BCFE bit. With BCFE at 0 (its default state), software can read and write I/O registers during the break state without affecting status bits. Some status bits have a 2-step read/write clearing procedure. If software does the first step on such a bit before the break, the bit cannot change during the break state as long as BCFE is at 0. After the break, doing the second step clears the status bit. 13.6 I/O Signals Port F shares two of its pins with the SCI module. The two SCI input/output (I/O) pins are: • PTF5/TxD — Transmit data • PTF4/RxD — Receive data 13.6.1 PTF5/TxD (Transmit Data) The PTF5/TxD pin is the serial data output from the SCI transmitter. The SCI shares the PTF5/TxD pin with port F. When the SCI is enabled, the PTF5/TxD pin is an output regardless of the state of the DDRF5 bit in data direction register F (DDRF). MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 168 Freescale Semiconductor I/O Registers 13.6.2 PTF4/RxD (Receive Data) The PTF4/RxD pin is the serial data input to the SCI receiver. The SCI shares the PTF4/RxD pin with port F. When the SCI is enabled, the PTF4/RxD pin is an input regardless of the state of the DDRF4 bit in data direction register F (DDRF). 13.7 I/O Registers These I/O registers control and monitor SCI operation: • SCI control register 1 (SCC1) • SCI control register 2 (SCC2) • SCI control register 3 (SCC3) • SCI status register 1 (SCS1) • SCI status register 2 (SCS2) • SCI data register (SCDR) • SCI baud rate register (SCBR) 13.7.1 SCI Control Register 1 SCI control register 1 (SCC1): • Enables loop-mode operation • Enables the SCI • Controls output polarity • Controls character length • Controls SCI wakeup method • Controls idle character detection • Enables parity function • Controls parity type Address: $0038 Bit 7 Read: Write: Reset: LOOPS 0 6 ENSCI 0 5 TXINV 0 4 M 0 3 WAKE 0 2 ILTY 0 1 PEN 0 Bit 0 PTY 0 Figure 13-8. SCI Control Register 1 (SCC1) LOOPS — Loop Mode Select Bit This read/write bit enables loop mode operation. In loop mode the PTF4/RxD pin is disconnected from the SCI, and the transmitter output goes into the receiver input. Both the transmitter and the receiver must be enabled to use loop mode. Reset clears the LOOPS bit. 1 = Loop mode enabled 0 = Normal operation enabled MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 169 Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI) ENSCI — Enable SCI Bit This read/write bit enables the SCI and the SCI baud rate generator. Clearing ENSCI sets the SCTE and TC bits in SCI status register 1 and disables transmitter interrupts. Reset clears the ENSCI bit. 1 = SCI enabled 0 = SCI disabled TXINV — Transmit Inversion Bit This read/write bit reverses the polarity of transmitted data. Reset clears the TXINV bit. 1 = Transmitter output inverted 0 = Transmitter output not inverted NOTE Setting the TXINV bit inverts all transmitted values, including idle, break, start, and stop bits. M — Mode (Character Length) Bit This read/write bit determines whether SCI characters are eight or nine bits long. See Table 13-4. The ninth bit can serve as an extra stop bit, as a receiver wakeup signal, or as a parity bit. Reset clears the M bit. 1 = 9-bit SCI characters 0 = 8-bit SCI characters WAKE — Wakeup Condition Bit This read/write bit determines which condition wakes up the SCI: a 1 (address mark) in the most significant bit (MSB) position of a received character or an idle condition on the PTF4/RxD pin. Reset clears the WAKE bit. 1 = Address mark wakeup 0 = Idle line wakeup ILTY — Idle Line Type Bit This read/write bit determines when the SCI starts counting 1s as idle character bits. The counting begins either after the start bit or after the stop bit. If the count begins after the start bit, then a string of 1s preceding the stop bit may cause false recognition of an idle character. Beginning the count after the stop bit avoids false idle character recognition, but requires properly synchronized transmissions. Reset clears the ILTY bit. 1 = Idle character bit count begins after stop bit. 0 = Idle character bit count begins after start bit. PEN — Parity Enable Bit This read/write bit enables the SCI parity function. See Table 13-4. When enabled, the parity function inserts a parity bit in the most significant bit position. See Figure 13-4. Reset clears the PEN bit. 1 = Parity function enabled 0 = Parity function disabled PTY — Parity Bit This read/write bit determines whether the SCI generates and checks for odd parity or even parity. See Table 13-4. Reset clears the PTY bit. 1 = Odd parity 0 = Even parity NOTE Changing the PTY bit in the middle of a transmission or reception can generate a parity error. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 170 Freescale Semiconductor I/O Registers Table 13-4. Character Format Selection Control Bits M 0 1 0 0 1 1 PEN:PTY 0X 0X 10 11 10 11 Start Bits 1 1 1 1 1 1 Data Bits 8 9 7 7 8 8 Character Format Parity None None Even Odd Even Odd Stop Bits 1 1 1 1 1 1 Character Length 10 bits 11 bits 10 bits 10 bits 11 bits 11 bits 13.7.2 SCI Control Register 2 SCI control register 2 (SCC2): • Enables these CPU interrupt requests: – Enables the SCTE bit to generate transmitter CPU interrupt requests – Enables the TC bit to generate transmitter CPU interrupt requests – Enables the SCRF bit to generate receiver CPU interrupt requests – Enables the IDLE bit to generate receiver CPU interrupt requests • Enables the transmitter • Enables the receiver • Enables SCI wakeup • Transmits SCI break characters Address: $0039 Bit 7 Read: Write: Reset: SCTIE 0 6 TCIE 0 5 SCRIE 0 4 ILIE 0 3 TE 0 2 RE 0 1 RWU 0 Bit 0 SBK 0 Figure 13-9. SCI Control Register 2 (SCC2) SCTIE — SCI Transmit Interrupt Enable Bit This read/write bit enables the SCTE bit to generate SCI transmitter CPU interrupt requests. Setting the SCTIE bit in SCC3 enables SCTE CPU interrupt requests. Reset clears the SCTIE bit. 1 = SCTE enabled to generate CPU interrupt 0 = SCTE not enabled to generate CPU interrupt TCIE — Transmission Complete Interrupt Enable Bit This read/write bit enables the TC bit to generate SCI transmitter CPU interrupt requests. Reset clears the TCIE bit. 1 = TC enabled to generate CPU interrupt requests 0 = TC not enabled to generate CPU interrupt requests MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 171 Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI) SCRIE — SCI Receive Interrupt Enable Bit This read/write bit enables the SCRF bit to generate SCI receiver CPU interrupt requests. Setting the SCRIE bit in SCC3 enables the SCRF bit to generate CPU interrupt requests. Reset clears the SCRIE bit. 1 = SCRF enabled to generate CPU interrupt 0 = SCRF not enabled to generate CPU interrupt ILIE — Idle Line Interrupt Enable Bit This read/write bit enables the IDLE bit to generate SCI receiver CPU interrupt requests. Reset clears the ILIE bit. 1 = IDLE enabled to generate CPU interrupt requests 0 = IDLE not enabled to generate CPU interrupt requests TE — Transmitter Enable Bit Setting this read/write bit begins the transmission by sending a preamble of 10 or 11 1s from the transmit shift register to the PTF5/TxD pin. If software clears the TE bit, the transmitter completes any transmission in progress before the PTF5/TxD returns to the idle condition (logic 1). Clearing and then setting TE during a transmission queues an idle character to be sent after the character currently being transmitted. Reset clears the TE bit. 1 = Transmitter enabled 0 = Transmitter disabled NOTE Writing to the TE bit is not allowed when the enable SCI bit (ENSCI) is clear. ENSCI is in SCI control register 1. RE — Receiver Enable Bit Setting this read/write bit enables the receiver. Clearing the RE bit disables the receiver but does not affect receiver interrupt flag bits. Reset clears the RE bit. 1 = Receiver enabled 0 = Receiver disabled NOTE Writing to the RE bit is not allowed when the enable SCI bit (ENSCI) is clear. ENSCI is in SCI control register 1. RWU — Receiver Wakeup Bit This read/write bit puts the receiver in a standby state during which receiver interrupts are disabled. The WAKE bit in SCC1 determines whether an idle input or an address mark brings the receiver out of the standby state and clears the RWU bit. Reset clears the RWU bit. 1 = Standby state 0 = Normal operation SBK — Send Break Bit Setting and then clearing this read/write bit transmits a break character followed by a 1. The 1 after the break character guarantees recognition of a valid start bit. If SBK remains set, the transmitter continuously transmits break characters with no 1s between them. Reset clears the SBK bit. 1 = Transmit break characters 0 = No break characters being transmitted NOTE Do not toggle the SBK bit immediately after setting the SCTE bit. Toggling SBK too early causes the SCI to send a break character instead of a preamble. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 172 Freescale Semiconductor I/O Registers 13.7.3 SCI Control Register 3 SCI control register 3 (SCC3): • Stores the ninth SCI data bit received and the ninth SCI data bit to be transmitted • Enables SCI receiver full (SCRF) • Enables SCI transmitter empty (SCTE) • Enables the following interrupts: – Receiver overrun interrupts – Noise error interrupts – Framing error interrupts – Parity error interrupts Address: Read: Write: Reset: $003A Bit 7 R8 R U R 6 T8 U = Reserved 5 0 R 0 4 0 R 0 3 ORIE 0 U = Unaffected 2 NEIE 0 1 FEIE 0 Bit 0 PEIE 0 Figure 13-10. SCI Control Register 3 (SCC3) R8 — Received Bit 8 When the SCI is receiving 9-bit characters, R8 is the read-only ninth bit (bit 8) of the received character. R8 is received at the same time that the SCDR receives the other eight bits. When the SCI is receiving 8-bit characters, R8 is a copy of the eighth bit (bit 7). Reset has no effect on the R8 bit. T8 — Transmitted Bit 8 When the SCI is transmitting 9-bit characters, T8 is the read/write ninth bit (bit 8) of the transmitted character. T8 is loaded into the transmit shift register at the same time that the SCDR is loaded into the transmit shift register. Reset has no effect on the T8 bit. ORIE — Receiver Overrun Interrupt Enable Bit This read/write bit enables SCI error CPU interrupt requests generated by the receiver overrun bit, OR. 1 = SCI error CPU interrupt requests from OR bit enabled 0 = SCI error CPU interrupt requests from OR bit disabled NEIE — Receiver Noise Error Interrupt Enable Bit This read/write bit enables SCI error CPU interrupt requests generated by the noise error bit, NE. Reset clears NEIE. 1 = SCI error CPU interrupt requests from NE bit enabled 0 = SCI error CPU interrupt requests from NE bit disabled FEIE — Receiver Framing Error Interrupt Enable Bit This read/write bit enables SCI error CPU interrupt requests generated by the framing error bit, FE. Reset clears FEIE. 1 = SCI error CPU interrupt requests from FE bit enabled 0 = SCI error CPU interrupt requests from FE bit disabled PEIE — Receiver Parity Error Interrupt Enable Bit This read/write bit enables SCI receiver CPU interrupt requests generated by the parity error bit, PE. See 13.7.4 SCI Status Register 1. Reset clears PEIE. 1 = SCI error CPU interrupt requests from PE bit enabled 0 = SCI error CPU interrupt requests from PE bit disabled MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 173 Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI) 13.7.4 SCI Status Register 1 SCI status register 1 (SCS1) contains flags to signal these conditions: • Transfer of SCDR data to transmit shift register complete • Transmission complete • Transfer of receive shift register data to SCDR complete • Receiver input idle • Receiver overrun • Noisy data • Framing error • Parity error Address: $003B Bit 7 Read: Write: Reset: SCTE R 1 R 6 TC R 1 = Reserved 5 SCRF R 0 4 IDLE R 0 3 OR R 0 2 NF R 0 1 FE R 0 Bit 0 PE R 0 Figure 13-11. SCI Status Register 1 (SCS1) SCTE — SCI Transmitter Empty Bit This clearable, read-only bit is set when the SCDR transfers a character to the transmit shift register. SCTE can generate an SCI transmitter CPU interrupt request. When the SCTIE bit in SCC2 is set, SCTE generates an SCI transmitter CPU interrupt request. In normal operation, clear the SCTE bit by reading SCS1 with SCTE set and then writing to SCDR. Reset sets the SCTE bit. 1 = SCDR data transferred to transmit shift register 0 = SCDR data not transferred to transmit shift register TC — Transmission Complete Bit This read-only bit is set when the SCTE bit is set and no data, preamble, or break character is being transmitted. TC generates an SCI transmitter CPU interrupt request if the TCIE bit in SCC2 is also set. TC is cleared automatically when data, preamble, or break is queued and ready to be sent. There may be up to 1.5 transmitter clocks of latency between queueing data, preamble, and break and the transmission actually starting. Reset sets the TC bit. 1 = No transmission in progress 0 = Transmission in progress SCRF — SCI Receiver Full Bit This clearable, read-only bit is set when the data in the receive shift register transfers to the SCI data register. SCRF can generate an SCI receiver CPU interrupt request. When the SCRIE bit in SCC2 is set, SCRF generates a CPU interrupt request. In normal operation, clear the SCRF bit by reading SCS1 with SCRF set and then reading the SCDR. Reset clears SCRF. 1 = Received data available in SCDR 0 = Data not available in SCDR MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 174 Freescale Semiconductor I/O Registers IDLE — Receiver Idle Bit This clearable, read-only bit is set when 10 or 11 consecutive 1s appear on the receiver input. IDLE generates an SCI error CPU interrupt request if the ILIE bit in SCC2 is also set. Clear the IDLE bit by reading SCS1 with IDLE set and then reading the SCDR. After the receiver is enabled, it must receive a valid character that sets the SCRF bit before an idle condition can set the IDLE bit. Also, after the IDLE bit has been cleared, a valid character must again set the SCRF bit before an idle condition can set the IDLE bit. Reset clears the IDLE bit. 1 = Receiver input idle 0 = Receiver input active or idle since the IDLE bit was cleared OR — Receiver Overrun Bit This clearable, read-only bit is set when software fails to read the SCDR before the receive shift register receives the next character. The OR bit generates an SCI error CPU interrupt request if the ORIE bit in SCC3 is also set. The data in the shift register is lost, but the data already in the SCDR is not affected. Clear the OR bit by reading SCS1 with OR set and then reading the SCDR. Reset clears the OR bit. 1 = Receive shift register full and SCRF = 1 0 = No receiver overrun Software latency may allow an overrun to occur between reads of SCS1 and SCDR in the flag-clearing sequence. Figure 13-12 shows the normal flag-clearing sequence and an example of an overrun caused by a delayed flag-clearing sequence. The delayed read of SCDR does not clear the OR bit because OR was not set when SCS1 was read. Byte 2 caused the overrun and is lost. The next flag-clearing sequence reads byte 3 in the SCDR instead of byte 2. NORMAL FLAG CLEARING SEQUENCE SCRF = 1 SCRF = 0 SCRF = 1 SCRF = 0 SCRF = 1 SCRF = 0 BYTE 4 READ SCS1 SCRF = 1 OR = 0 READ SCDR BYTE 3 SCRF = 1 OR = 1 SCRF = 0 OR = 0 BYTE 4 READ SCS1 SCRF = 1 OR = 1 READ SCDR BYTE 3 BYTE 1 READ SCS1 SCRF = 1 OR = 0 READ SCDR BYTE 1 SCRF = 1 BYTE 2 READ SCS1 SCRF = 1 OR = 0 READ SCDR BYTE 2 BYTE 3 DELAYED FLAG CLEARING SEQUENCE SCRF = 1 OR = 1 BYTE 2 READ SCS1 SCRF = 1 OR = 0 READ SCDR BYTE 1 SCRF = 0 OR = 1 BYTE 3 BYTE 1 Figure 13-12. Flag Clearing Sequence MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 175 Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI) In applications that are subject to software latency or in which it is important to know which byte is lost due to an overrun, the flag-clearing routine can check the OR bit in a second read of SCS1 after reading the data register. NF — Receiver Noise Flag Bit This clearable, read-only bit is set when the SCI detects noise on the PTF4/RxD pin. NF generates an NF CPU interrupt request if the NEIE bit in SCC3 is also set. Clear the NF bit by reading SCS1 and then reading the SCDR. Reset clears the NF bit. 1 = Noise detected 0 = No noise detected FE — Receiver Framing Error Bit This clearable, read-only bit is set when a 0 is accepted as the stop bit. FE generates an SCI error CPU interrupt request if the FEIE bit in SCC3 also is set. Clear the FE bit by reading SCS1 with FE set and then reading the SCDR. Reset clears the FE bit. 1 = Framing error detected 0 = No framing error detected PE — Receiver Parity Error Bit This clearable, read-only bit is set when the SCI detects a parity error in incoming data. PE generates a PE CPU interrupt request if the PEIE bit in SCC3 is also set. Clear the PE bit by reading SCS1 with PE set and then reading the SCDR. Reset clears the PE bit. 1 = Parity error detected 0 = No parity error detected 13.7.5 SCI Status Register 2 SCI status register 2 (SCS2) contains flags to signal these conditions: • Break character detected • Incoming data Address: Read: Write: Reset: $003C Bit 7 0 R 0 R 6 0 R 0 = Reserved 5 0 R 0 4 0 R 0 3 0 R 0 2 0 R 0 1 BKF R 0 Bit 0 RPF R 0 Figure 13-13. SCI Status Register 2 (SCS2) BKF — Break Flag This clearable, read-only bit is set when the SCI detects a break character on the PTF4/RxD pin. In SCS1, the FE and SCRF bits are also set. In 9-bit character transmissions, the R8 bit in SCC3 is cleared. BKF does not generate a CPU interrupt request. Clear BKF by reading SCS2 with BKF set and then reading the SCDR. Once cleared, BKF can become set again only after logic 1s again appear on the PTF4/RxD pin followed by another break character. Reset clears the BKF bit. 1 = Break character detected 0 = No break character detected MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 176 Freescale Semiconductor I/O Registers RPF —Reception-in-Progress Flag This read-only bit is set when the receiver detects a logic 0 during the RT1 time period of the start bit search. RPF does not generate an interrupt request. RPF is reset after the receiver detects false start bits (usually from noise or a baud rate mismatch, or when the receiver detects an idle character. Polling RPF before disabling the SCI module or entering stop mode can show whether a reception is in progress. 1 = Reception in progress 0 = No reception in progress 13.7.6 SCI Data Register The SCI data register (SCDR) is the buffer between the internal data bus and the receive and transmit shift registers. Reset has no effect on data in the SCI data register. Address: Read: Write: Reset: $003D Bit 7 R7 T7 6 R6 T6 5 R5 T5 4 R4 T4 3 R3 T3 2 R2 T2 1 R1 T1 Bit 0 R0 T0 Unaffected by reset Figure 13-14. SCI Data Register (SCDR) R7/T7:R0/T0 — Receive/Transmit Data Bits Reading address $003D accesses the read-only received data bits, R7:R0. Writing to address $003D writes the data to be transmitted, T7:T0. Reset has no effect on the SCI data register. 13.7.7 SCI Baud Rate Register The baud rate register (SCBR) selects the baud rate for both the receiver and the transmitter. Address: Read: Write: Reset: $003E Bit 7 0 R 0 R 6 0 R 0 = Reserved 5 SCP1 0 4 SCP0 0 3 0 R 0 2 SCR2 0 1 SCR1 0 Bit 0 SCR0 0 Figure 13-15. SCI Baud Rate Register (SCBR) SCP1 and SCP0 — SCI Baud Rate Prescaler Bits These read/write bits select the baud rate prescaler divisor as shown in Table 13-5. Reset clears SCP1 and SCP0. Table 13-5. SCI Baud Rate Prescaling SCP1:SCP0 00 01 10 11 Prescaler Divisor (PD) 1 3 4 13 MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 177 Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI) SCR2–SCR0 — SCI Baud Rate Select Bits These read/write bits select the SCI baud rate divisor as shown in Table 13-6. Reset clears SCR2–SCR0. Table 13-6. SCI Baud Rate Selection SCR2:SCR1:SCR0 000 001 010 011 100 101 110 111 Baud Rate Divisor (BD) 1 2 4 8 16 32 64 128 Use this formula to calculate the SCI baud rate: f OP Baud rate = ----------------------------------64 × PD × BD where: fOP = internal operating frequency PD = prescaler divisor BD = baud rate divisor Table 13-7 shows the SCI baud rates that can be generated with a 4.9152-MHz crystal with the CGM set for an fOP of 7.3728 MHz and the CGM set for an fOP of 4.9152 MHz. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 178 Freescale Semiconductor I/O Registers Table 13-7. SCI Baud Rate Selection Examples SCP1:SCP0 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 01 01 01 01 01 01 01 01 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 11 11 11 11 11 11 11 11 Prescaler Divisor (PD) 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 13 13 13 13 13 13 13 13 SCR2:SCR1:SCR0 000 001 010 011 100 101 110 111 000 001 010 011 100 101 110 111 000 001 010 011 100 101 110 111 000 001 010 011 100 101 110 111 Baud Rate Divisor (BD) 1 2 4 8 16 32 64 128 1 2 4 8 16 32 64 128 1 2 4 8 16 32 64 128 1 2 4 8 16 32 64 128 Baud Rate (fOP = 7.3728 MHz) 115,200 57,600 28,800 14,400 7200 3600 1800 900 38,400 19,200 9600 4800 2400 1200 600 300 28,800 14,400 7200 3600 1800 900 450 225 8861.5 4430.7 2215.4 1107.7 553.8 276.9 138.5 69.2 Baud Rate (fOP = 4.9152 MHz) 76,800 38,400 19,200 9600 4800 2400 1200 600 25,600 12,800 6400 3200 1600 800 400 200 19,200 9600 4800 2400 1200 600 300 150 5907.7 2953.8 1476.9 738.5 369.2 184.6 92.3 46.2 MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 179 Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI) MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 180 Freescale Semiconductor Chapter 14 System Integration Module (SIM) 14.1 Introduction This section describes the system integration module (SIM). Together with the central processor unit (CPU), the SIM controls all microcontroller unit (MCU) activities. A block diagram of the SIM is shown in Figure 14-1. The SIM is a system state controller that coordinates CPU and exception timing. The SIM is responsible for: • Bus clock generation and control for CPU and peripherals: – Wait/reset/break entry and recovery – Internal clock control • Master reset control, including power-on reset (POR) and computer operating properly (COP) timeout • Interrupt control: – Acknowledge timing – Arbitration control timing – Vector address generation • CPU enable/disable timing • Modular architecture expandable to 128 interrupt sources Table 14-1 shows the internal signal names used in this section. Table 14-1. Signal Name Conventions Signal Name CGMXCLK CGMVCLK CGMOUT IAB IDB PORRST IRST R/W Description Buffered version of OSC1 from clock generator module (CGM) Phase-locked loop (PLL) circuit output PLL-based or OSC1-based clock output from CGM module (bus clock = CGMOUT divided by two) Internal address bus Internal data bus Signal from the power-on reset module to the SIM Internal reset signal Read/write signal MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 181 System Integration Module (SIM) MODULE WAIT WAIT CONTROL CPU WAIT (FROM CPU) SIMOSCEN (TO CGM) SIM COUNTER COP CLOCK CGMXCLK (FROM CGM) CGMOUT (FROM CGM) ÷2 CLOCK CONTROL CLOCK GENERATORS INTERNAL CLOCKS RESET PIN LOGIC POR CONTROL RESET PIN CONTROL SIM RESET STATUS REGISTER MASTER RESET CONTROL LVI (FROM LVI MODULE) ILLEGAL OPCODE (FROM CPU) ILLEGAL ADDRESS (FROM ADDRESS MAP DECODERS) COP (FROM COP MODULE) RESET INTERRUPT CONTROL AND PRIORITY DECODE INTERRUPT SOURCES CPU INTERFACE Figure 14-1. SIM Block Diagram 14.2 SIM Bus Clock Control and Generation The bus clock generator provides system clock signals for the CPU and peripherals on the MCU. The system clocks are generated from an incoming clock, CGMOUT, as shown in Figure 14-2. This clock can come from either an external oscillator or from the on-chip phase-locked loop (PLL) circuit. See Chapter 4 Clock Generator Module (CGM). 14.2.1 Bus Timing In user mode, the internal bus frequency is either the crystal oscillator output (CGMXCLK) divided by four or the PLL output (CGMVCLK) divided by four. See Chapter 4 Clock Generator Module (CGM). 14.2.2 Clock Startup from POR or LVI Reset When the power-on reset (POR) module or the low-voltage inhibit (LVI) module generates a reset, the clocks to the CPU and peripherals are inactive and held in an inactive phase until after the 4096 CGMXCLK cycle POR timeout has completed. The RST pin is driven low by the SIM during this entire period. The internal bus (IBUS) clocks start upon completion of the timeout. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 182 Freescale Semiconductor Reset and System Initialization OSC1 CLOCK SELECT CIRCUIT ÷2 A CGMXCLK CGMOUT SIM COUNTER ÷2 BUS CLOCK GENERATORS CGMVCLK B S* *When S = 1, CGMOUT = B PLL BCS PTC2 MONITOR MODE USER MODE SIM CGM Figure 14-2. CGM Clock Signals 14.2.3 Clocks in Wait Mode In wait mode, the CPU clocks are inactive. The SIM also produces two sets of clocks for other modules. Refer to the wait mode subsection of each module to see if the module is active or inactive in wait mode. Some modules can be programmed to be active in wait mode. 14.3 Reset and System Initialization The MCU has these reset sources: • Power-on reset module (POR) • External reset pin (RST) • Computer operating properly (COP) module • Low-voltage inhibit (LVI) module • Illegal opcode • Illegal address All of these resets produce the vector $FFFE–FFFF ($FEFE–FEFF in monitor mode) and assert the internal reset signal (IRST). IRST causes all registers to be returned to their default values and all modules to be returned to their reset states. An internal reset clears the SIM counter (see 14.4 SIM Counter), but an external reset does not. Each of the resets sets a corresponding bit in the SIM reset status register (SRSR). See 14.7.2 SIM Reset Status Register. 14.3.1 External Pin Reset Pulling the asynchronous RST pin low halts all processing. The PIN bit of the SIM reset status register (SRSR) is set as long as RST is held low for a minimum of 67 CGMXCLK cycles, assuming that neither the POR nor the LVI was the source of the reset. See Table 14-2 for details. Figure 14-3 shows the relative timing. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 183 System Integration Module (SIM) Table 14-2. PIN Bit Set Timing Reset Type POR/LVI All others Number of Cycles Required to Set PIN 4163 (4096 + 64 + 3) 67 (64 + 3) CGMOUT RST IAB PC VECT H VECT L Figure 14-3. External Reset Timing 14.3.2 Active Resets from Internal Sources All internal reset sources actively pull the RST pin low for 32 CGMXCLK cycles to allow resetting of external peripherals. The internal reset signal (IRST) continues to be asserted for an additional 32 cycles (see Figure 14-5). An internal reset can be caused by an illegal address, illegal opcode, COP timeout, LVI, or POR. (See Figure 14-4.) ILLEGAL ADDRESS RST ILLEGAL OPCODE RST COPRST LVI POR INTERNAL RESET Figure 14-4. Sources of Internal Reset NOTE For LVI or POR resets, the SIM cycles through 4096 CGMXCLK cycles during which the SIM forces the RST pin low. The internal reset signal then follows the sequence from the falling edge of RST, as shown in Figure 14-5. IRST RST RST PULLED LOW BY MCU 32 CYCLES 32 CYCLES CGMXCLK IAB VECTOR HIGH Figure 14-5. Internal Reset Timing The COP reset is asynchronous to the bus clock. The active reset feature allows the part to issue a reset to peripherals and other chips within a system built around the MCU. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 184 Freescale Semiconductor Reset and System Initialization 14.3.2.1 Power-On Reset (POR) When power is first applied to the MCU, the power-on reset (POR) module generates a pulse to indicate that power-on has occurred. The external reset pin (RST) is held low while the SIM counter counts out 4096 CGMXCLK cycles. Sixty-four CGMXCLK cycles later, the CPU and memories are released from reset to allow the reset vector sequence to occur. OSC1 PORRST 4096 CYCLES CGMXCLK 32 CYCLES 32 CYCLES CGMOUT RST IAB $FFFE $FFFF Figure 14-6. POR Recovery At power-on, these events occur: • A POR pulse is generated. • The internal reset signal is asserted. • The SIM enables CGMOUT. • Internal clocks to the CPU and modules are held inactive for 4096 CGMXCLK cycles to allow stabilization of the oscillator. • The RST pin is driven low during the oscillator stabilization time. • The POR bit of the SIM reset status register (SRSR) is set and all other bits in the register are cleared. 14.3.2.2 Computer Operating Properly (COP) Reset An input to the SIM is reserved for the COP reset signal. The overflow of the COP counter causes an internal reset and sets the COP bit in the SIM reset status register (SRSR). The SIM actively pulls down the RST pin for all internal reset sources. To prevent a COP module timeout, write any value to location $FFFF. Writing to location $FFFF clears the COP counter and bits 12–4 of the SIM counter. The SIM counter output, which occurs at least every 213–24 CGMXCLK cycles, drives the COP counter. The COP should be serviced as soon as possible out of reset to guarantee the maximum amount of time before the first timeout. The COP module is disabled if the RST pin or the IRQ pin is held at VHI while the MCU is in monitor mode. The COP module can be disabled only through combinational logic conditioned with the high voltage MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 185 System Integration Module (SIM) signal on the RST or the IRQ pin. This prevents the COP from becoming disabled as a result of external noise. During a break state, VHI on the RST pin disables the COP module. 14.3.2.3 Illegal Opcode Reset The SIM decodes signals from the CPU to detect illegal instructions. An illegal instruction sets the ILOP bit in the SIM reset status register (SRSR) and causes a reset. Because the MC68HC908MR32 has stop mode disabled, execution of the STOP instruction will cause an illegal opcode reset. 14.3.2.4 Illegal Address Reset An opcode fetch from addresses other than FLASH or RAM addresses generates an illegal address reset (unimplemented locations within memory map). The SIM verifies that the CPU is fetching an opcode prior to asserting the ILAD bit in the SIM reset status register (SRSR) and resetting the MCU. A data fetch from an unmapped address does not generate a reset. 14.3.2.5 Forced Monitor Mode Entry Reset (MENRST) The MENRST module monitors the reset vector fetches and will assert an internal reset if it detects that the reset vectors are erased ($FF). When the MCU comes out of reset, it is forced into monitor mode. 14.3.2.6 Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI) Reset The low-voltage inhibit (LVI) module asserts its output to the SIM when the VDD voltage falls to the VLVRX voltage and remains at or below that level for at least nine consecutive CPU cycles (see 19.5 DC Electrical Characteristics). The LVI bit in the SIM reset status register (SRSR) is set, and the external reset pin (RST) is held low while the SIM counter counts out 4096 CGMXCLK cycles. Sixty-four CGMXCLK cycles later, the CPU is released from reset to allow the reset vector sequence to occur. The SIM actively pulls down the RST pin for all internal reset sources. 14.4 SIM Counter The SIM counter is used by the power-on reset (POR) module to allow the oscillator time to stabilize before enabling the internal bus (IBUS) clocks. The SIM counter also serves as a prescaler for the computer operating properly (COP) module. The SIM counter overflow supplies the clock for the COP module. The SIM counter is 13 bits long and is clocked by the falling edge of CGMXCLK. 14.4.1 SIM Counter During Power-On Reset The power-on reset (POR) module detects power applied to the MCU. At power-on, the POR circuit asserts the signal PORRST. Once the SIM is initialized, it enables the clock generation (CGM) module to drive the bus clock state machine. 14.4.2 SIM Counter and Reset States External reset has no effect on the SIM counter. The SIM counter is free-running after all reset states. For counter control and internal reset recovery sequences, see 14.3.2 Active Resets from Internal Sources. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 186 Freescale Semiconductor Exception Control 14.5 Exception Control Normal, sequential program execution can be changed in three different ways: 1. Interrupts: a. Maskable hardware CPU interrupts b. Non-maskable software interrupt instruction (SWI) 2. Reset 3. Break interrupts 14.5.1 Interrupts At the beginning of an interrupt, the CPU saves the CPU register contents on the stack and sets the interrupt mask (I bit) to prevent additional interrupts. At the end of an interrupt, the return-from-interrupt (RTI) instruction recovers the CPU register contents from the stack so that normal processing can resume. Figure 14-7 shows interrupt entry timing. Figure 14-9 shows interrupt recovery timing. MODULE INTERRUPT I BIT START ADDR OPCODE IAB DUMMY SP SP – 1 SP – 2 SP – 3 SP – 4 VECT H VECT L IDB DUMMY PC – 1[7:0] PC – 1[15:8] X A CCR V DATA H V DATA L R/W Figure 14-7. Interrupt Entry Interrupts are latched, and arbitration is performed in the SIM at the start of interrupt processing. The arbitration result is a constant that the CPU uses to determine which vector to fetch. Once an interrupt is latched by the SIM, no other interrupt can take precedence, regardless of priority, until the latched interrupt is serviced (or the I bit is cleared). See Figure 14-8. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 187 System Integration Module (SIM) FROM RESET BREAK SET? I BIT OR SWI INTERRUPT? NO YES YES I BIT SET? NO INTERRUPT? NO AS MANY INTERRUPTS AS EXIST ON CHIP YES STACK CPU REGISTERS SET I BIT LOAD PC WITH INTERRUPT VECTOR FETCH NEXT INSTRUCTION SWI INSTRUCTION? NO YES RTI INSTRUCTION? NO YES UNSTACK CPU REGISTERS EXECUTE INSTRUCTION Figure 14-8. Interrupt Processing MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 188 Freescale Semiconductor Exception Control MODULE INTERRUPT I BIT IAB SP – 4 SP – 3 SP – 2 SP – 1 SP PC PC + 1 IDB CCR A X PC – 1[7:0] PC – 1[15:8] OPCODE OPERAND R/W Figure 14-9. Interrupt Recovery 14.5.1.1 Hardware Interrupts A hardware interrupt does not stop the current instruction. Processing of a hardware interrupt begins after completion of the current instruction. When the current instruction is complete, the SIM checks all pending hardware interrupts. If interrupts are not masked (I bit clear in the condition code register), and if the corresponding interrupt enable bit is set, the SIM proceeds with interrupt processing; otherwise, the next instruction is fetched and executed. If more than one interrupt is pending at the end of an instruction execution, the highest priority interrupt is serviced first. Figure 14-10 demonstrates what happens when two interrupts are pending. If an interrupt is pending upon exit from the original interrupt service routine, the pending interrupt is serviced before the load-accumulator-from- memory (LDA) instruction is executed. CLI LDA#$FF INT1 BACKGROUND ROUTINE PSHH INT1 INTERRUPT SERVICE ROUTINE PULH RTI INT2 PSHH INT2 INTERRUPT SERVICE ROUTINE PULH RTI Figure 14-10. Interrupt Recognition Example The LDA opcode is prefetched by both the INT1 and INT2 RTI instructions. However, in the case of the INT1 RTI prefetch, this is a redundant operation. NOTE To maintain compatibility with the M6805 Family, the H register is not pushed on the stack during interrupt entry. If the interrupt service routine modifies the H register or uses the indexed addressing mode, software should save the H register and then restore it prior to exiting the routine. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 189 System Integration Module (SIM) 14.5.1.2 Software Interrupt (SWI) Instruction The software interrupt (SWI) instruction is a non-maskable instruction that causes an interrupt regardless of the state of the interrupt mask (I bit) in the condition code register. 14.5.2 Reset All reset sources always have equal and highest priority and cannot be arbitrated. 14.6 Low-Power Mode Executing the WAIT instruction puts the MCU in a low power-consumption mode for standby situations. The SIM holds the CPU in a non-clocked state. WAIT clears the interrupt mask (I) in the condition code register, allowing interrupts to occur. 14.6.1 Wait Mode In wait mode, the CPU clocks are inactive while the peripheral clocks continue to run. Figure 14-11 shows the timing for wait mode entry. A module that is active during wait mode can wake up the CPU with an interrupt if the interrupt is enabled. Stacking for the interrupt begins one cycle after the WAIT instruction during which the interrupt occurred. Refer to the wait mode subsection of each module to see if the module is active or inactive in wait mode. Some modules can be programmed to be active in wait mode. Wait mode can also be exited by a reset. If the COP disable bit, COPD, in the configuration register is logic 0, then the computer operating properly module (COP) is enabled and remains active in wait mode. IAB WAIT ADDR WAIT ADDR + 1 SAME SAME IDB PREVIOUS DATA NEXT OPCODE SAME SAME R/W Note: Previous data can be operand data or the WAIT opcode, depending on the last instruction. Figure 14-11. Wait Mode Entry Timing Figure 14-12 and Figure 14-13 show the timing for wait recovery. IAB $6E0B $6E0C $00FF $00FE $00FD $00FC IDB $A6 $A6 $A6 $01 $0B $6E EXITSTOPWAIT Note: EXITSTOPWAIT = RST pin OR CPU interrupt Figure 14-12. Wait Recovery from Interrupt MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 190 Freescale Semiconductor SIM Registers 32 CYCLES IAB $6E0B 32 CYCLES RST VCT H RST VCT L IDB $A6 $A6 $A6 RST CGMXCLK Figure 14-13. Wait Recovery from Internal Reset 14.6.2 Stop Mode In stop mode, the SIM counter is reset and the system clocks are disabled. An interrupt request from a module can cause an exit from stop mode. Stacking for interrupts begins after the selected stop recovery time has elapsed. Reset or break also causes an exit from stop mode. The SIM disables the clock generator module outputs (CGMOUT and CGMXCLK) in stop mode, stopping the CPU and peripherals. Stop recovery time is hard wired at the normal delay of 4096 CGMXCLK cycles. It is important to note that when using the PWM generator, its outputs will stop toggling when stop mode is entered. The PWM module must be disabled before entering stop mode to prevent external inverter failure. 14.7 SIM Registers This subsection describes the SIM registers. 14.7.1 SIM Break Status Register The SIM break status register (SBSR) contains a flag to indicate that a break caused an exit from wait mode. Address: Read: Write: Reset: R = Reserved $FE00 BIt 7 R 6 R 5 R 4 R 3 R 2 R 1 SBSW Note(1) 0 Note 1. Writing a logic 0 clears SBSW. Bit 0 R Figure 14-14. SIM Break Status Register (SBSR) SBSW — SIM Break Stop/Wait This status bit is useful in applications requiring a return to wait mode after exiting from a break interrupt. Clear SBSW by writing a logic 0 to it. Reset clears SBSW. 1 = Wait mode was exited by break interrupt. 0 = Wait mode was not exited by break interrupt. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 191 System Integration Module (SIM) SBSW can be read within the break state SWI routine. The user can modify the return address on the stack by subtracting one from it. 14.7.2 SIM Reset Status Register The SIM reset status register (SRSR) contains six flags that show the source of the last reset. Clear the SIM reset status register by reading it. A power-on reset sets the POR bit and clears all other bits in the register. Address: $FE01 BIt 7 Read: Write: Reset: POR R 1 R 6 PIN R 0 = Reserved 5 COP R 0 4 ILOP R 0 3 ILAD R 0 2 MENRST R 0 1 LVI R 0 Bit 0 0 R 0 Figure 14-15. SIM Reset Status Register (SRSR) POR — Power-On Reset Bit 1 = Last reset caused by POR circuit 0 = Read of SRSR PIN — External Reset Bit 1 = Last reset caused by external reset pin (RST) 0 = POR or read of SRSR COP — Computer Operating Properly Reset Bit 1 = Last reset caused by COP counter 0 = POR or read of SRSR ILOP — Illegal Opcode Reset Bit 1 = Last reset caused by an illegal opcode 0 = POR or read of SRSR ILAD — Illegal Address Reset Bit (opcode fetches only) 1 = Last reset caused by an opcode fetch from an illegal address 0 = POR or read of SRSR MENRST — Forced Monitor Mode Entry Reset Bit 1 = Last reset caused by the MENRST circuit 0 = POR or read of SRSR LVI — Low-Voltage Inhibit Reset Bit 1 = Last reset caused by the LVI circuit 0 = POR or read of SRSR MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 192 Freescale Semiconductor SIM Registers 14.7.3 SIM Break Flag Control Register The SIM break control register (SBFCR) contains a bit that enables software to clear status bits while the MCU is in a break state. Address: Read: Write: Reset: $FE03 BIt 7 BCFE 0 R = Reserved 6 R 5 R 4 R 3 R 2 R 1 R Bit 0 R Figure 14-16. SIM Break Flag Control Register (SBFCR) BCFE — Break Clear Flag Enable Bit This read/write bit enables software to clear status bits by accessing status registers while the MCU is in a break state. To clear status bits during the break state, the BCFE bit must be set. 1 = Status bits clearable during break 0 = Status bits not clearable during break MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 193 System Integration Module (SIM) MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 194 Freescale Semiconductor Chapter 15 Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) 15.1 Introduction The serial peripheral interface (SPI) module allows full-duplex, synchronous, serial communications with peripheral devices. 15.2 Features Features of the SPI module include: • Full-duplex operation • Master and slave modes • Double-buffered operation with separate transmit and receive registers • Four master mode frequencies (maximum = bus frequency ÷ 2) • Maximum slave mode frequency = bus frequency • Serial clock with programmable polarity and phase • Two separately enabled interrupts with central processor unit (CPU) service: – SPRF (SPI receiver full) – SPTE (SPI transmitter empty) • Mode fault error flag with CPU interrupt capability • Overflow error flag with CPU interrupt capability • Programmable wired-OR mode • I2C (inter-integrated circuit) compatibility 15.3 Pin Name Conventions The generic names of the SPI input/output (I/O) pins are: • SS, slave select • SPSCK, SPI serial clock • MOSI, master out/slave in • MISO, master in/slave out SPI pins are shared by parallel I/O ports or have alternate functions. The full name of an SPI pin reflects the name of the shared port pin or the name of an alternate pin function. The generic pin names appear in the text that follows. Table 15-1 shows the full names of the SPI I/O pins. Table 15-1. Pin Name Conventions Generic Pin Names: Full Pin Names: MISO PTF3/MISO MOSI PTF2/MOSI SPSCK PTF0/SPSCK SS PTF1/SS MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 195 DDRA PTA DDRB USER FLASH — 32,256 BYTES TIMER INTERFACE MODULE A USER RAM — 768 BYTES TIMER INTERFACE MODULE B PTB DDRC USER FLASH VECTOR SPACE — 46 BYTES OSC1 OSC2 CGMXFC SERIAL COMMUNICATIONS INTERFACE MODULE PTC RST SYSTEM INTEGRATION MODULE IRQ MODULE ANALOG-TO-DIGITAL CONVERTER MODULE POWER-ON RESET MODULE PTD DDRE VSS VDD VDDAD VSSAD PTF0/SPSCK(1) POWER Notes: 1. These pins are not available in the 56-pin SDIP package. 2. This module is not available in the 56-pin SDIP package. 3. In the 56-pin SDIP package, these pins are bonded together. Figure 15-1. Block Diagram Highlighting SPI Block and Pins DDRF PTF PWMGND PWM6–PWM1 PULSE-WIDTH MODULATOR MODULE PTF5/TxD PTF4/RxD PTF3/MISO(1) PTF2/MOSI(1) PTF1/SS(1) PTE 196 M68HC08 CPU CPU REGISTERS ARITHMETIC/LOGIC UNIT CONTROL AND STATUS REGISTERS — 112 BYTES Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) INTERNAL BUS PTA7–PTA0 PTB7/ATD7 PTB6/ATD6 PTB5/ATD5 PTB4/ATD4 PTB3/ATD3 PTB2/ATD2 PTB1/ATD1 PTB0/ATD0 PTC6 PTC5 PTC4 PTC3 PTC2 PTC1/ATD9(1) PTC0/ATD8 PTD6/IS3 PTD5/IS2 PTD4/IS1 PTD3/FAULT4 PTD2/FAULT3 PTD1/FAULT2 PTD0/FAULT1 PTE7/TCH3A PTE6/TCH2A PTE5/TCH1A PTE4/TCH0A PTE3/TCLKA PTE2/TCH1B(1) PTE1/TCH0B(1) PTE0/TCLKB(1) LOW-VOLTAGE INHIBIT MODULE COMPUTER OPERATING PROPERLY MODULE MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor MONITOR ROM — 240 BYTES CLOCK GENERATOR MODULE SERIAL PERIPHERAL INTERFACE MODULE(2) IRQ VDDA VSSA(3) VREFL(3) VREFH SINGLE BREAK MODULE Functional Description 15.4 Functional Description Figure 15-2 shows the structure of the SPI module and Figure 15-3 shows the locations and contents of the SPI I/O registers. The SPI module allows full-duplex, synchronous, serial communication between the microcontroller unit (MCU) and peripheral devices, including other MCUs. Software can poll the SPI status flags or SPI operation can be interrupt-driven. All SPI interrupts can be serviced by the CPU. INTERNAL BUS TRANSMIT DATA REGISTER CGMOUT ÷ 2 (FROM SIM) 7 ÷2 CLOCK DIVIDER ÷8 ÷ 32 ÷ 128 CLOCK SELECT RECEIVE DATA REGISTER PIN CONTROL LOGIC SPSCK CLOCK LOGIC M S SS SPR1 SPR0 6 SHIFT REGISTER 5 4 3 2 1 0 MISO MOSI SPMSTR SPE SPMSTR CPHA CPOL TRANSMITTER CPU INTERRUPT REQUEST SPI CONTROL RECEIVER/ERROR CPU INTERRUPT REQUEST SPWOM MODFEN ERRIE SPTIE SPRIE SPE SPRF SPTE OVRF MODF Figure 15-2. SPI Module Block Diagram MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 197 Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) Addr. $0044 Register Name SPI Control Register Read: (SPCR) Write: See page 211. Reset: SPI Status and Control Read: Register (SPSCR) Write: See page 212. Reset: SPI Data Register Read: (SPDR) Write: See page 214. Reset: Bit 7 SPRIE 0 SPRF R 0 R7 T7 R 6 R 0 ERRIE 0 R6 T6 = Reserved 5 SPMSTR 1 OVRF R 0 R5 T5 4 CPOL 0 MODF R 0 R4 T4 3 CPHA 1 SPTE R 1 R3 T3 2 SPWOM 0 MODFEN 0 R2 T2 1 SPE 0 SPR1 0 R1 T1 Bit 0 SPTIE 0 SPR0 0 R0 T0 $0045 $0046 Unaffected by reset Figure 15-3. SPI I/O Register Summary 15.4.1 Master Mode The SPI operates in master mode when the SPI master bit, SPMSTR, is set. NOTE Configure the SPI modules as master or slave before enabling them. Enable the master SPI before enabling the slave SPI. Disable the slave SPI before disabling the master SPI. See 15.12.1 SPI Control Register. Only a master SPI module can initiate transmissions. Software begins the transmission from a master SPI module by writing to the SPI data register. If the shift register is empty, the byte immediately transfers to the shift register, setting the SPI transmitter empty bit, SPTE. The byte begins shifting out on the MOSI pin under the control of the serial clock. See Figure 15-4. MASTER MCU MISO MOSI SPSCK BAUD RATE GENERATOR SS MISO MOSI SPSCK SS SLAVE MCU SHIFT REGISTER SHIFT REGISTER VDD Figure 15-4. Full-Duplex Master-Slave Connections The SPR1 and SPR0 bits control the baud rate generator and determine the speed of the shift register. See 15.12.2 SPI Status and Control Register. Through the SPSCK pin, the baud-rate generator of the master also controls the shift register of the slave peripheral. As the byte shifts out on the MOSI pin of the master, another byte shifts in from the slave on the master’s MISO pin. The transmission ends when the receiver full bit, SPRF, becomes set. At the same time that SPRF becomes set, the byte from the slave transfers to the receive data register. In normal operation, MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 198 Freescale Semiconductor Transmission Formats SPRF signals the end of a transmission. Software clears SPRF by reading the SPI status and control register with SPRF set and then reading the SPI data register. Writing to the SPI data register clears the SPTE bit. 15.4.2 Slave Mode The SPI operates in slave mode when the SPMSTR bit is clear. In slave mode the SPSCK pin is the input for the serial clock from the master MCU. Before a data transmission occurs, the SS pin of the slave SPI must be at logic 0. SS must remain low until the transmission is complete. See 15.6.2 Mode Fault Error. In a slave SPI module, data enters the shift register under the control of the serial clock from the master SPI module. After a byte enters the shift register of a slave SPI, it transfers to the receive data register, and the SPRF bit is set. To prevent an overflow condition, slave software then must read the receive data register before another full byte enters the shift register. The maximum frequency of the SPSCK for an SPI configured as a slave is the bus clock speed (which is twice as fast as the fastest master SPSCK clock that can be generated). The frequency of the SPSCK for an SPI configured as a slave does not have to correspond to any SPI baud rate. The baud rate only controls the speed of the SPSCK generated by an SPI configured as a master. Therefore, the frequency of the SPSCK for an SPI configured as a slave can be any frequency less than or equal to the bus speed. When the master SPI starts a transmission, the data in the slave shift register begins shifting out on the MISO pin. The slave can load its shift register with a new byte for the next transmission by writing to its transmit data register. The slave must write to its transmit data register at least one bus cycle before the master starts the next transmission. Otherwise, the byte already in the slave shift register shifts out on the MISO pin. Data written to the slave shift register during a transmission remains in a buffer until the end of the transmission. When the clock phase bit (CPHA) is set, the first edge of SPSCK starts a transmission. When CPHA is clear, the falling edge of SS starts a transmission. See 15.5 Transmission Formats. NOTE If the write to the data register is late, the SPI transmits the data already in the shift register from the previous transmission. SPSCK must be in the proper idle state before the slave is enabled to prevent SPSCK from appearing as a clock edge. 15.5 Transmission Formats During an SPI transmission, data is simultaneously transmitted (shifted out serially) and received (shifted in serially). A serial clock synchronizes shifting and sampling on the two serial data lines. A slave select line allows selection of an individual slave SPI device; slave devices that are not selected do not interfere with SPI bus activities. On a master SPI device, the slave select line can optionally be used to indicate multiple-master bus contention. 15.5.1 Clock Phase and Polarity Controls Software can select any of four combinations of serial clock (SPSCK) phase and polarity using two bits in the SPI control register (SPCR). The clock polarity is specified by the CPOL control bit, which selects an active high or low clock and has no significant effect on the transmission format. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 199 Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) The clock phase (CPHA) control bit selects one of two fundamentally different transmission formats. The clock phase and polarity should be identical for the master SPI device and the communicating slave device. In some cases, the phase and polarity are changed between transmissions to allow a master device to communicate with peripheral slaves having different requirements. NOTE Before writing to the CPOL bit or the CPHA bit, disable the SPI by clearing the SPI enable bit (SPE). 15.5.2 Transmission Format When CPHA = 0 Figure 15-5 shows an SPI transmission in which CPHA is logic 0. The figure should not be used as a replacement for data sheet parametric information.Two waveforms are shown for SPSCK: one for CPOL = 0 and another for CPOL = 1. The diagram may be interpreted as a master or slave timing diagram since the serial clock (SPSCK), master in/slave out (MISO), and master out/slave in (MOSI) pins are directly connected between the master and the slave. The MISO signal is the output from the slave, and the MOSI signal is the output from the master. The SS line is the slave select input to the slave. The slave SPI drives its MISO output only when its slave select input (SS) is at logic 0, so that only the selected slave drives to the master. The SS pin of the master is not shown but is assumed to be inactive. The SS pin of the master must be high or must be reconfigured as general-purpose I/O not affecting the SPI. (See 15.6.2 Mode Fault Error.) When CPHA = 0, the first SPSCK edge is the MSB capture strobe. Therefore, the slave must begin driving its data before the first SPSCK edge, and a falling edge on the SS pin is used to start the slave data transmission. The slave’s SS pin must be toggled back to high and then low again between each byte transmitted as shown in Figure 15-6. SPSCK CYCLE # FOR REFERENCE SPSCK, CPOL = 0 SPSCK, CPOL = 1 MOSI FROM MASTER MISO FROM SLAVE SS, TO SLAVE CAPTURE STROBE 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 MSB MSB BIT 6 BIT 6 BIT 5 BIT 5 BIT 4 BIT 4 BIT 3 BIT 3 BIT 2 BIT 2 BIT 1 BIT 1 LSB LSB Figure 15-5. Transmission Format (CPHA = 0) MISO/MOSI MASTER SS SLAVE SS CPHA = 0 SLAVE SS CPHA = 1 BYTE 1 BYTE 2 BYTE 3 Figure 15-6. CPHA/SS Timing MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 200 Freescale Semiconductor Transmission Formats When CPHA = 0 for a slave, the falling edge of SS indicates the beginning of the transmission. This causes the SPI to leave its idle state and begin driving the MISO pin with the MSB of its data. Once the transmission begins, no new data is allowed into the shift register from the transmit data register. Therefore, the SPI data register of the slave must be loaded with transmit data before the falling edge of SS. Any data written after the falling edge is stored in the transmit data register and transferred to the shift register after the current transmission. 15.5.3 Transmission Format When CPHA = 1 Figure 15-7 shows an SPI transmission in which CPHA is logic 1. The figure should not be used as a replacement for data sheet parametric information. Two waveforms are shown for SPSCK: one for CPOL = 0 and another for CPOL = 1. The diagram may be interpreted as a master or slave timing diagram since the serial clock (SPSCK), master in/slave out (MISO), and master out/slave in (MOSI) pins are directly connected between the master and the slave. The MISO signal is the output from the slave, and the MOSI signal is the output from the master. The SS line is the slave select input to the slave. The slave SPI drives its MISO output only when its slave select input (SS) is at logic 0, so that only the selected slave drives to the master. The SS pin of the master is not shown but is assumed to be inactive. The SS pin of the master must be high or must be reconfigured as general-purpose I/O not affecting the SPI. See 15.6.2 Mode Fault Error. When CPHA = 1, the master begins driving its MOSI pin on the first SPSCK edge. Therefore, the slave uses the first SPSCK edge as a start transmission signal. The SS pin can remain low between transmissions. This format may be preferable in systems having only one master and only one slave driving the MISO data line. When CPHA = 1 for a slave, the first edge of the SPSCK indicates the beginning of the transmission. This causes the SPI to leave its idle state and begin driving the MISO pin with the MSB of its data. Once the transmission begins, no new data is allowed into the shift register from the transmit data register. Therefore, the SPI data register of the slave must be loaded with transmit data before the first edge of SPSCK. Any data written after the first edge is stored in the transmit data register and transferred to the shift register after the current transmission. SPSCK CYCLE # FOR REFERENCE SPSCK, CPOL = 0 SPSCK, CPOL = 1 MOSI FROM MASTER MISO FROM SLAVE SS, TO SLAVE CAPTURE STROBE MSB MSB BIT 6 BIT 6 BIT 5 BIT 5 BIT 4 BIT 4 BIT 3 BIT 3 BIT 2 BIT 2 BIT 1 BIT 1 LSB LSB 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 Figure 15-7. Transmission Format (CPHA = 1) 15.5.4 Transmission Initiation Latency When the SPI is configured as a master (SPMSTR = 1), writing to the SPDR starts a transmission. CPHA has no effect on the delay to the start of the transmission, but it does affect the initial state of the SPSCK signal. When CPHA = 0, the SPSCK signal remains inactive for the first half of the first SPSCK cycle. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 201 Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) When CPHA = 1, the first SPSCK cycle begins with an edge on the SPSCK line from its inactive to its active level. The SPI clock rate (selected by SPR1:SPR0) affects the delay from the write to SPDR and the start of the SPI transmission. See Figure 15-8 The internal SPI clock in the master is a free-running derivative of the internal MCU clock. To conserve power, it is enabled only when both the SPE and SPMSTR bits are set. SPSCK edges occur halfway through the low time of the internal MCU clock. Since the SPI clock is free-running, it is uncertain where the write to the SPDR occurs relative to the slower SPSCK. This uncertainty causes the variation in the initiation delay shown in Figure 15-8. This delay is no longer than a single SPI bit time. That is, the maximum delay is two MCU bus cycles for DIV2, eight MCU bus cycles for DIV8, 32 MCU bus cycles for DIV32, and 128 MCU bus cycles for DIV128. WRITE TO SPDR BUS CLOCK MOSI SPSCK CPHA = 1 SPSCK CPHA = 0 SPSCK CYCLE NUMBER 1 2 3 INITIATION DELAY MSB BIT 6 BIT 5 INITIATION DELAY FROM WRITE SPDR TO TRANSFER BEGIN WRITE TO SPDR BUS CLOCK EARLIEST LATEST WRITE TO SPDR BUS CLOCK SPSCK = INTERNAL CLOCK ÷ 8; 8 POSSIBLE START POINTS SPSCK = INTERNAL CLOCK ÷ 2; 2 POSSIBLE START POINTS EARLIEST WRITE TO SPDR BUS CLOCK LATEST EARLIEST WRITE TO SPDR BUS CLOCK SPSCK = INTERNAL CLOCK ÷ 32; 32 POSSIBLE START POINTS LATEST EARLIEST SPSCK = INTERNAL CLOCK ÷ 128; 128 POSSIBLE START POINTS LATEST Figure 15-8. Transmission Start Delay (Master) MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 202 Freescale Semiconductor Error Conditions 15.6 Error Conditions These flags signal SPI error conditions: • Overflow (OVRF) — Failing to read the SPI data register before the next full byte enters the shift register sets the OVRF bit. The new byte does not transfer to the receive data register, and the unread byte still can be read. OVRF is in the SPI status and control register. • Mode fault error (MODF) — The MODF bit indicates that the voltage on the slave select pin (SS) is inconsistent with the mode of the SPI. MODF is in the SPI status and control register. 15.6.1 Overflow Error The overflow flag (OVRF) becomes set if the receive data register still has unread data from a previous transmission when the capture strobe of bit 1 of the next transmission occurs. If an overflow occurs, all data received after the overflow and before the OVRF bit is cleared does not transfer to the receive data register and does not set the SPI receiver full bit (SPRF). The unread data that transferred to the receive data register before the overflow occurred can still be read. Therefore, an overflow error always indicates the loss of data. Clear the overflow flag by reading the SPI status and control register and then reading the SPI data register. OVRF generates a receiver/error CPU interrupt request if the error interrupt enable bit (ERRIE) is also set. MODF and OVRF can generate a receiver/error CPU interrupt request. See Figure 15-11. It is not possible to enable MODF or OVRF individually to generate a receiver/error CPU interrupt request. However, leaving MODFEN low prevents MODF from being set. If the CPU SPRF interrupt is enabled and the OVRF interrupt is not, watch for an overflow condition. Figure 15-9 shows how it is possible to miss an overflow. The first part of Figure 15-9 shows how it is possible to read the SPSCR and SPDR to clear the SPRF without problems. However, as illustrated by the second transmission example, the OVRF bit can be set in between the time that SPSCR and SPDR are read. BYTE 1 1 SPRF BYTE 2 4 BYTE 3 6 BYTE 4 8 OVRF READ SPSCR READ SPDR 1 2 3 4 2 5 3 BYTE 1 SETS SPRF BIT. CPU READS SPSCR WITH SPRF BIT SET AND OVRF BIT CLEAR. CPU READS BYTE 1 IN SPDR, CLEARING SPRF BIT. BYTE 2 SETS SPRF BIT. 5 6 7 8 7 CPU READS SPSCR WITH SPRF BIT SET AND OVRF BIT CLEAR. BYTE 3 SETS OVRF BIT. BYTE 3 IS LOST. CPU READS BYTE 2 IN SPDR, CLEARING SPRF BIT, BUT NOT OVRF BIT. BYTE 4 FAILS TO SET SPRF BIT BECAUSE OVRF BIT IS NOT CLEARED. BYTE 4 IS LOST. Figure 15-9. Missed Read of Overflow Condition MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 203 Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) In this case, an overflow can easily be missed. Since no more SPRF interrupts can be generated until this OVRF is serviced, it is not obvious that bytes are being lost as more transmissions are completed. To prevent this, either enable the OVRF interrupt or do another read of the SPSCR following the read of the SPDR. This ensures that the OVRF was not set before the SPRF was cleared and that future transmissions can set the SPRF bit. Figure 15-10 illustrates this process. Generally, to avoid this second SPSCR read, enable the OVRF interrupt to the CPU by setting the ERRIE bit. BYTE 1 SPI RECEIVE COMPLETE SPRF OVRF READ SPSCR READ SPDR 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 2 3 BYTE 1 SETS SPRF BIT. CPU READS SPSCR WITH SPRF BIT SET AND OVRF BIT CLEAR. CPU READS BYTE 1 IN SPDR, CLEARING SPRF BIT. CPU READS SPSCR AGAIN TO CHECK OVRF BIT. BYTE 2 SETS SPRF BIT. CPU READS SPSCR WITH SPRF BIT SET AND OVRF BIT CLEAR. BYTE 3 SETS OVRF BIT. BYTE 3 IS LOST. 4 6 8 8 9 9 10 12 13 14 1 BYTE 2 5 BYTE 3 7 BYTE 4 11 CPU READS BYTE 2 IN SPDR, CLEARING SPRF BIT. CPU READS SPSCR AGAIN TO CHECK OVRF BIT. 10 CPU READS BYTE 2 SPDR, CLEARING OVRF BIT. 11 BYTE 4 SETS SPRF BIT. 12 CPU READS SPSCR. 13 CPU READS BYTE 4 IN SPDR, CLEARING SPRF BIT. 14 CPU READS SPSCR AGAIN TO CHECK OVRF BIT. Figure 15-10. Clearing SPRF When OVRF Interrupt Is Not Enabled 15.6.2 Mode Fault Error Setting the SPMSTR bit selects master mode and configures the SPSCK and MOSI pins as outputs and the MISO pin as an input. Clearing SPMSTR selects slave mode and configures the SPSCK and MOSI pins as inputs and the MISO pin as an output. The mode fault bit, MODF, becomes set any time the state of the slave select pin, SS, is inconsistent with the mode selected by SPMSTR. To prevent SPI pin contention and damage to the MCU, a mode fault error occurs if: • The SS pin of a slave SPI goes high during a transmission. • The SS pin of a master SPI goes low at any time. For the MODF flag to be set, the mode fault error enable bit (MODFEN) must be set. Clearing the MODFEN bit does not clear the MODF flag but does prevent MODF from being set again after MODF is cleared. MODF generates a receiver/error CPU interrupt request if the error interrupt enable bit (ERRIE) is also set. The SPRF, MODF, and OVRF interrupts share the same CPU interrupt vector. MODF and OVRF can generate a receiver/error CPU interrupt request. See Figure 15-11. It is not possible to enable MODF or MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 204 Freescale Semiconductor Error Conditions OVRF individually to generate a receiver/error CPU interrupt request. However, leaving MODFEN low prevents MODF from being set. In a master SPI with the mode fault enable bit (MODFEN) set, the mode fault flag (MODF) is set if SS goes to logic 0. A mode fault in a master SPI causes these events to occur: • If ERRIE = 1, the SPI generates an SPI receiver/error CPU interrupt request. • The SPE bit is cleared. • The SPTE bit is set. • The SPI state counter is cleared. • The data direction register of the shared I/O port regains control of port drivers. NOTE To prevent bus contention with another master SPI after a mode fault error, clear all SPI bits of the data direction register of the shared I/O port before enabling the SPI. When configured as a slave (SPMSTR = 0), the MODF flag is set if SS goes high during a transmission. When CPHA = 0, a transmission begins when SS goes low and ends once the incoming SPSCK goes back to its idle level following the shift of the eighth data bit. When CPHA = 1, the transmission begins when the SPSCK leaves its idle level and SS is already low. The transmission continues until the SPSCK returns to its idle level following the shift of the last data bit. See 15.5 Transmission Formats. NOTE Setting the MODF flag does not clear the SPMSTR bit. Reading SPMSTR when MODF = 1 will indicate a mode fault error occurred in either master mode or slave mode. When CPHA = 0, a MODF occurs if a slave is selected (SS is at logic 0) and later unselected (SS is at logic 1) even if no SPSCK is sent to that slave. This happens because SS at logic 0 indicates the start of the transmission (MISO driven out with the value of MSB) for CPHA = 0. When CPHA = 1, a slave can be selected and then later unselected with no transmission occurring. Therefore, MODF does not occur since a transmission was never begun. In a slave SPI (MSTR = 0), the MODF bit generates an SPI receiver/error CPU interrupt request if the ERRIE bit is set. The MODF bit does not clear the SPE bit or reset the SPI in any way. Software can abort the SPI transmission by clearing the SPE bit of the slave. NOTE A logic 1 voltage on the SS pin of a slave SPI puts the MISO pin in a high impedance state. Also, the slave SPI ignores all incoming SPSCK clocks, even if it was already in the middle of a transmission. To clear the MODF flag, read the SPSCR with the MODF bit set and then write to the SPCR register. This entire clearing procedure must occur with no MODF condition existing or else the flag is not cleared. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 205 Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) 15.7 Interrupts Four SPI status flags can be enabled to generate CPU interrupt requests as shown in Table 15-2. Table 15-2. SPI Interrupts Flag SPTE transmitter empty SPRF receiver full OVRF overflow MODF mode fault Request SPI transmitter CPU interrupt request (SPTIE = 1, SPE = 1) SPI receiver CPU interrupt request (SPRIE = 1) SPI receiver/error interrupt request (ERRIE = 1) SPI receiver/error interrupt request (ERRIE = 1) The SPI transmitter interrupt enable bit (SPTIE) enables the SPTE flag to generate transmitter CPU interrupt requests, provided that the SPI is enabled (SPE = 1). The SPI receiver interrupt enable bit (SPRIE) enables the SPRF bit to generate receiver CPU interrupt requests, provided that the SPI is enabled (SPE = 1). (See Figure 15-11.) SPTE SPTIE SPE SPI TRANSMITTER CPU INTERRUPT REQUEST SPRIE SPRF SPI RECEIVER/ERROR ERRIE MODF OVRF CPU INTERRUPT REQUEST Figure 15-11. SPI Interrupt Request Generation The error interrupt enable bit (ERRIE) enables both the MODF and OVRF bits to generate a receiver/error CPU interrupt request. The mode fault enable bit (MODFEN) can prevent the MODF flag from being set so that only the OVRF bit is enabled by the ERRIE bit to generate receiver/error CPU interrupt requests. These sources in the SPI status and control register can generate CPU interrupt requests: • SPI receiver full bit (SPRF) — The SPRF bit becomes set every time a byte transfers from the shift register to the receive data register. If the SPI receiver interrupt enable bit, SPRIE, is also set, SPRF can generate either an SPI receiver/error or CPU interrupt. • SPI transmitter empty (SPTE) — The SPTE bit becomes set every time a byte transfers from the transmit data register to the shift register. If the SPI transmit interrupt enable bit, SPTIE, is also set, SPTE can generate either an SPTE or CPU interrupt request. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 206 Freescale Semiconductor Resetting the SPI 15.8 Resetting the SPI Any system reset completely resets the SPI. Partial resets occur whenever the SPI enable bit (SPE) is low. Whenever SPE is low: • The SPTE flag is set. • Any transmission currently in progress is aborted. • The shift register is cleared. • The SPI state counter is cleared, making it ready for a new complete transmission. • All the SPI port logic is defaulted back to being general-purpose I/O. These items are reset only by a system reset: • All control bits in the SPCR • All control bits in the SPSCR (MODFEN, ERRIE, SPR1, and SPR0) • The status flags SPRF, OVRF, and MODF By not resetting the control bits when SPE is low, the user can clear SPE between transmissions without having to set all control bits again when SPE is set back high for the next transmission. By not resetting the SPRF, OVRF, and MODF flags, the user can still service these interrupts after the SPI has been disabled. The user can disable the SPI by writing 0 to the SPE bit. The SPI can also be disabled by a mode fault occurring in an SPI that was configured as a master with the MODFEN bit set. 15.9 Queuing Transmission Data The double-buffered transmit data register allows a data byte to be queued and transmitted. For an SPI configured as a master, a queued data byte is transmitted immediately after the previous transmission has completed. The SPI transmitter empty flag (SPTE) indicates when the transmit data buffer is ready to accept new data. Write to the transmit data register only when the SPTE bit is high. Figure 15-12 shows the timing associated with doing back-to-back transmissions with the SPI (SPSCK has CPHA:CPOL = 1:0). For a slave, the transmit data buffer allows back-to-back transmissions without the slave precisely timing its writes between transmissions as in a system with a single data buffer. Also, if no new data is written to the data buffer, the last value contained in the shift register is the next data word to be transmitted. For an idle master or idle slave that has no data loaded into its transmit buffer, the SPTE is set again no more than two bus cycles after the transmit buffer empties into the shift register. This allows the user to queue up a 16-bit value to send. For an already active slave, the load of the shift register cannot occur until the transmission is completed. This implies that a back-to-back write to the transmit data register is not possible. The SPTE indicates when the next write can occur. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 207 Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) WRITE TO SPDR SPTE SPSCK CPHA:CPOL = 1:0 MOSI 1 2 3 5 8 10 MSBBIT BIT BIT BIT BIT BIT LSBMSBBIT BIT BIT BIT BIT BIT LSBMSBBIT BIT BIT 654 654321 654321 BYTE 1 BYTE 2 BYTE 3 4 6 7 7 CPU READS SPDR, CLEARING SPRF BIT. 8 CPU WRITES BYTE 3 TO SPDR, QUEUEING BYTE 3 AND CLEARING SPTE BIT. 9 SECOND INCOMING BYTE TRANSFERS FROM SHIFT REGISTER TO RECEIVE DATA REGISTER, SETTING SPRF BIT. 10 BYTE 3 TRANSFERS FROM TRANSMIT DATA REGISTER TO SHIFT REGISTER, SETTING SPTE BIT. 11 CPU READS SPSCR WITH SPRF BIT SET. 12 CPU READS SPDR, CLEARING SPRF BIT. 9 11 12 SPRF READ SPSCR READ SPDR 1 CPU WRITES BYTE 1 TO SPDR, CLEARING SPTE BIT. 2 BYTE 1 TRANSFERS FROM TRANSMIT DATA REGISTER TO SHIFT REGISTER, SETTING SPTE BIT. 3 CPU WRITES BYTE 2 TO SPDR, QUEUEING BYTE 2 AND CLEARING SPTE BIT. 4 FIRST INCOMING BYTE TRANSFERS FROM SHIFT REGISTER TO RECEIVE DATA REGISTER, SETTING SPRF BIT. 5 BYTE 2 TRANSFERS FROM TRANSMIT DATA REGISTER TO SHIFT REGISTER, SETTING SPTE BIT. 6 CPU READS SPSCR WITH SPRF BIT SET. Figure 15-12. SPRF/SPTE CPU Interrupt Timing 15.10 Low-Power Mode The WAIT instruction puts the MCU in a low power-consumption standby mode. The SPI module remains active after the execution of a WAIT instruction. In wait mode the SPI module registers are not accessible by the CPU. Any enabled CPU interrupt request from the SPI module can bring the MCU out of wait mode. If SPI module functions are not required during wait mode, reduce power consumption by disabling the SPI module before executing the WAIT instruction. To exit wait mode when an overflow condition occurs, enable the OVRF bit to generate CPU interrupt requests by setting the error interrupt enable bit (ERRIE). See 15.7 Interrupts. Since the SPTE bit cannot be cleared during a break with the BCFE bit cleared, a write to the transmit data register in break mode does not initiate a transmission nor is this data transferred into the shift register. Therefore, a write to the SPDR in break mode with the BCFE bit cleared has no effect. 15.11 I/O Signals The SPI module has five I/O pins and shares four of them with a parallel I/O port. The pins are: • MISO — Data received • MOSI — Data transmitted • SPSCK — Serial clock • SS — Slave select MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 208 Freescale Semiconductor I/O Signals The SPI has limited inter-integrated circuit (I2C) capability (requiring software support) as a master in a single-master environment. To communicate with I2C peripherals, MOSI becomes an open-drain output when the SPWOM bit in the SPI control register is set. In I2C communication, the MOSI and MISO pins are connected to a bidirectional pin from the I2C peripheral and through a pullup resistor to VDD. 15.11.1 MISO (Master In/Slave Out) MISO is one of the two SPI module pins that transmits serial data. In full duplex operation, the MISO pin of the master SPI module is connected to the MISO pin of the slave SPI module. The master SPI simultaneously receives data on its MISO pin and transmits data from its MOSI pin. Slave output data on the MISO pin is enabled only when the SPI is configured as a slave. The SPI is configured as a slave when its SPMSTR bit is logic 0 and its SS pin is at logic 0. To support a multiple-slave system, a logic 1 on the SS pin puts the MISO pin in a high-impedance state. When enabled, the SPI controls data direction of the MISO pin regardless of the state of the data direction register of the shared I/O port. 15.11.2 MOSI (Master Out/Slave In) MOSI is one of the two SPI module pins that transmits serial data. In full-duplex operation, the MOSI pin of the master SPI module is connected to the MOSI pin of the slave SPI module. The master SPI simultaneously transmits data from its MOSI pin and receives data on its MISO pin. When enabled, the SPI controls data direction of the MOSI pin regardless of the state of the data direction register of the shared I/O port. 15.11.3 SPSCK (Serial Clock) The serial clock synchronizes data transmission between master and slave devices. In a master MCU, the SPSCK pin is the clock output. In a slave MCU, the SPSCK pin is the clock input. In full-duplex operation, the master and slave MCUs exchange a byte of data in eight serial clock cycles. When enabled, the SPI controls data direction of the SPSCK pin regardless of the state of the data direction register of the shared I/O port. 15.11.4 SS (Slave Select) The SS pin has various functions depending on the current state of the SPI. For an SPI configured as a slave, the SS is used to select a slave. For CPHA = 0, the SS is used to define the start of a transmission. See 15.5 Transmission Formats. Since it is used to indicate the start of a transmission, the SS must be toggled high and low between each byte transmitted for the CPHA = 0 format. However, it can remain low between transmissions for the CPHA = 1 format. See Figure 15-13. MISO/MOSI MASTER SS SLAVE SS CPHA = 0 SLAVE SS CPHA = 1 BYTE 1 BYTE 2 BYTE 3 Figure 15-13. CPHA/SS Timing MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 209 Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) When an SPI is configured as a slave, the SS pin is always configured as an input. It cannot be used as a general-purpose I/O regardless of the state of the MODFEN control bit. However, the MODFEN bit can still prevent the state of the SS from creating a MODF error. See 15.12.2 SPI Status and Control Register. NOTE A logic 1 voltage on the SS pin of a slave SPI puts the MISO pin in a high-impedance state. The slave SPI ignores all incoming SPSCK clocks, even if it was already in the middle of a transmission. When an SPI is configured as a master, the SS input can be used in conjunction with the MODF flag to prevent multiple masters from driving MOSI and SPSCK. (See 15.6.2 Mode Fault Error.) For the state of the SS pin to set the MODF flag, the MODFEN bit in the SPSCK register must be set. If the MODFEN bit is low for an SPI master, the SS pin can be used as a general-purpose I/O under the control of the data direction register of the shared I/O port. With MODFEN high, it is an input-only pin to the SPI regardless of the state of the data direction register of the shared I/O port. The CPU can always read the state of the SS pin by configuring the appropriate pin as an input and reading the port data register. See Table 15-3. Table 15-3. SPI Configuration SPE 0 1 1 1 SPMSTR X(1) 0 1 1 MODFEN X X 0 1 SPI Configuration Not enabled Slave Master without MODF Master with MODF State of SS Logic General-purpose I/O; SS ignored by SPI Input-only to SPI General-purpose I/O; SS ignored by SPI Input-only to SPI 1. X = don’t care 15.11.5 VSS (Clock Ground) VSS is the ground return for the serial clock pin, SPSCK, and the ground for the port output buffers. To reduce the ground return path loop and minimize radio frequency (RF) emissions, connect the ground pin of the slave to the VSS pin of the master. 15.12 I/O Registers Three registers control and monitor SPI operation: • SPI control register, SPCR • SPI status and control register, SPSCR • SPI data register, SPDR 15.12.1 SPI Control Register The SPI control register (SPCR): • Enables SPI module interrupt requests • Selects CPU interrupt requests or DMA service requests • Configures the SPI module as master or slave • Selects serial clock polarity and phase • Configures the SPSCK, MOSI, and MISO pins as open-drain outputs • Enables the SPI module MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 210 Freescale Semiconductor I/O Registers Address: $0044 Bit 7 Read: Write: Reset: SPRIE 0 R 6 R 0 = Reserved 5 SPMSTR 1 4 CPOL 0 3 CPHA 1 2 SPWOM 0 1 SPE 0 Bit 0 SPTIE 0 Figure 15-14. SPI Control Register (SPCR) SPRIE — SPI Receiver Interrupt Enable Bit This read/write bit enables CPU interrupt requests generated by the SPRF bit. The SPRF bit is set when a byte transfers from the shift register to the receive data register. Reset clears the SPRIE bit. 1 = SPRF CPU interrupt requests enabled 0 = SPRF CPU interrupt requests disabled SPMSTR — SPI Master Bit This read/write bit selects master mode operation or slave mode operation. Reset sets the SPMSTR bit. 1 = Master mode 0 = Slave mode CPOL — Clock Polarity Bit This read/write bit determines the logic state of the SPSCK pin between transmissions. See Figure 15-5 and Figure 15-7. To transmit data between SPI modules, the SPI modules must have identical CPOL values. Reset clears the CPOL bit. CPHA — Clock Phase Bit This read/write bit controls the timing relationship between the serial clock and SPI data. See Figure 15-5 and Figure 15-7. To transmit data between SPI modules, the SPI modules must have identical CPHA bits. When CPHA = 0, the SS pin of the slave SPI module must be set to logic 1 between bytes. See Figure 15-13. Reset sets the CPHA bit. When CPHA = 0 for a slave, the falling edge of SS indicates the beginning of the transmission. This causes the SPI to leave its idle state and begin driving the MISO pin with the MSB of its data, once the transmission begins, no new data is allowed into the shift register from the data register. Therefore, the slave data register must be loaded with the desired transmit data before the falling edge of SS. Any data written after the falling edge is stored in the data register and transferred to the shift register at the current transmission. When CPHA = 1 for a slave, the first edge of the SPSCK indicates the beginning of the transmission. The same applies when SS is high for a slave. The MISO pin is held in a high-impedance state, and the incoming SPSCK is ignored. In certain cases, it may also cause the MODF flag to be set. See 15.6.2 Mode Fault Error. A logic 1 on the SS pin does not in any way affect the state of the SPI state machine. SPWOM — SPI Wired-OR Mode Bit This read/write bit disables the pullup devices on pins SPSCK, MOSI, and MISO so that those pins become open-drain outputs. 1 = Wired-OR SPSCK, MOSI, and MISO pins 0 = Normal push-pull SPSCK, MOSI, and MISO pins MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 211 Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) SPE — SPI Enable Bit This read/write bit enables the SPI module. Clearing SPE causes a partial reset of the SPI. See 15.8 Resetting the SPI. Reset clears the SPE bit. 1 = SPI module enabled 0 = SPI module disabled SPTIE— SPI Transmit Interrupt Enable Bit This read/write bit enables CPU interrupt requests generated by the SPTE bit. SPTE is set when a byte transfers from the transmit data register to the shift register. Reset clears the SPTIE bit. 1 = SPTE CPU interrupt requests enabled 0 = SPTE CPU interrupt requests disabled 15.12.2 SPI Status and Control Register The SPI status and control register (SPSCR) contains flags to signal these conditions: • Receive data register full • Failure to clear SPRF bit before next byte is received (overflow error) • Inconsistent logic level on SS pin (mode fault error) • Transmit data register empty The SPI status and control register also contains bits that perform these functions: • Enable error interrupts • Enable mode fault error detection • Select master SPI baud rate Address: $0045 Bit 7 Read: Write: Reset: SPRF R 0 R 6 ERRIE 0 = Reserved 5 OVRF R 0 4 MODF R 0 3 SPTE R 1 2 MODFEN 0 1 SPR1 0 Bit 0 SPR0 0 Figure 15-15. SPI Status and Control Register (SPSCR) SPRF — SPI Receiver Full Bit This clearable, read-only flag is set each time a byte transfers from the shift register to the receive data register. SPRF generates a CPU interrupt request if the SPRIE bit in the SPI control register is set also. During an SPRF CPU interrupt (DMAS = 0), the CPU clears SPRF by reading the SPI status and control register with SPRF set and then reading the SPI data register. Reset clears the SPRF bit. 1 = Receive data register full 0 = Receive data register not full ERRIE — Error Interrupt Enable Bit This read/write bit enables the MODF and OVRF bits to generate CPU interrupt requests. Reset clears the ERRIE bit. 1 = MODF and OVRF can generate CPU interrupt requests. 0 = MODF and OVRF cannot generate CPU interrupt requests. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 212 Freescale Semiconductor I/O Registers OVRF — Overflow Bit This clearable, read-only flag is set if software does not read the byte in the receive data register before the next full byte enters the shift register. In an overflow condition, the byte already in the receive data register is unaffected, and the byte that shifted in last is lost. Clear the OVRF bit by reading the SPI status and control register with OVRF set and then reading the receive data register. Reset clears the OVRF bit. 1 = Overflow 0 = No overflow MODF — Mode Fault Bit This clearable, read-only flag is set in a slave SPI if the SS pin goes high during a transmission with the MODFEN bit set. In a master SPI, the MODF flag is set if the SS pin goes low at any time with the MODFEN bit set. Clear the MODF bit by reading the SPI status and control register (SPSCR) with MODF set and then writing to the SPI control register (SPCR). Reset clears the MODF bit. 1 = SS pin at inappropriate logic level 0 = SS pin at appropriate logic level SPTE — SPI Transmitter Empty Bit This clearable, read-only flag is set each time the transmit data register transfers a byte into the shift register. SPTE generates an SPTE CPU interrupt request or an SPTE DMA service request if the SPTIE bit in the SPI control register is set also. NOTE Do not write to the SPI data register unless the SPTE bit is high. For an idle master of idle slave that has no data loaded into its transmit buffer, the SPTE will be set again within two bus cycles since the transmit buffer empties into the shift register. This allows the user to queue up a 16-bit value to send. For an already active slave, the load of the shift register cannot occur until the transmission is completed. This implies that a back-to-back write to the transmit data register is not possible. The SPTE indicates when the next write can occur. Reset sets the SPTE bit. 1 = Transmit data register empty 0 = Transmit data register not empty MODFEN — Mode Fault Enable Bit This read/write bit, when set to 1, allows the MODF flag to be set. If the MODF flag is set, clearing the MODFEN does not clear the MODF flag. If the SPI is enabled as a master and the MODFEN bit is low, then the SS pin is available as a general-purpose I/O. If the MODFEN bit is set, then this pin is not available as a general-purpose I/O. When the SPI is enabled as a slave, the SS pin is not available as a general-purpose I/O regardless of the value of MODFEN. See 15.11.4 SS (Slave Select). If the MODFEN bit is low, the level of the SS pin does not affect the operation of an enabled SPI configured as a master. For an enabled SPI configured as a slave, having MODFEN low only prevents the MODF flag from being set. It does not affect any other part of SPI operation. See 15.6.2 Mode Fault Error. SPR1 and SPR0 — SPI Baud Rate Select Bits In master mode, these read/write bits select one of four baud rates as shown in Table 15-4. SPR1 and SPR0 have no effect in slave mode. Reset clears SPR1 and SPR0. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 213 Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) Table 15-4. SPI Master Baud Rate Selection SPR1:SPR0 00 01 10 11 Baud Rate Divisor (BD) 2 8 32 128 Use this formula to calculate the SPI baud rate: CGMOUT Baud rate = ------------------------2 × BD where: CGMOUT = base clock output of the clock generator module (CGM) BD = baud rate divisor 15.12.3 SPI Data Register The SPI data register consists of the read-only receive data register and the write-only transmit data register. Writing to the SPI data register writes data into the transmit data register. Reading the SPI data register reads data from the receive data register. The transmit data and receive data registers are separate registers that can contain different values. See Figure 15-2. Address: $0046 Bit 7 Read: Write: Reset: R7 T7 6 R6 T6 5 R5 T5 4 R4 T4 3 R3 T3 2 R2 T2 1 R1 T1 Bit 0 R0 T0 Indeterminate after reset Figure 15-16. SPI Data Register (SPDR) R7:R0/T7:T0 — Receive/Transmit Data Bits NOTE Do not use read-modify-write instructions on the SPI data register since the register read is not the same as the register written. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 214 Freescale Semiconductor Chapter 16 Timer Interface A (TIMA) 16.1 Introduction This section describes the timer interface module A (TIMA). The TIMA is a 4-channel timer that provides: • Timing reference with input capture • Output compare • Pulse-width modulator functions Figure 16-2 is a block diagram of the TIMA. 16.2 Features Features of the TIMA include: • Four input capture/output compare channels: – Rising-edge, falling-edge, or any-edge input capture trigger – Set, clear, or toggle output compare action • Buffered and unbuffered pulse-width modulator (PWM) signal generation • Programmable TIMA clock input: – 7-frequency internal bus clock prescaler selection – External TIMA clock input (4-MHz maximum frequency) • Free-running or modulo up-count operation • Toggle any channel pin on overflow • TIMA counter stop and reset bits MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 215 DDRA PTA DDRB USER FLASH — 32,256 BYTES TIMER INTERFACE MODULE A USER RAM — 768 BYTES TIMER INTERFACE MODULE B PTB DDRC USER FLASH VECTOR SPACE — 46 BYTES OSC1 OSC2 CGMXFC SERIAL COMMUNICATIONS INTERFACE MODULE PTC RST SYSTEM INTEGRATION MODULE IRQ MODULE ANALOG-TO-DIGITAL CONVERTER MODULE POWER-ON RESET MODULE PTD DDRE VSS VDD VDDAD VSSAD PTF0/SPSCK(1) POWER Notes: 1. These pins are not available in the 56-pin SDIP package. 2. This module is not available in the 56-pin SDIP package. 3. In the 56-pin SDIP package, these pins are bonded together. Figure 16-1. Block Diagram Highlighting TIMA Block and Pins DDRF PTF PWMGND PWM6–PWM1 PULSE-WIDTH MODULATOR MODULE PTF5/TxD PTF4/RxD PTF3/MISO(1) PTF2/MOSI(1) PTF1/SS(1) PTE 216 M68HC08 CPU CPU REGISTERS ARITHMETIC/LOGIC UNIT CONTROL AND STATUS REGISTERS — 112 BYTES Timer Interface A (TIMA) INTERNAL BUS PTA7–PTA0 PTB7/ATD7 PTB6/ATD6 PTB5/ATD5 PTB4/ATD4 PTB3/ATD3 PTB2/ATD2 PTB1/ATD1 PTB0/ATD0 PTC6 PTC5 PTC4 PTC3 PTC2 PTC1/ATD9(1) PTC0/ATD8 PTD6/IS3 PTD5/IS2 PTD4/IS1 PTD3/FAULT4 PTD2/FAULT3 PTD1/FAULT2 PTD0/FAULT1 PTE7/TCH3A PTE6/TCH2A PTE5/TCH1A PTE4/TCH0A PTE3/TCLKA PTE2/TCH1B(1) PTE1/TCH0B(1) PTE0/TCLKB(1) LOW-VOLTAGE INHIBIT MODULE COMPUTER OPERATING PROPERLY MODULE MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor MONITOR ROM — 240 BYTES CLOCK GENERATOR MODULE SERIAL PERIPHERAL INTERFACE MODULE(2) IRQ VDDA VSSA(3) VREFL(3) VREFH SINGLE BREAK MODULE Features PTE3/TCLKA INTERNAL BUS CLOCK TSTOP TRST 16-BIT COUNTER TCLK PRESCALER SELECT PRESCALER PS2 PS1 PS0 TOF TOIE INTERRUPT LOGIC 16-BIT COMPARATOR TMODH:TMODL CHANNEL 0 16-BIT COMPARATOR TCH0H:TCH0L 16-BIT LATCH MS0A CHANNEL 1 16-BIT COMPARATOR TCH1H:TCH1L 16-BIT LATCH MS1A CHANNEL 2 16-BIT COMPARATOR TCH2H:TCH2L 16-BIT LATCH MS2A CHANNEL 3 16-BIT COMPARATOR TCH3H:TCH3L 16-BIT LATCH MS3A CH3IE CH3F ELS3B ELS3A MS2B CH2IE TOV3 CH3MAX CH2F ELS2B ELS2A CH1IE TOV2 CH2MAX CH1F ELS1B ELS1A MS0B CH0IE TOV1 CH1MAX CH0F ELS0B ELS0A TOV0 CH0MAX PTE4 LOGIC INTERRUPT LOGIC PTE4/TCH0A PTE5 LOGIC INTERRUPT LOGIC PTE5/TCH1A PTE6 LOGIC INTERRUPT LOGIC PTE6/TCH2A PTE7 LOGIC INTERRUPT LOGIC PTE7/TCH3A Figure 16-2. TIMA Block Diagram MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 217 Timer Interface A (TIMA) Addr. $000E Register Name TIMA Status/Control Register Read: (TASC) Write: See page 226. Reset: TIMA Counter Register High Read: (TACNTH) Write: See page 227. Reset: TIMA Counter Register Low (TACNTL) Write: See page 227. Reset: TIMA Counter Modulo Read: Register High (TAMODH) Write: See page 228. Reset: TIMA Counter Modulo Read: Register Low (TAMODL) Write: See page 228. Reset: TIMA Channel 0 Status/Control Read: Register (TASC0) Write: See page 229. Reset: TIMA Channel 0 Register High (TACH0H) Write: See page 232. Reset: TIMA Channel 0 Register Low Read: (TACH0L) Write: See page 232. Reset: TIMA Channel 1 Status/Control Read: Register (TASC1) Write: See page 229. Reset: TIMA Channel 1 Register High Read: (TACH1H) Write: See page 232. Reset: TIMA Channel 1 Register Low (TACH1L) Write: See page 232. Reset: TIMA Channel 2 Status/Control Read: Register (TASC2) Write: See page 229. Reset: Read: Read: Read: Bit 7 TOF 0 0 Bit 15 R 0 Bit 7 R 0 Bit 15 1 Bit 7 1 CH0F 0 0 Bit 15 6 TOIE 0 Bit 14 R 0 Bit 6 R 0 14 1 6 1 CH0IE 0 14 5 TSTOP 1 Bit 13 R 0 Bit 5 R 0 13 1 5 1 MS0B 0 13 4 0 TRST 0 Bit 12 R 0 Bit 4 R 0 12 1 4 1 MS0A 0 12 3 0 R 0 Bit 11 R 0 Bit 3 R 0 11 1 3 1 ELS0B 0 11 2 PS2 0 Bit 10 R 0 Bit 2 R 0 10 1 2 1 ELS0A 0 10 1 PS1 0 Bit 9 R 0 Bit 1 R 0 9 1 1 1 TOV0 0 9 Bit 0 PS0 0 Bit 8 R 0 Bit 0 R 0 Bit 8 1 Bit 0 1 CH0MAX 0 Bit 8 $000F $0010 $0011 $0012 $0013 $0014 Indeterminate after reset Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 $0015 Indeterminate after reset CH1F 0 0 Bit 15 CH1IE 0 14 0 R 0 13 MS1A 0 12 ELS1B 0 11 ELS1A 0 10 TOV1 0 9 CH1MAX 0 Bit 8 $0016 $0017 Indeterminate after reset Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 $0018 Indeterminate after reset CH2F 0 0 R CH2IE 0 = Reserved MS2B 0 MS2A 0 ELS2B 0 ELS2A 0 TOV2 0 CH2MAX 0 $0019 Figure 16-3. TIM I/O Register Summary MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 218 Freescale Semiconductor Functional Description Addr. $001A Register Name TIMA Channel 2 Register High (TACH2H) Write: See page 232. Reset: TIMA Channel 2 Register Low Read: (TACH2L) Write: See page 232. Reset: TIMA Channel 3 Status/Control Read: Register (TASC3) Write: See page 229. Reset: TIMA Channel 3 Register High Read: (TACH3H) Write: See page 232. Reset: TIMA Channel 3 Register Low (TACH3L) Write: See page 232. Reset: Read: Read: Bit 7 Bit 15 6 14 5 13 4 12 3 11 2 10 1 9 Bit 0 Bit 8 Indeterminate after reset Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 $001B Indeterminate after reset CH3F 0 0 Bit 15 CH3IE 0 14 0 R 0 13 MS3A 0 12 ELS3B 0 11 ELS3A 0 10 TOV3 0 9 CH3MAX 0 Bit 8 $001C $001D Indeterminate after reset Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 $001E Indeterminate after reset R = Reserved Figure 16-3. TIM I/O Register Summary (Continued) 16.3 Functional Description Figure 16-2 shows the TIMA structure. The central component of the TIMA is the 16-bit TIMA counter that can operate as a free-running counter or a modulo up-counter. The TIMA counter provides the timing reference for the input capture and output compare functions. The TIMA counter modulo registers, TAMODH–TAMODL, control the modulo value of the TIMA counter. Software can read the TIMA counter value at any time without affecting the counting sequence. The four TIMA channels are programmable independently as input capture or output compare channels. 16.3.1 TIMA Counter Prescaler The TIMA clock source can be one of the seven prescaler outputs or the TIMA clock pin, PTE3/TCLKA. The prescaler generates seven clock rates from the internal bus clock. The prescaler select bits, PS[2:0], in the TIMA status and control register select the TIMA clock source. 16.3.2 Input Capture An input capture function has three basic parts: 1. Edge select logic 2. Input capture latch 3. 16-bit counter Two 8-bit registers, which make up the 16-bit input capture register, are used to latch the value of the free-running counter after the corresponding input capture edge detector senses a defined transition. The polarity of the active edge is programmable. The level transition which triggers the counter transfer is defined by the corresponding input edge bits (ELSxB and ELSxA in TASC0–TASC3 control registers with MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 219 Timer Interface A (TIMA) x referring to the active channel number). When an active edge occurs on the pin of an input capture channel, the TIMA latches the contents of the TIMA counter into the TIMA channel registers, TACHxH–TACHxL. Input captures can generate TIMA CPU interrupt requests. Software can determine that an input capture event has occurred by enabling input capture interrupts or by polling the status flag bit. The free-running counter contents are transferred to the TIMA channel status and control register (TACHxH–TACHxL, see 16.7.5 TIMA Channel Registers) on each proper signal transition regardless of whether the TIMA channel flag (CH0F–CH3F in TASC0–TASC3 registers) is set or clear. When the status flag is set, a CPU interrupt is generated if enabled. The value of the count latched or “captured” is the time of the event. Because this value is stored in the input capture register two bus cycles after the actual event occurs, user software can respond to this event at a later time and determine the actual time of the event. However, this must be done prior to another input capture on the same pin; otherwise, the previous time value will be lost. By recording the times for successive edges on an incoming signal, software can determine the period and/or pulse width of the signal. To measure a period, two successive edges of the same polarity are captured. To measure a pulse width, two alternate polarity edges are captured. Software should track the overflows at the 16-bit module counter to extend its range. Another use for the input capture function is to establish a time reference. In this case, an input capture function is used in conjunction with an output compare function. For example, to activate an output signal a specified number of clock cycles after detecting an input event (edge), use the input capture function to record the time at which the edge occurred. A number corresponding to the desired delay is added to this captured value and stored to an output compare register (see 16.7.5 TIMA Channel Registers). Because both input captures and output compares are referenced to the same 16-bit modulo counter, the delay can be controlled to the resolution of the counter independent of software latencies. Reset does not affect the contents of the input capture channel registers. 16.3.3 Output Compare With the output compare function, the TIMA can generate a periodic pulse with a programmable polarity, duration, and frequency. When the counter reaches the value in the registers of an output compare channel, the TIMA can set, clear, or toggle the channel pin. Output compares can generate TIMA CPU interrupt requests. 16.3.3.1 Unbuffered Output Compare Any output compare channel can generate unbuffered output compare pulses as described in 16.3.3 Output Compare. The pulses are unbuffered because changing the output compare value requires writing the new value over the old value currently in the TIMA channel registers. An unsynchronized write to the TIMA channel registers to change an output compare value could cause incorrect operation for up to two counter overflow periods. For example, writing a new value before the counter reaches the old value but after the counter reaches the new value prevents any compare during that counter overflow period. Also, using a TIMA overflow interrupt routine to write a new, smaller output compare value may cause the compare to be missed. The TIMA may pass the new value before it is written. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 220 Freescale Semiconductor Functional Description Use this method to synchronize unbuffered changes in the output compare value on channel x: • When changing to a smaller value, enable channel x output compare interrupts and write the new value in the output compare interrupt routine. The output compare interrupt occurs at the end of the current output compare pulse. The interrupt routine has until the end of the counter overflow period to write the new value. • When changing to a larger output compare value, enable TIMA overflow interrupts and write the new value in the TIMA overflow interrupt routine. The TIMA overflow interrupt occurs at the end of the current counter overflow period. Writing a larger value in an output compare interrupt routine (at the end of the current pulse) could cause two output compares to occur in the same counter overflow period. 16.3.3.2 Buffered Output Compare Channels 0 and 1 can be linked to form a buffered output compare channel whose output appears on the PTE4/TCH0A pin. The TIMA channel registers of the linked pair alternately control the output. Setting the MS0B bit in TIMA channel 0 status and control register (TASC0) links channel 0 and channel 1. The output compare value in the TIMA channel 0 registers initially controls the output on the PTE4/TCH0A pin. Writing to the TIMA channel 1 registers enables the TIMA channel 1 registers to synchronously control the output after the TIMA overflows. At each subsequent overflow, the TIMA channel registers (0 or 1) that control the output are the ones written to last. TASC0 controls and monitors the buffered output compare function, and TIMA channel 1 status and control register (TASC1) is unused. While the MS0B bit is set, the channel 1 pin, PTE5/TCH1A, is available as a general-purpose I/O pin. Channels 2 and 3 can be linked to form a buffered output compare channel whose output appears on the PTE6/TCH2A pin. The TIMA channel registers of the linked pair alternately control the output. Setting the MS2B bit in TIMA channel 2 status and control register (TASC2) links channel 2 and channel 3. The output compare value in the TIMA channel 2 registers initially controls the output on the PTE6/TCH2A pin. Writing to the TIMA channel 3 registers enables the TIMA channel 3 registers to synchronously control the output after the TIMA overflows. At each subsequent overflow, the TIMA channel registers (2 or 3) that control the output are the ones written to last. TASC2 controls and monitors the buffered output compare function, and TIMA channel 3 status and control register (TASC3) is unused. While the MS2B bit is set, the channel 3 pin, PTE7/TCH3A, is available as a general-purpose I/O pin. NOTE In buffered output compare operation, do not write new output compare values to the currently active channel registers. User software should track the currently active channel to prevent writing a new value to the active channel. Writing to the active channel registers is the same as generating unbuffered output compares. 16.3.4 Pulse-Width Modulation (PWM) By using the toggle-on-overflow feature with an output compare channel, the TIMA can generate a PWM signal. The value in the TIMA counter modulo registers determines the period of the PWM signal. The channel pin toggles when the counter reaches the value in the TIMA counter modulo registers. The time between overflows is the period of the PWM signal. As Figure 16-4 shows, the output compare value in the TIMA channel registers determines the pulse width of the PWM signal. The time between overflow and output compare is the pulse width. Program the TIMA MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 221 Timer Interface A (TIMA) to clear the channel pin on output compare if the polarity of the PWM pulse is 1 (ELSxA = 0). Program the TIMA to set the pin if the polarity of the PWM pulse is 0 (ELSxA = 1). The value in the TIMA counter modulo registers and the selected prescaler output determines the frequency of the PWM output. The frequency of an 8-bit PWM signal is variable in 256 increments. Writing $00FF (255) to the TIMA counter modulo registers produces a PWM period of 256 times the internal bus clock period if the prescaler select value is $000 (see 16.7.1 TIMA Status and Control Register). The value in the TIMA channel registers determines the pulse width of the PWM output. The pulse width of an 8-bit PWM signal is variable in 256 increments. Writing $0080 (128) to the TIMA channel registers produces a duty cycle of 128/256 or 50 percent. OVERFLOW PERIOD POLARITY = 1 (ELSxA = 0) TCHx PULSE WIDTH POLARITY = 0 (ELSxA = 1) TCHx OVERFLOW OVERFLOW OUTPUT COMPARE OUTPUT COMPARE OUTPUT COMPARE Figure 16-4. PWM Period and Pulse Width 16.3.4.1 Unbuffered PWM Signal Generation Any output compare channel can generate unbuffered PWM pulses as described in 16.3.4 Pulse-Width Modulation (PWM). The pulses are unbuffered because changing the pulse width requires writing the new pulse width value over the value currently in the TIMA channel registers. An unsynchronized write to the TIMA channel registers to change a pulse width value could cause incorrect operation for up to two PWM periods. For example, writing a new value before the counter reaches the old value but after the counter reaches the new value prevents any compare during that PWM period. Also, using a TIMA overflow interrupt routine to write a new, smaller pulse width value may cause the compare to be missed. The TIMA may pass the new value before it is written to the TIMA channel registers. Use this method to synchronize unbuffered changes in the PWM pulse width on channel x: • When changing to a shorter pulse width, enable channel x output compare interrupts and write the new value in the output compare interrupt routine. The output compare interrupt occurs at the end of the current pulse. The interrupt routine has until the end of the PWM period to write the new value. • When changing to a longer pulse width, enable TIMA overflow interrupts and write the new value in the TIMA overflow interrupt routine. The TIMA overflow interrupt occurs at the end of the current PWM period. Writing a larger value in an output compare interrupt routine (at the end of the current pulse) could cause two output compares to occur in the same PWM period. NOTE In PWM signal generation, do not program the PWM channel to toggle on output compare. Toggling on output compare prevents reliable 0 percent MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 222 Freescale Semiconductor Functional Description duty cycle generation and removes the ability of the channel to self-correct in the event of software error or noise. Toggling on output compare also can cause incorrect PWM signal generation when changing the PWM pulse width to a new, much larger value. 16.3.4.2 Buffered PWM Signal Generation Channels 0 and 1 can be linked to form a buffered PWM channel whose output appears on the PTE4/TCH0A pin. The TIMA channel registers of the linked pair alternately control the pulse width of the output. Setting the MS0B bit in TIMA channel 0 status and control register (TASC0) links channel 0 and channel 1. The TIMA channel 0 registers initially control the pulse width on the PTE4/TCH0A pin. Writing to the TIMA channel 1 registers enables the TIMA channel 1 registers to synchronously control the pulse width at the beginning of the next PWM period. At each subsequent overflow, the TIMA channel registers (0 or 1) that control the pulse width are the ones written to last. TASC0 controls and monitors the buffered PWM function, and TIMA channel 1 status and control register (TASC1) is unused. While the MS0B bit is set, the channel 1 pin, PTE5/TCH1A, is available as a general-purpose I/O pin. Channels 2 and 3 can be linked to form a buffered PWM channel whose output appears on the PTE6/TCH2A pin. The TIMA channel registers of the linked pair alternately control the pulse width of the output. Setting the MS2B bit in TIMA channel 2 status and control register (TASC2) links channel 2 and channel 3. The TIMA channel 2 registers initially control the pulse width on the PTE6/TCH2A pin. Writing to the TIMA channel 3 registers enables the TIMA channel 3 registers to synchronously control the pulse width at the beginning of the next PWM period. At each subsequent overflow, the TIMA channel registers (2 or 3) that control the pulse width are written to last. TASC2 controls and monitors the buffered PWM function, and TIMA channel 3 status and control register (TASC3) is unused. While the MS2B bit is set, the channel 3 pin, PTE7/TCH3A, is available as a general-purpose I/O pin. NOTE In buffered PWM signal generation, do not write new pulse width values to the currently active channel registers. User software should track the currently active channel to prevent writing a new value to the active channel. Writing to the active channel registers is the same as generating unbuffered PWM signals. 16.3.4.3 PWM Initialization To ensure correct operation when generating unbuffered or buffered PWM signals, use this initialization procedure: 1. In the TIMA status and control register (TASC): a. Stop the TIMA counter by setting the TIMA stop bit, TSTOP. b. Reset the TIMA counter and prescaler by setting the TIMA reset bit, TRST. 2. In the TIMA counter modulo registers (TAMODH–TAMODL), write the value for the required PWM period. 3. In the TIMA channel x registers (TACHxH–TACHxL), write the value for the required pulse width. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 223 Timer Interface A (TIMA) 4. In TIMA channel x status and control register (TSCx): a. Write 0:1 (for unbuffered output compare or PWM signals) or 1:0 (for buffered output compare or PWM signals) to the mode select bits, MSxB–MSxA. (See Table 16-2.) b. Write 1 to the toggle-on-overflow bit, TOVx. c. Write 1:0 (polarity 1 — to clear output on compare) or 1:1 (polarity 0 — to set output on compare) to the edge/level select bits, ELSxB–ELSxA. The output action on compare must force the output to the complement of the pulse width level. (See Table 16-2.) NOTE In PWM signal generation, do not program the PWM channel to toggle on output compare. Toggling on output compare prevents reliable 0 percent duty cycle generation and removes the ability of the channel to self-correct in the event of software error or noise. Toggling on output compare can also cause incorrect PWM signal generation when changing the PWM pulse width to a new, much larger value. 5. In the TIMA status control register (TASC), clear the TIMA stop bit, TSTOP. Setting MS0B links channels 0 and 1 and configures them for buffered PWM operation. The TIMA channel 0 registers (TACH0H–TACH0L) initially control the buffered PWM output. TIMA status control register 0 (TASC0) controls and monitors the PWM signal from the linked channels. MS0B takes priority over MS0A. Setting MS2B links channels 2 and 3 and configures them for buffered PWM operation. The TIMA channel 2 registers (TACH2H–TACH2L) initially control the buffered PWM output. TIMA status control register 2 (TASC2) controls and monitors the PWM signal from the linked channels. MS2B takes priority over MS2A. Clearing the toggle-on-overflow bit, TOVx, inhibits output toggles on TIMA overflows. Subsequent output compares try to force the output to a state it is already in and have no effect. The result is a 0 percent duty cycle output. Setting the channel x maximum duty cycle bit (CHxMAX) and setting the TOVx bit generates a 100 percent duty cycle output. (See 16.7.4 TIMA Channel Status and Control Registers.) 16.4 Interrupts These TIMA sources can generate interrupt requests: • TIMA overflow flag (TOF) — The timer overflow flag (TOF) bit is set when the TIMA counter reaches the modulo value programmed in the TIMA counter modulo registers. The TIMA overflow interrupt enable bit, TOIE, enables TIMA overflow interrupt requests. TOF and TOIE are in the TIMA status and control registers. • TIMA channel flags (CH3F–CH0F) — The CHxF bit is set when an input capture or output compare occurs on channel x. Channel x TIMA CPU interrupt requests are controlled by the channel x interrupt enable bit, CHxIE. 16.5 Wait Mode The WAIT instruction puts the MCU in low power-consumption standby mode. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 224 Freescale Semiconductor I/O Signals The TIMA remains active after the execution of a WAIT instruction. In wait mode, the TIMA registers are not accessible by the CPU. Any enabled CPU interrupt request from the TIMA can bring the MCU out of wait mode. If TIMA functions are not required during wait mode, reduce power consumption by stopping the TIMA before executing the WAIT instruction. 16.6 I/O Signals Port E shares five of its pins with the TIMA: • PTE3/TCLKA is an external clock input to the TIMA prescaler. • The four TIMA channel I/O pins are PTE4/TCH0A, PTE5/TCH1A, PTE6/TCH2A, and PTE7/TCH3A. 16.6.1 TIMA Clock Pin (PTE3/TCLKA) PTE3/TCLKA is an external clock input that can be the clock source for the TIMA counter instead of the prescaled internal bus clock. Select the PTE3/TCLKA input by writing logic 1s to the three prescaler select bits, PS[2:0]. See 16.7.1 TIMA Status and Control Register. The maximum TCLK frequency is the least: 4 MHz or bus frequency ÷ 2. PTE3/TCLKA is available as a general-purpose I/O pin when not used as the TIMA clock input. When the PTE3/TCLKA pin is the TIMA clock input, it is an input regardless of the state of the DDRE3 bit in data direction register E. 16.6.2 TIMA Channel I/O Pins (PTE4/TCH0A–PTE7/TCH3A) Each channel I/O pin is programmable independently as an input capture pin or an output compare pin. PTE2/TCH0 and PTE4/TCH2 can be configured as buffered output compare or buffered PWM pins. 16.7 I/O Registers These input/output (I/O) registers control and monitor TIMA operation: • TIMA status and control register (TASC) • TIMA control registers (TACNTH–TACNTL) • TIMA counter modulo registers (TAMODH–TAMODL) • TIMA channel status and control registers (TASC0, TASC1, TASC2, and TASC3) • TIMA channel registers (TACH0H–TACH0L, TACH1H–TACH1L, TACH2H–TACH2L, and TACH3H–TACH3L) 16.7.1 TIMA Status and Control Register The TIMA status and control register: • Enables TIMA overflow interrupts • Flags TIMA overflows • Stops the TIMA counter • Resets the TIMA counter • Prescales the TIMA counter clock MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 225 Timer Interface A (TIMA) Address: $000E Bit 7 Read: Write: Reset: TOF 0 0 R 6 TOIE 0 = Reserved 5 TSTOP 1 4 0 TRST 0 3 0 R 0 2 PS2 0 1 PS1 0 Bit 0 PS0 0 Figure 16-5. TIMA Status and Control Register (TASC) TOF — TIMA Overflow Flag This read/write flag is set when the TIMA counter reaches the modulo value programmed in the TIMA counter modulo registers. Clear TOF by reading the TIMA status and control register when TOF is set and then writing a logic 0 to TOF. If another TIMA overflow occurs before the clearing sequence is complete, then writing logic 0 to TOF has no effect. Therefore, a TOF interrupt request cannot be lost due to inadvertent clearing of TOF. Reset clears the TOF bit. Writing a logic 1 to TOF has no effect. 1 = TIMA counter has reached modulo value. 0 = TIMA counter has not reached modulo value. TOIE — TIMA Overflow Interrupt Enable Bit This read/write bit enables TIMA overflow interrupts when the TOF bit becomes set. Reset clears the TOIE bit. 1 = TIMA overflow interrupts enabled 0 = TIMA overflow interrupts disabled TSTOP — TIMA Stop Bit This read/write bit stops the TIMA counter. Counting resumes when TSTOP is cleared. Reset sets the TSTOP bit, stopping the TIMA counter until software clears the TSTOP bit. 1 = TIMA counter stopped 0 = TIMA counter active NOTE Do not set the TSTOP bit before entering wait mode if the TIMA is required to exit wait mode. Also when the TSTOP bit is set and the timer is configured for input capture operation, input captures are inhibited until the TSTOP bit is cleared. TRST — TIMA Reset Bit Setting this write-only bit resets the TIMA counter and the TIMA prescaler. Setting TRST has no effect on any other registers. Counting resumes from $0000. TRST is cleared automatically after the TIMA counter is reset and always reads as logic 0. Reset clears the TRST bit. 1 = Prescaler and TIMA counter cleared 0 = No effect NOTE Setting the TSTOP and TRST bits simultaneously stops the TIMA counter at a value of $0000. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 226 Freescale Semiconductor I/O Registers PS[2:0] — Prescaler Select Bits These read/write bits select either the PTE3/TCLKA pin or one of the seven prescaler outputs as the input to the TIMA counter as Table 16-1 shows. Reset clears the PS[2:0] bits. Table 16-1. Prescaler Selection PS[2:0] 000 001 010 011 100 101 110 111 TIMA Clock Source Internal bus clock ÷1 Internal bus clock ÷ 2 Internal bus clock ÷ 4 Internal bus clock ÷ 8 Internal bus clock ÷ 16 Internal bus clock ÷ 32 Internal bus clock ÷ 64 PTE3/TCLKA 16.7.2 TIMA Counter Registers The two read-only TIMA counter registers contain the high and low bytes of the value in the TIMA counter. Reading the high byte (TACNTH) latches the contents of the low byte (TACNTL) into a buffer. Subsequent reads of TACNTH do not affect the latched TACNTL value until TACNTL is read. Reset clears the TIMA counter registers. Setting the TIMA reset bit (TRST) also clears the TIMA counter registers. NOTE If TACNTH is read during a break interrupt, be sure to unlatch TACNTL by reading TACNTL before exiting the break interrupt. Otherwise, TACNTL retains the value latched during the break. Register Name and Address: Bit 7 Read: Write: Reset: Bit 15 R 0 6 Bit 14 R 0 TACNTH — $000F 5 Bit 13 R 0 4 Bit 12 R 0 3 Bit 11 R 0 2 Bit 10 R 0 1 Bit 9 R 0 Bit 0 Bit 8 R 0 Register Name and Address: Bit 7 Read: Write: Reset: Bit 7 R 0 R 6 Bit 6 R 0 = Reserved TACNTL — $0010 5 Bit 5 R 0 4 Bit 4 R 0 3 Bit 3 R 0 2 Bit 2 R 0 1 Bit 1 R 0 Bit 0 Bit 0 R 0 Figure 16-6. TIMA Counter Registers (TACNTH and TACNTL) MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 227 Timer Interface A (TIMA) 16.7.3 TIMA Counter Modulo Registers The read/write TIMA modulo registers contain the modulo value for the TIMA counter. When the TIMA counter reaches the modulo value, the overflow flag (TOF) becomes set, and the TIMA counter resumes counting from $0000 at the next timer clock. Writing to the high byte (TAMODH) inhibits the TOF bit and overflow interrupts until the low byte (TAMODL) is written. Reset sets the TIMA counter modulo registers. Register Name and Address: Bit 7 Read: Write: Reset: Bit 15 1 6 Bit 14 1 TAMODH — $0011 5 Bit 13 1 4 Bit 12 1 3 Bit 11 1 2 Bit 10 1 1 Bit 9 1 Bit 0 Bit 8 1 Register Name and Address: Bit 7 Read: Write: Reset: Bit 7 1 6 Bit 6 1 TAMODL — $0012 5 Bit 5 1 4 Bit 4 1 3 Bit 3 1 2 Bit 2 1 1 Bit 1 1 Bit 0 Bit 0 1 Figure 16-7. TIMA Counter Modulo Registers (TAMODH and TAMODL) NOTE Reset the TIMA counter before writing to the TIMA counter modulo registers. 16.7.4 TIMA Channel Status and Control Registers Each of the TIMA channel status and control registers: • Flags input captures and output compares • Enables input capture and output compare interrupts • Selects input capture, output compare, or PWM operation • Selects high, low, or toggling output on output compare • Selects rising edge, falling edge, or any edge as the active input capture trigger • Selects output toggling on TIMA overflow • Selects 0 percent and 100 percent PWM duty cycle • Selects buffered or unbuffered output compare/PWM operation MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 228 Freescale Semiconductor I/O Registers Register Name and Address: Bit 7 Read: Write: Reset: CH0F 0 0 6 CH0IE 0 TASC0 — $0013 5 MS0B 0 TASC1 — $0016 6 CH1IE 0 5 0 R 0 TASC2 — $0019 6 CH2IE 0 5 MS2B 0 TASC3 — $001C 6 CH3IE 0 = Reserved 5 0 R 0 4 MS3A 0 3 ELS3B 0 2 ELS3A 0 1 TOV3 0 Bit 0 CH3MAX 0 4 MS2A 0 3 ELS2B 0 2 ELS2A 0 1 TOV2 0 Bit 0 CH2MAX 0 4 MS1A 0 3 ELS1B 0 2 ELS1A 0 1 TOV1 0 Bit 0 CH1MAX 0 4 MS0A 0 3 ELS0B 0 2 ELS0A 0 1 TOV0 0 Bit 0 CH0MAX 0 Register Name and Address: Bit 7 Read: Write: Reset: CH1F 0 0 Register Name and Address: Bit 7 Read: Write: Reset: CH2F 0 0 Register Name and Address: Bit 7 Read: Write: Reset: CH3F 0 0 R Figure 16-8. TIMA Channel Status and Control Registers (TASC0–TASC3) CHxF — Channel x Flag Bit When channel x is an input capture channel, this read/write bit is set when an active edge occurs on the channel x pin. When channel x is an output compare channel, CHxF is set when the value in the TIMA counter registers matches the value in the TIMA channel x registers. When CHxIE = 1, clear CHxF by reading TIMA channel x status and control register with CHxF set, and then writing a 0 to CHxF. If another interrupt request occurs before the clearing sequence is complete, then writing 0 to CHxF has no effect. Therefore, an interrupt request cannot be lost due to inadvertent clearing of CHxF. Reset clears the CHxF bit. Writing a 1 to CHxF has no effect. 1 = Input capture or output compare on channel x 0 = No input capture or output compare on channel x CHxIE — Channel x Interrupt Enable Bit This read/write bit enables TIMA CPU interrupts on channel x. Reset clears the CHxIE bit. 1 = Channel x CPU interrupt requests enabled 0 = Channel x CPU interrupt requests disabled MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 229 Timer Interface A (TIMA) MSxB — Mode Select Bit B This read/write bit selects buffered output compare/PWM operation. MSxB exists only in the TIMA channel 0 and TIMA channel 2 status and control registers. Setting MS0B disables the channel 1 status and control register and reverts TCH1A pin to general-purpose I/O. Setting MS2B disables the channel 3 status and control register and reverts TCH3A pin to general-purpose I/O. Reset clears the MSxB bit. 1 = Buffered output compare/PWM operation enabled 0 = Buffered output compare/PWM operation disabled MSxA — Mode Select Bit A When ELSxB:A ≠ 00, this read/write bit selects either input capture operation or unbuffered output compare/PWM operation. See Table 16-2. 1 = Unbuffered output compare/PWM operation 0 = Input capture operation When ELSxB:A = 00, this read/write bit selects the initial output level of the TCHxA pin once PWM, input capture, or output compare operation is enabled. See Table 16-2. Reset clears the MSxA bit. 1 = Initial output level low 0 = Initial output level high NOTE Before changing a channel function by writing to the MSxB or MSxA bit, set the TSTOP and TRST bits in the TIMA status and control register (TASC). ELSxB and ELSxA — Edge/Level Select Bits When channel x is an input capture channel, these read/write bits control the active edge-sensing logic on channel x. When channel x is an output compare channel, ELSxB and ELSxA control the channel x output behavior when an output compare occurs. When ELSxB and ELSxA are both clear, channel x is not connected to port E, and pin PTEx/TCHxA is available as a general-purpose I/O pin. However, channel x is at a state determined by these bits and becomes transparent to the respective pin when PWM, input capture, or output compare mode is enabled. Table 16-2 shows how ELSxB and ELSxA work. Reset clears the ELSxB and ELSxA bits. NOTE Before enabling a TIMA channel register for input capture operation, make sure that the PTEx/TACHx pin is stable for at least two bus clocks. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 230 Freescale Semiconductor I/O Registers Table 16-2. Mode, Edge, and Level Selection MSxB:MSxA X0 X1 00 00 00 01 01 01 01 1X 1X 1X ELSxB:ELSxA 00 00 01 10 11 00 01 10 11 01 10 11 Buffered output compare or buffered PWM Output compare or PWM Input capture Mode Output preset Configuration Pin under port control; initialize timer output level high Pin under port control; initialize timer output level low Capture on rising edge only Capture on falling edge only Capture on rising or falling edge Software compare only Toggle output on compare Clear output on compare Set output on compare Toggle output on compare Clear output on compare Set output on compare TOVx — Toggle-On-Overflow Bit When channel x is an output compare channel, this read/write bit controls the behavior of the channel x output when the TIMA counter overflows. When channel x is an input capture channel, TOVx has no effect. Reset clears the TOVx bit. 1 = Channel x pin toggles on TIMA counter overflow. 0 = Channel x pin does not toggle on TIMA counter overflow. NOTE When TOVx is set, a TIMA counter overflow takes precedence over a channel x output compare if both occur at the same time. CHxMAX — Channel x Maximum Duty Cycle Bit When the TOVx is 1 and clear output on compare is selected, setting the CHxMAX bit forces the duty cycle of buffered and unbuffered PWM signals to 100 percent. As Figure 16-9 shows, CHxMAX bit takes effect in the cycle after it is set or cleared. The output stays at 100 percent duty cycle level until the cycle after CHxMAX is cleared. OVERFLOW PERIOD OVERFLOW OVERFLOW OVERFLOW OVERFLOW PTEx/TCHx OUTPUT COMPARE CHxMAX OUTPUT COMPARE OUTPUT COMPARE OUTPUT COMPARE TOVx Figure 16-9. CHxMAX Latency MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 231 Timer Interface A (TIMA) 16.7.5 TIMA Channel Registers These read/write registers contain the captured TIMA counter value of the input capture function or the output compare value of the output compare function. The state of the TIMA channel registers after reset is unknown. In input capture mode (MSxB:MSxA = 0:0), reading the high byte of the TIMA channel x registers (TACHxH) inhibits input captures until the low byte (TACHxL) is read. In output compare mode (MSxB:MSxA ≠ 0:0), writing to the high byte of the TIMA channel x registers (TACHxH) inhibits output compares until the low byte (TACHxL) is written. Register Name and Address: Bit 7 Read: Write: Reset: Register Name and Address: Bit 7 Read: Write: Reset: Bit 7 Read: Write: Reset: Register Name and Address: Bit 7 Read: Write: Reset: Register Name and Address: Bit 7 Read: Write: Reset: Bit 15 6 Bit 14 Bit 7 6 Bit 6 Bit 15 6 Bit 14 Bit 7 6 Bit 6 Bit 15 6 Bit 14 TACH0H — $0014 5 Bit 13 4 Bit 12 3 Bit 11 2 Bit 10 1 Bit 9 Bit 0 Bit 8 Indeterminate after reset TACH0L — $0015 5 Bit 5 4 Bit 4 3 Bit 3 2 Bit 2 1 Bit 1 Bit 0 Bit 0 Indeterminate after reset 5 Bit 13 4 Bit 12 3 Bit 11 2 Bit 10 1 Bit 9 Bit 0 Bit 8 Register Name and Address: TACH1H — $0017 Indeterminate after reset TACH1L — $0018 5 Bit 5 4 Bit 4 3 Bit 3 2 Bit 2 1 Bit 1 Bit 0 Bit 0 Indeterminate after reset TACH2H — $001A 5 Bit 13 4 Bit 12 3 Bit 11 2 Bit 10 1 Bit 9 Bit 0 Bit 8 Indeterminate after reset Figure 16-10. TIMA Channel Registers (TACH0H/L–TACH3H/L) MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 232 Freescale Semiconductor I/O Registers Register Name and Address: Bit 7 Read: Write: Reset: Register Name and Address: Bit 7 Read: Write: Reset: Register Name and Address: Bit 7 Read: Write: Reset: Bit 7 6 Bit 6 Bit 15 6 Bit 14 Bit 7 6 Bit 6 TACH2L — $001B 5 Bit 5 4 Bit 4 3 Bit 3 2 Bit 2 1 Bit 1 Bit 0 Bit 0 Indeterminate after reset TACH3H — $001D 5 Bit 13 4 Bit 12 3 Bit 11 2 Bit 10 1 Bit 9 Bit 0 Bit 8 Indeterminate after reset TACH3L — $001E 5 Bit 5 4 Bit 4 3 Bit 3 2 Bit 2 1 Bit 1 Bit 0 Bit 0 Indeterminate after reset Figure 16-10. TIMA Channel Registers (TACH0H/L–TACH3H/L) (Continued) MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 233 Timer Interface A (TIMA) MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 234 Freescale Semiconductor Chapter 17 Timer Interface B (TIMB) 17.1 Introduction This section describes the timer interface module B (TIMB). The TIMB is a 2-channel timer that provides: • Timing reference with input capture • Output compare • Pulse-width modulation functions Figure 17-2 is a block diagram of the TIMB. NOTE The TIMB module is not available in the 56-pin shrink dual in-line package (SDIP). 17.2 Features Features of the TIMB include: • Two input capture/output compare channels: – Rising-edge, falling-edge, or any-edge input capture trigger – Set, clear, or toggle output compare action • Buffered and unbuffered pulse-width modulation (PWM) signal generation • Programmable TIMB clock input: – 7-frequency internal bus clock prescaler selection – External TIMB clock input (4-MHz maximum frequency) • Free-running or modulo up-count operation • Toggle any channel pin on overflow • TIMB counter stop and reset bits 17.3 Functional Description Figure 17-2 shows the TIMB structure. The central component of the TIMB is the 16-bit TIMB counter that can operate as a free-running counter or a modulo up-counter. The TIMB counter provides the timing reference for the input capture and output compare functions. The TIMB counter modulo registers, TBMODH–TBMODL, control the modulo value of the TIMB counter. Software can read the TIMB counter value at any time without affecting the counting sequence. The two TIMB channels are programmable independently as input capture or output compare channels. NOTE The TIMB module is not available in the 56-pin SDIP. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 235 DDRA PTA DDRB USER FLASH — 32,256 BYTES TIMER INTERFACE MODULE A USER RAM — 768 BYTES TIMER INTERFACE MODULE B PTB DDRC USER FLASH VECTOR SPACE — 46 BYTES OSC1 OSC2 CGMXFC SERIAL COMMUNICATIONS INTERFACE MODULE PTC RST SYSTEM INTEGRATION MODULE IRQ MODULE ANALOG-TO-DIGITAL CONVERTER MODULE POWER-ON RESET MODULE PTD DDRE VSS VDD VDDAD VSSAD PTF0/SPSCK(1) POWER Notes: 1. These pins are not available in the 56-pin SDIP package. 2. This module is not available in the 56-pin SDIP package. 3. In the 56-pin SDIP package, these pins are bonded together. Figure 17-1. Block Diagram Highlighting TIMB Block and Pins DDRF PTF PWMGND PWM6–PWM1 PULSE-WIDTH MODULATOR MODULE PTF5/TxD PTF4/RxD PTF3/MISO(1) PTF2/MOSI(1) PTF1/SS(1) PTE 236 M68HC08 CPU CPU REGISTERS ARITHMETIC/LOGIC UNIT CONTROL AND STATUS REGISTERS — 112 BYTES Timer Interface B (TIMB) INTERNAL BUS PTA7–PTA0 PTB7/ATD7 PTB6/ATD6 PTB5/ATD5 PTB4/ATD4 PTB3/ATD3 PTB2/ATD2 PTB1/ATD1 PTB0/ATD0 PTC6 PTC5 PTC4 PTC3 PTC2 PTC1/ATD9(1) PTC0/ATD8 PTD6/IS3 PTD5/IS2 PTD4/IS1 PTD3/FAULT4 PTD2/FAULT3 PTD1/FAULT2 PTD0/FAULT1 PTE7/TCH3A PTE6/TCH2A PTE5/TCH1A PTE4/TCH0A PTE3/TCLKA PTE2/TCH1B(1) PTE1/TCH0B(1) PTE0/TCLKB(1) LOW-VOLTAGE INHIBIT MODULE COMPUTER OPERATING PROPERLY MODULE MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor MONITOR ROM — 240 BYTES CLOCK GENERATOR MODULE SERIAL PERIPHERAL INTERFACE MODULE(2) IRQ VDDA VSSA(3) VREFL(3) VREFH SINGLE BREAK MODULE Functional Description PTE0/TCLKB INTERNAL BUS CLOCK TSTOP TRST 16-BIT COUNTER TCLK PRESCALER SELECT PRESCALER PS2 PS1 PS0 TOF TOIE INTERRUPT LOGIC 16-BIT COMPARATOR TMODH:TMODL CHANNEL 0 16-BIT COMPARATOR TCH0H:TCH0L 16-BIT LATCH MS0A CHANNEL 1 16-BIT COMPARATOR TCH1H:TCH1L 16-BIT LATCH MS1A CH1IE CH1F ELS1B ELS1A MS0B CH0IE TOV1 CH1MAX CH0F ELS0B ELS0A TOV0 CH0MAX PTE1 LOGIC INTERRUPT LOGIC PTE1/TCH0B PTE2 LOGIC INTERRUPT LOGIC PTE2/TCH1B Figure 17-2. TIMB Block Diagram Addr. $0051 Register Name TIMB Status/Control Register Read: (TBSC) Write: See page 244. Reset: TIMB Counter Register High (TBCNTH) Write: See page 246. Reset: TIMB Counter Register Low Read: (TBCNTL) Write: See page 246. Reset: TIMB Counter Modulo Register Read: High (TBMODH) Write: See page 246. Reset: TIMB Counter Modulo Register Read: Low (TBMODL) Write: See page 246. Reset: Read: Bit 7 TOF 0 0 Bit 15 R 0 Bit 7 R 0 Bit 15 1 Bit 7 1 R 6 TOIE 0 Bit 14 R 0 Bit 6 R 0 Bit 14 1 Bit 6 1 = Reserved 5 TSTOP 1 Bit 13 R 0 Bit 5 R 0 Bit 13 1 Bit 5 1 4 0 TRST 0 Bit 12 R 0 Bit 4 R 0 Bit 12 1 Bit 4 1 3 0 R 0 Bit 11 R 0 Bit 3 R 0 Bit 11 1 Bit 3 1 2 PS2 0 Bit 10 R 0 Bit 2 R 0 Bit 10 1 Bit 2 1 1 PS1 0 Bit 9 R 0 Bit 1 R 0 Bit 9 1 Bit 1 1 Bit 0 PS0 0 Bit 8 R 0 Bit 0 R 0 Bit 8 1 Bit 0 1 $0052 $0053 $0054 $0055 Figure 17-3. TIMB I/O Register Summary MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 237 Timer Interface B (TIMB) Addr. $0056 Register Name TIMB Channel 0 Status/Control Register Write: (TBSC0) See page 247. Reset: TIMB Channel 0 Register High Read: (TBCH0H) Write: See page 250. Reset: TIMB Channel 0 Register Low Read: (TBCH0L) Write: See page 250. Reset: TIMB Channel 1 Status/Control Read: Register Write: (TBSC1) See page 247. Reset: TIMB Channel 1 Register High (TBCH1H) Write: See page 250. Reset: TIMB Channel 1 Register Low Read: (TBCH1L) Write: See page 250. Reset: Read: Read: Bit 7 CH0F 0 0 Bit 15 6 CH0IE 0 Bit 14 5 MS0B 0 Bit 13 4 MS0A 0 Bit 12 3 ELS0B 0 Bit 11 2 ELS0A 0 Bit 10 1 TOV0 0 Bit 9 Bit 0 CH0MAX 0 Bit 8 $0057 Indeterminate after reset Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 $0058 Indeterminate after reset CH1F 0 0 Bit 15 CH1IE 0 Bit 14 0 R 0 Bit 13 MS1A 0 Bit 12 ELS1B 0 Bit 11 ELS1A 0 Bit 10 TOV1 0 Bit 9 CH1MAX 0 Bit 8 $0059 $005A Indeterminate after reset Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 $005B Indeterminate after reset R = Reserved Figure 17-3. TIMB I/O Register Summary (Continued) 17.3.1 TIMB Counter Prescaler The TIMB clock source can be one of the seven prescaler outputs or the TIMB clock pin, PTE0/TCLKB. The prescaler generates seven clock rates from the internal bus clock. The prescaler select bits, PS[2:0], in the TIMB status and control register select the TIMB clock source. 17.3.2 Input Capture An input capture function has three basic parts: 1. Edge select logic 2. Input capture latch 3. 16-bit counter Two 8-bit registers, which make up the 16-bit input capture register, are used to latch the value of the free-running counter after the corresponding input capture edge detector senses a defined transition. The polarity of the active edge is programmable. The level transition which triggers the counter transfer is defined by the corresponding input edge bits (ELSxB and ELSxA in TBSC0–TBSC1 control registers with x referring to the active channel number). When an active edge occurs on the pin of an input capture channel, the TIMB latches the contents of the TIMB counter into the TIMB channel registers, TCHxH–TCHxL. Input captures can generate TIMB CPU interrupt requests. Software can determine that an input capture event has occurred by enabling input capture interrupts or by polling the status flag bit. The free-running counter contents are transferred to the TIMB channel status and control register (TBCHxH–TBCHxL, see 17.7.5 TIMB Channel Registers) on each proper signal transition regardless of MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 238 Freescale Semiconductor Functional Description whether the TIMB channel flag (CH0F–CH1F in TBSC0–TBSC1 registers) is set or clear. When the status flag is set, a CPU interrupt is generated if enabled. The value of the count latched or “captured” is the time of the event. Because this value is stored in the input capture register two bus cycles after the actual event occurs, user software can respond to this event at a later time and determine the actual time of the event. However, this must be done prior to another input capture on the same pin; otherwise, the previous time value will be lost. By recording the times for successive edges on an incoming signal, software can determine the period and/or pulse width of the signal. To measure a period, two successive edges of the same polarity are captured. To measure a pulse width, two alternate polarity edges are captured. Software should track the overflows at the 16-bit module counter to extend its range. Another use for the input capture function is to establish a time reference. In this case, an input capture function is used in conjunction with an output compare function. For example, to activate an output signal a specified number of clock cycles after detecting an input event (edge), use the input capture function to record the time at which the edge occurred. A number corresponding to the desired delay is added to this captured value and stored to an output compare register (see 17.7.5 TIMB Channel Registers). Because both input captures and output compares are referenced to the same 16-bit modulo counter, the delay can be controlled to the resolution of the counter independent of software latencies. Reset does not affect the contents of the input capture channel register (TBCHxH–TBCHxL). 17.3.3 Output Compare With the output compare function, the TIMB can generate a periodic pulse with a programmable polarity, duration, and frequency. When the counter reaches the value in the registers of an output compare channel, the TIMB can set, clear, or toggle the channel pin. Output compares can generate TIMB CPU interrupt requests. 17.3.3.1 Unbuffered Output Compare Any output compare channel can generate unbuffered output compare pulses as described in 17.3.3 Output Compare. The pulses are unbuffered because changing the output compare value requires writing the new value over the old value currently in the TIMB channel registers. An unsynchronized write to the TIMB channel registers to change an output compare value could cause incorrect operation for up to two counter overflow periods. For example, writing a new value before the counter reaches the old value but after the counter reaches the new value prevents any compare during that counter overflow period. Also, using a TIMB overflow interrupt routine to write a new, smaller output compare value may cause the compare to be missed. The TIMB may pass the new value before it is written. Use this method to synchronize unbuffered changes in the output compare value on channel x: • When changing to a smaller value, enable channel x output compare interrupts and write the new value in the output compare interrupt routine. The output compare interrupt occurs at the end of the current output compare pulse. The interrupt routine has until the end of the counter overflow period to write the new value. • When changing to a larger output compare value, enable TIMB overflow interrupts and write the new value in the TIMB overflow interrupt routine. The TIMB overflow interrupt occurs at the end of the current counter overflow period. Writing a larger value in an output compare interrupt routine (at the end of the current pulse) could cause two output compares to occur in the same counter overflow period. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 239 Timer Interface B (TIMB) 17.3.3.2 Buffered Output Compare Channels 0 and 1 can be linked to form a buffered output compare channel whose output appears on the PTE1/TCH0B pin. The TIMB channel registers of the linked pair alternately control the output. Setting the MS0B bit in TIMB channel 0 status and control register (TBSC0) links channel 0 and channel 1. The output compare value in the TIMB channel 0 registers initially controls the output on the PTE1/TCH0B pin. Writing to the TIMB channel 1 registers enables the TIMB channel 1 registers to synchronously control the output after the TIMB overflows. At each subsequent overflow, the TIMB channel registers (0 or 1) that control the output are the ones written to last. TSC0 controls and monitors the buffered output compare function, and TIMB channel 1 status and control register (TBSC1) is unused. While the MS0B bit is set, the channel 1 pin, PTE2/TCH1B, is available as a general-purpose I/O pin. NOTE In buffered output compare operation, do not write new output compare values to the currently active channel registers. User software should track the currently active channel to prevent writing a new value to the active channel. Writing to the active channel registers is the same as generating unbuffered output compares. 17.3.4 Pulse-Width Modulation (PWM) By using the toggle-on-overflow feature with an output compare channel, the TIMB can generate a PWM signal. The value in the TIMB counter modulo registers determines the period of the PWM signal. The channel pin toggles when the counter reaches the value in the TIMB counter modulo registers. The time between overflows is the period of the PWM signal. As Figure 17-4 shows, the output compare value in the TIMB channel registers determines the pulse width of the PWM signal. The time between overflow and output compare is the pulse width. Program the TIMB to clear the channel pin on output compare if the polarity of the PWM pulse is 1 (ELSxA = 0). Program the TIMB to set the pin if the polarity of the PWM pulse is 0 (ELSxA = 1). OVERFLOW PERIOD POLARITY = 1 (ELSxA = 0) TCHx PULSE WIDTH POLARITY = 0 (ELSxA = 1) TCHx OVERFLOW OVERFLOW OUTPUT COMPARE OUTPUT COMPARE OUTPUT COMPARE Figure 17-4. PWM Period and Pulse Width The value in the TIMB counter modulo registers and the selected prescaler output determines the frequency of the PWM output. The frequency of an 8-bit PWM signal is variable in 256 increments. Writing $00FF (255) to the TIMB counter modulo registers produces a PWM period of 256 times the internal bus clock period if the prescaler select value is $000 (see 17.7.1 TIMB Status and Control Register). MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 240 Freescale Semiconductor Functional Description The value in the TIMB channel registers determines the pulse width of the PWM output. The pulse width of an 8-bit PWM signal is variable in 256 increments. Writing $0080 (128) to the TIMB channel registers produces a duty cycle of 128/256 or 50 percent. 17.3.4.1 Unbuffered PWM Signal Generation Any output compare channel can generate unbuffered PWM pulses as described in 17.3.4 Pulse-Width Modulation (PWM). The pulses are unbuffered because changing the pulse width requires writing the new pulse width value over the value currently in the TIMB channel registers. An unsynchronized write to the TIMB channel registers to change a pulse width value could cause incorrect operation for up to two PWM periods. For example, writing a new value before the counter reaches the old value but after the counter reaches the new value prevents any compare during that PWM period. Also, using a TIMB overflow interrupt routine to write a new, smaller pulse width value may cause the compare to be missed. The TIMB may pass the new value before it is written to the TIMB channel registers. Use this method to synchronize unbuffered changes in the PWM pulse width on channel x: • When changing to a shorter pulse width, enable channel x output compare interrupts and write the new value in the output compare interrupt routine. The output compare interrupt occurs at the end of the current pulse. The interrupt routine has until the end of the PWM period to write the new value. • When changing to a longer pulse width, enable TIMB overflow interrupts and write the new value in the TIMB overflow interrupt routine. The TIMB overflow interrupt occurs at the end of the current PWM period. Writing a larger value in an output compare interrupt routine (at the end of the current pulse) could cause two output compares to occur in the same PWM period. NOTE In PWM signal generation, do not program the PWM channel to toggle on output compare. Toggling on output compare prevents reliable 0 percent duty cycle generation and removes the ability of the channel to self-correct in the event of software error or noise. Toggling on output compare also can cause incorrect PWM signal generation when changing the PWM pulse width to a new, much larger value. 17.3.4.2 Buffered PWM Signal Generation Channels 0 and 1 can be linked to form a buffered PWM channel whose output appears on the PTE1/TCH0B pin. The TIMB channel registers of the linked pair alternately control the pulse width of the output. Setting the MS0B bit in TIMB channel 0 status and control register (TBSC0) links channel 0 and channel 1. The TIMB channel 0 registers initially control the pulse width on the PTE1/TCH0B pin. Writing to the TIMB channel 1 registers enables the TIMB channel 1 registers to synchronously control the pulse width at the beginning of the next PWM period. At each subsequent overflow, the TIMB channel registers (0 or 1) that control the pulse width are the ones written to last. TBSC0 controls and monitors the buffered PWM function, and TIMB channel 1 status and control register (TBSC1) is unused. While the MS0B bit is set, the channel 1 pin, PTE2/TCH1B, is available as a general-purpose I/O pin. NOTE In buffered PWM signal generation, do not write new pulse width values to the currently active channel registers. User software should track the MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 241 Timer Interface B (TIMB) currently active channel to prevent writing a new value to the active channel. Writing to the active channel registers is the same as generating unbuffered PWM signals. 17.3.4.3 PWM Initialization To ensure correct operation when generating unbuffered or buffered PWM signals, use this initialization procedure: 1. In the TIMB status and control register (TBSC): a. Stop the TIMB counter by setting the TIMB stop bit, TSTOP. b. Reset the TIMB counter and prescaler by setting the TIMB reset bit, TRST. 2. In the TIMB counter modulo registers (TBMODH–TBMODL), write the value for the required PWM period. 3. In the TIMB channel x registers (TBCHxH–TBCHxL), write the value for the required pulse width. 4. In TIMB channel x status and control register (TBSCx): a. Write 0:1 (for unbuffered output compare or PWM signals) or 1:0 (for buffered output compare or PWM signals) to the mode select bits, MSxB–MSxA. (See Table 17-2.) b. Write 1 to the toggle-on-overflow bit, TOVx. c. Write 1:0 (polarity 1 — to clear output on compare) or 1:1 (polarity 0 — to set output on compare) to the edge/level select bits, ELSxB–ELSxA. The output action on compare must force the output to the complement of the pulse width level. (See Table 17-2.) NOTE In PWM signal generation, do not program the PWM channel to toggle on output compare. Toggling on output compare prevents reliable 0 percent duty cycle generation and removes the ability of the channel to self-correct in the event of software error or noise. Toggling on output compare can also cause incorrect PWM signal generation when changing the PWM pulse width to a new, much larger value. 5. In the TIMB status control register (TBSC), clear the TIMB stop bit, TSTOP. Setting MS0B links channels 0 and 1 and configures them for buffered PWM operation. The TIMB channel 0 registers (TBCH0H–TBCH0L) initially control the buffered PWM output. TIMB status control register 0 (TBSC0) controls and monitors the PWM signal from the linked channels. MS0B takes priority over MS0A. Clearing the toggle-on-overflow bit, TOVx, inhibits output toggles on TIMB overflows. Subsequent output compares try to force the output to a state it is already in and have no effect. The result is a 0 percent duty cycle output. Setting the channel x maximum duty cycle bit (CHxMAX) and setting the TOVx bit generates a 100 percent duty cycle output. (See 17.7.4 TIMB Channel Status and Control Registers.) MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 242 Freescale Semiconductor Interrupts 17.4 Interrupts These TIMB sources can generate interrupt requests: • TIMB overflow flag (TOF) — The timer overflow flag (TOF) bit is set when the TIMB counter reaches the modulo value programmed in the TIMB counter modulo registers. The TIMB overflow interrupt enable bit, TOIE, enables TIMB overflow interrupt requests. TOF and TOIE are in the TIMB status and control registers. • TIMB channel flags (CH1F–CH0F) — The CHxF bit is set when an input capture or output compare occurs on channel x. Channel x TIMB CPU interrupt requests are controlled by the channel x interrupt enable bit, CHxIE. 17.5 Wait Mode The WAIT instruction puts the MCU in low-power standby mode. The TIMB remains active after the execution of a WAIT instruction. In wait mode, the TIMB registers are not accessible by the CPU. Any enabled CPU interrupt request from the TIMB can bring the MCU out of wait mode. If TIMB functions are not required during wait mode, reduce power consumption by stopping the TIMB before executing the WAIT instruction. 17.6 I/O Signals Port E shares three of its pins with the TIMB: • PTE0/TCLKB is an external clock input to the TIMB prescaler. • The two TIMB channel I/O pins are PTE1/TCH0B and PTE2/TCH1B. 17.6.1 TIMB Clock Pin (PTE0/TCLKB) PTE0/TCLKB is an external clock input that can be the clock source for the TIMB counter instead of the prescaled internal bus clock. Select the PTE0/TCLKB input by writing 1s to the three prescaler select bits, PS[2:0]. See 17.7.1 TIMB Status and Control Register. The maximum TCLK frequency is the least: 4 MHz or bus frequency ÷ 2. PTE0/TCLKB is available as a general-purpose I/O pin or ADC channel when not used as the TIMB clock input. When the PTE0/TCLKB pin is the TIMB clock input, it is an input regardless of the state of the DDRE0 bit in data direction register E. 17.6.2 TIMB Channel I/O Pins (PTE1/TCH0B–PTE2/TCH1B) Each channel I/O pin is programmable independently as an input capture pin or an output compare pin. PTE1/TCH0B and PTE2/TCH1B can be configured as buffered output compare or buffered PWM pins. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 243 Timer Interface B (TIMB) 17.7 I/O Registers These input/output (I/O) registers control and monitor TIMB operation: • TIMB status and control register (TBSC) • TIMB control registers (TBCNTH–TBCNTL) • TIMB counter modulo registers (TBMODH–TBMODL) • TIMB channel status and control registers (TBSC0 and TBSC1) • TIMB channel registers (TBCH0H–TBCH0L and TBCH1H–TBCH1L) 17.7.1 TIMB Status and Control Register The TIMB status and control register: • Enables TIMB overflow interrupts • Flags TIMB overflows • Stops the TIMB counter • Resets the TIMB counter • Prescales the TIMB counter clock Address: Read: Write: Reset: $0051 Bit 7 TOF 0 0 R 6 TOIE 0 = Reserved 5 TSTOP 1 4 0 TRST 0 3 0 R 0 2 PS2 0 1 PS1 0 Bit 0 PS0 0 Figure 17-5. TIMB Status and Control Register (TBSC) TOF — TIMB Overflow Flag This read/write flag is set when the TIMB counter reaches the modulo value programmed in the TIMB counter modulo registers. Clear TOF by reading the TIMB status and control register when TOF is set and then writing a logic 0 to TOF. If another TIMB overflow occurs before the clearing sequence is complete, then writing logic 0 to TOF has no effect. Therefore, a TOF interrupt request cannot be lost due to inadvertent clearing of TOF. Reset clears the TOF bit. Writing a logic 1 to TOF has no effect. 1 = TIMB counter has reached modulo value. 0 = TIMB counter has not reached modulo value. TOIE — TIMB Overflow Interrupt Enable Bit This read/write bit enables TIMB overflow interrupts when the TOF bit becomes set. Reset clears the TOIE bit. 1 = TIMB overflow interrupts enabled 0 = TIMB overflow interrupts disabled MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 244 Freescale Semiconductor I/O Registers TSTOP — TIMB Stop Bit This read/write bit stops the TIMB counter. Counting resumes when TSTOP is cleared. Reset sets the TSTOP bit, stopping the TIMB counter until software clears the TSTOP bit. 1 = TIMB counter stopped 0 = TIMB counter active NOTE Do not set the TSTOP bit before entering wait mode if the TIMB is required to exit wait mode. Also, when the TSTOP bit is set and the timer is configured for input capture operation, input captures are inhibited until TSTOP is cleared. TRST — TIMB Reset Bit Setting this write-only bit resets the TIMB counter and the TIMB prescaler. Setting TRST has no effect on any other registers. Counting resumes from $0000. TRST is cleared automatically after the TIMB counter is reset and always reads as logic 0. Reset clears the TRST bit. 1 = Prescaler and TIMB counter cleared 0 = No effect NOTE Setting the TSTOP and TRST bits simultaneously stops the TIMB counter at a value of $0000. PS[2:0] — Prescaler Select Bits These read/write bits select either the PTE0/TCLKB pin or one of the seven prescaler outputs as the input to the TIMB counter as Table 17-1 shows. Reset clears the PS[2:0] bits. Table 17-1. Prescaler Selection PS[2:0] 000 001 010 011 100 101 110 111 TIMB Clock Source Internal bus clock ÷1 Internal bus clock ÷ 2 Internal bus clock ÷ 4 Internal bus clock ÷ 8 Internal bus clock ÷ 16 Internal bus clock ÷ 32 Internal bus clock ÷ 64 PTE0/TCLKB MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 245 Timer Interface B (TIMB) 17.7.2 TIMB Counter Registers The two read-only TIMB counter registers contain the high and low bytes of the value in the TIMB counter. Reading the high byte (TBCNTH) latches the contents of the low byte (TBCNTL) into a buffer. Subsequent reads of TBCNTH do not affect the latched TBCNTL value until TBCNTL is read. Reset clears the TIMB counter registers. Setting the TIMB reset bit (TRST) also clears the TIMB counter registers. NOTE If TBCNTH is read during a break interrupt, be sure to unlatch TBCNTL by reading TBCNTL before exiting the break interrupt. Otherwise, TBCNTL retains the value latched during the break. Register Name and Address: Bit 7 Read: Write: Reset: Bit 15 R 0 6 Bit 14 R 0 TBCNTH — $0052 5 Bit 13 R 0 4 Bit 12 R 0 3 Bit 11 R 0 2 Bit 10 R 0 1 Bit 9 R 0 Bit 0 Bit 8 R 0 Register Name and Address: Bit 7 Read: Write: Reset: Bit 7 R 0 R 6 Bit 6 R 0 = Reserved TBCNTL — $0053 5 Bit 5 R 0 4 Bit 4 R 0 3 Bit 3 R 0 2 Bit 2 R 0 1 Bit 1 R 0 Bit 0 Bit 0 R 0 Figure 17-6. TIMB Counter Registers (TBCNTH and TBCNTL) 17.7.3 TIMB Counter Modulo Registers The read/write TIMB modulo registers contain the modulo value for the TIMB counter. When the TIMB counter reaches the modulo value, the overflow flag (TOF) becomes set, and the TIMB counter resumes counting from $0000 at the next timer clock. Writing to the high byte (TBMODH) inhibits the TOF bit and overflow interrupts until the low byte (TBMODL) is written. Reset sets the TIMB counter modulo registers. Register Name and Address: Bit 7 Read: Write: Reset: Bit 15 1 6 Bit 14 1 TBMODH — $0054 5 Bit 13 1 4 Bit 12 1 3 Bit 11 1 2 Bit 10 1 1 Bit 9 1 Bit 0 Bit 8 1 Register Name and Address: Bit 7 Read: Write: Reset: Bit 7 1 6 Bit 6 1 TBMODL — $0055 5 Bit 5 1 4 Bit 4 1 3 Bit 3 1 2 Bit 2 1 1 Bit 1 1 Bit 0 Bit 0 1 Figure 17-7. TIMB Counter Modulo Registers (TBMODH and TBMODL) NOTE Reset the TIMB counter before writing to the TIMB counter modulo registers. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 246 Freescale Semiconductor I/O Registers 17.7.4 TIMB Channel Status and Control Registers Each of the TIMB channel status and control registers: • Flags input captures and output compares • Enables input capture and output compare interrupts • Selects input capture, output compare, or PWM operation • Selects high, low, or toggling output on output compare • Selects rising edge, falling edge, or any edge as the active input capture trigger • Selects output toggling on TIMB overflow • Selects 0 percent and 100 percent PWM duty cycle • Selects buffered or unbuffered output compare/PWM operation Register Name and Address: Bit 7 Read: Write: Reset: CH0F 0 0 6 CH0IE 0 TBSC0 — $0056 5 MS0B 0 TBSC1 — $0059 6 CH1IE 0 = Reserved 5 0 R 0 4 MS1A 0 3 ELS1B 0 2 ELS1A 0 1 TOV1 0 Bit 0 CH1MAX 0 4 MS0A 0 3 ELS0B 0 2 ELS0A 0 1 TOV0 0 Bit 0 CH0MAX 0 Register Name and Address: Bit 7 Read: Write: Reset: CH1F 0 0 R Figure 17-8. TIMB Channel Status and Control Registers (TBSC0–TBSC1) CHxF — Channel x Flag When channel x is an input capture channel, this read/write bit is set when an active edge occurs on the channel x pin. When channel x is an output compare channel, CHxF is set when the value in the TIMB counter registers matches the value in the TIMB channel x registers. When CHxIE = 1, clear CHxF by reading TIMB channel x status and control register with CHxF set, and then writing a 0 to CHxF. If another interrupt request occurs before the clearing sequence is complete, then writing 0 to CHxF has no effect. Therefore, an interrupt request cannot be lost due to inadvertent clearing of CHxF. Reset clears the CHxF bit. Writing a 1 to CHxF has no effect. 1 = Input capture or output compare on channel x 0 = No input capture or output compare on channel x CHxIE — Channel x Interrupt Enable Bit This read/write bit enables TIMB CPU interrupts on channel x. Reset clears the CHxIE bit. 1 = Channel x CPU interrupt requests enabled 0 = Channel x CPU interrupt requests disabled MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 247 Timer Interface B (TIMB) MSxB — Mode Select Bit B This read/write bit selects buffered output compare/PWM operation. MSxB exists only in the TIMB channel 0. Setting MS0B disables the channel 1 status and control register and reverts TCH1B to general-purpose I/O. Reset clears the MSxB bit. 1 = Buffered output compare/PWM operation enabled 0 = Buffered output compare/PWM operation disabled MSxA — Mode Select Bit A When ELSxB:A ≠ 00, this read/write bit selects either input capture operation or unbuffered output compare/PWM operation. See Table 17-2. 1 = Unbuffered output compare/PWM operation 0 = Input capture operation When ELSxB:A = 00, this read/write bit selects the initial output level of the TCHx pin once PWM, input capture, or output compare operation is enabled. See Table 17-2. Reset clears the MSxA bit. 1 = Initial output level low 0 = Initial output level high NOTE Before changing a channel function by writing to the MSxB or MSxA bit, set the TSTOP and TRST bits in the TIMB status and control register (TBSC). ELSxB and ELSxA — Edge/Level Select Bits When channel x is an input capture channel, these read/write bits control the active edge-sensing logic on channel x. When channel x is an output compare channel, ELSxB and ELSxA control the channel x output behavior when an output compare occurs. When ELSxB and ELSxA are both clear, channel x is not connected to port E, and pin PTEx/TCHxB is available as a general-purpose I/O pin. However, channel x is at a state determined by these bits and becomes transparent to the respective pin when PWM, input capture, or output compare mode is enabled. Table 17-2 shows how ELSxB and ELSxA work. Reset clears the ELSxB and ELSxA bits. NOTE Before enabling a TIMB channel register for input capture operation, make sure that the PTEx/TBCHx pin is stable for at least two bus clocks. TOVx — Toggle-On-Overflow Bit When channel x is an output compare channel, this read/write bit controls the behavior of the channel x output when the TIMB counter overflows. When channel x is an input capture channel, TOVx has no effect. Reset clears the TOVx bit. 1 = Channel x pin toggles on TIMB counter overflow. 0 = Channel x pin does not toggle on TIMB counter overflow. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 248 Freescale Semiconductor I/O Registers Table 17-2. Mode, Edge, and Level Selection MSxB:MSxA X0 X1 00 00 00 01 01 01 01 1X 1X 1X ELSxB:ELSxA 00 00 01 10 11 00 01 10 11 01 10 11 Buffered output compare or buffered PWM Output compare or PWM Input capture Mode Output preset Configuration Pin under port control; initialize timer output level high Pin under port control; initialize timer output level low Capture on rising edge only Capture on falling edge only Capture on rising or falling edge Softare compare only Toggle output on compare Clear output on compare Set output on compare Toggle output on compare Clear output on compare Set output on compare NOTE When TOVx is set, a TIMB counter overflow takes precedence over a channel x output compare if both occur at the same time. CHxMAX — Channel x Maximum Duty Cycle Bit When the TOVx is 1 and clear output on compare is selected, setting the CHxMAX bit forces the duty cycle of buffered and unbuffered PWM signals to 100 percent. As Figure 17-9 shows, CHxMAX bit takes effect in the cycle after it is set or cleared. The output stays at 100 percent duty cycle level until the cycle after CHxMAX is cleared. OVERFLOW OVERFLOW OVERFLOW OVERFLOW OVERFLOW PERIOD PTEx/TCHx OUTPUT COMPARE CHxMAX OUTPUT COMPARE OUTPUT COMPARE OUTPUT COMPARE TOVx Figure 17-9. CHxMAX Latency MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 249 Timer Interface B (TIMB) 17.7.5 TIMB Channel Registers These read/write registers contain the captured TIMB counter value of the input capture function or the output compare value of the output compare function. The state of the TIMB channel registers after reset is unknown. In input capture mode (MSxB–MSxA = 0:0), reading the high byte of the TIMB channel x registers (TBCHxH) inhibits input captures until the low byte (TBCHxL) is read. In output compare mode (MSxB–MSxA ≠ 0:0), writing to the high byte of the TIMB channel x registers (TBCHxH) inhibits output compares until the low byte (TBCHxL) is written. Register Name and Address: Bit 7 Read: Write: Reset: Register Name and Address: Bit 7 Read: Write: Reset: Register Name and Address: Bit 7 Read: Write: Reset: Register Name and Address: Bit 7 Read: Write: Reset: Bit 7 6 Bit 6 Bit 15 6 Bit 14 Bit 7 6 Bit 6 Bit 15 6 Bit 14 TBCH0H — $0057 5 Bit 13 4 Bit 12 3 Bit 11 2 Bit 10 1 Bit 9 Bit 0 Bit 8 Indeterminate after reset TBCH0L — $0058 5 Bit 5 4 Bit 4 3 Bit 3 2 Bit 2 1 Bit 1 Bit 0 Bit 0 Indeterminate after reset TBCH1H — $005A 5 Bit 13 4 Bit 12 3 Bit 11 2 Bit 10 1 Bit 9 Bit 0 Bit 8 Indeterminate after reset TBCH1L — $005B 5 Bit 5 4 Bit 4 3 Bit 3 2 Bit 2 1 Bit 1 Bit 0 Bit 0 Indeterminate after reset Figure 17-10. TIMB Channel Registers (TBCH0H/L–TBCH1H/L) MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 250 Freescale Semiconductor Chapter 18 Development Support 18.1 Introduction This section describes the break module, the monitor read-only memory (MON), and the monitor mode entry methods. 18.2 Break Module (BRK) The break module (BRK) can generate a break interrupt that stops normal program flow at a defined address to enter a background program. Features include: • Accessible input/output (I/O) registers during the break interrupt • Central processor unit (CPU) generated break interrupts • Software-generated break interrupts • Computer operating properly (COP) disabling during break interrupts 18.2.1 Functional Description When the internal address bus matches the value written in the break address registers, the break module issues a breakpoint signal to the CPU. The CPU then loads the instruction register with a software interrupt instruction (SWI) after completion of the current CPU instruction. The program counter vectors to $FFFC and $FFFD ($FEFC and $FEFD in monitor mode). These events can cause a break interrupt to occur: • A CPU-generated address (the address in the program counter) matches the contents of the break address registers. • Software writes a logic 1 to the BRKA bit in the break status and control register. When a CPU-generated address matches the contents of the break address registers, the break interrupt begins after the CPU completes its current instruction. A return-from-interrupt instruction (RTI) in the break routine ends the break interrupt and returns the microcontroller unit (MCU) to normal operation. Figure 18-1 shows the structure of the break module. 18.2.1.1 Flag Protection During Break Interrupts The BCFE bit in the SIM break flag control register (SBFCR) enables software to clear status bits during the break state. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 251 Development Support IAB15–IAB8 BREAK ADDRESS REGISTER HIGH 8-BIT COMPARATOR IAB15–IAB0 CONTROL 8-BIT COMPARATOR BREAK ADDRESS REGISTER LOW BREAK IAB7–IAB0 Figure 18-1. Break Module Block Diagram Addr. $FE00 Register Name SIM Break Status Register Read: (SBSR) Write: See page 255. Reset: SIM Break Flag Control Read: Register (SBFCR) Write: See page 255. Reset: Break Address Register High Read: (BRKH) Write: See page 254. Reset: Bit 7 R 6 R 5 R 4 R 3 R 2 R 1 BW 0 BCFE 0 Bit 15 0 Bit 7 0 BRKE 0 14 0 6 0 BRKA 0 = Unimplemented 13 0 5 0 0 0 12 0 4 0 0 0 R 11 0 3 0 0 0 = Reserved 10 0 2 0 0 0 9 0 1 0 0 0 Bit 8 0 Bit 0 0 0 0 R R R R R R R Bit 0 R $FE03 $FE0C Break Address Register Low Read: $FE0D (BRKL) Write: See page 254. Reset: $FE0E Break Status and Control Read: Register (BRKSCR) Write: See page 254. Reset: Note: Writing a 0 clears BW. Figure 18-2. I/O Register Summary MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 252 Freescale Semiconductor Break Module (BRK) 18.2.1.2 CPU During Break Interrupts The CPU starts a break interrupt by: • Loading the instruction register with the SWI instruction • Loading the program counter with $FFFC and $FFFD ($FEFC and $FEFD in monitor mode) The break interrupt begins after completion of the CPU instruction in progress. If the break address register match occurs on the last cycle of a CPU instruction, the break interrupt begins immediately. 18.2.1.3 TIM1 and TIM2 During Break Interrupts A break interrupt stops the timer counters. 18.2.1.4 COP During Break Interrupts The COP is disabled during a break interrupt when VTST is present on the RST pin. 18.2.2 Low-Power Modes The WAIT and STOP instructions put the MCU in low power- consumption standby modes. 18.2.2.1 Wait Mode If enabled, the break module is active in wait mode. In the break routine, the user can subtract one from the return address on the stack if SBSW is set. Clear the BW bit by writing logic 0 to it. 18.2.2.2 Stop Mode The break module is inactive in stop mode. The STOP instruction does not affect break module register states. 18.2.3 Break Module Registers These registers control and monitor operation of the break module: • Break status and control register (BRKSCR) • Break address register high (BRKH) • Break address register low (BRKL) • SIM break status register (SBSR) • SIM break flag control register (SBFCR) MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 253 Development Support 18.2.3.1 Break Status and Control Register The break status and control register (BRKSCR) contains break module enable and status bits. Address: Read: Write: Reset: $FE0E Bit 7 BRKE 0 6 BRKA 0 5 0 0 4 0 0 3 0 0 2 0 0 1 0 0 Bit 0 0 0 = Unimplemented Figure 18-3. Break Status and Control Register (BRKSCR) BRKE — Break Enable Bit This read/write bit enables breaks on break address register matches. Clear BRKE by writing a logic 0 to bit 7. Reset clears the BRKE bit. 1 = Breaks enabled on 16-bit address match 0 = Breaks disabled on 16-bit address match BRKA — Break Active Bit This read/write status and control bit is set when a break address match occurs. Writing a logic 1 to BRKA generates a break interrupt. Clear BRKA by writing a logic 0 to it before exiting the break routine. Reset clears the BRKA bit. 1 = When read, break address match 0 = When read, no break address match 18.2.3.2 Break Address Registers The break address registers (BRKH and BRKL) contain the high and low bytes of the desired breakpoint address. Reset clears the break address registers. Address: Read: Write: Reset: $FE0C Bit 7 Bit 15 0 6 14 0 5 13 0 4 12 0 3 11 0 2 10 0 1 9 0 Bit 0 Bit 8 0 Figure 18-4. Break Address Register High (BRKH) Address: Read: Write: Reset: $FE0D Bit 7 Bit 7 0 6 6 0 5 5 0 4 4 0 3 3 0 2 2 0 1 1 0 Bit 0 Bit 0 0 Figure 18-5. Break Address Register Low (BRKL) MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 254 Freescale Semiconductor Monitor ROM (MON) 18.2.3.3 Break Status Register The break status register (SBSR) contains a flag to indicate that a break caused an exit from wait mode. The flag is useful in applications requiring a return to wait mode after exiting from a break interrupt. Address: Read: Write: Reset: $FE00 Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 R R R R R R BW 0 R Figure 18-6. SIM Break Status Register (SBSR) BW — Break Wait Bit This read/write bit is set when a break interrupt causes an exit from wait mode. Clear BW by writing a logic 0 to it. Reset clears BW. 1 = Break interrupt during wait mode 0 = No break interrupt during wait mode BW can be read within the break interrupt routine. The user can modify the return address on the stack by subtracting 1 from it. 18.2.3.4 Break Flag Control Register The break flag control register (SBFCR) contains a bit that enables software to clear status bits while the MCU is in a break state. Address: Read: Write: Reset: $FE03 Bit 7 BCFE 0 R = Reserved 6 R 5 R 4 R 3 R 2 R 1 R Bit 0 R Figure 18-7. SIM Break Flag Control Register (SBFCR) BCFE — Break Clear Flag Enable Bit This read/write bit enables software to clear status bits by accessing status registers while the MCU is in a break state. To clear status bits during the break state, the BCFE bit must be set. 1 = Status bits clearable during break 0 = Status bits not clearable during break 18.3 Monitor ROM (MON) The monitor ROM (MON) allows complete testing of the microcontroller unit (MCU) through a single-wire interface with a host computer. Monitor mode entry can be achieved without the use of VTST as long as vector addresses $FFFE and $FFFF are blank, thus reducing the hardware requirements for in-circuit programming. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 255 Development Support Features include: • Normal user-mode pin functionality • One pin dedicated to serial communication between monitor ROM and host computer • Standard mark/space non-return-to-zero (NRZ) communication with host computer • 4800 baud–28.8 Kbaud communication with host computer • Execution of code in random-access memory (RAM) or ROM • FLASH programming 18.3.1 Functional Description The monitor ROM receives and executes commands from a host computer. Figure 18-8 shows a sample circuit used to enter monitor mode and communicate with a host computer via a standard RS-232 interface. Simple monitor commands can access any memory address. In monitor mode, the MCU can execute host-computer code in RAM while all MCU pins retain normal operating mode functions. All communication between the host computer and the MCU is through the PTA0 pin. A level-shifting and multiplexing interface is required between PTA0 and the host computer. PTA0 is used in a wired-OR configuration and requires a pullup resistor. 18.3.1.1 Entering Monitor Mode There are two methods for entering monitor: • The first is the traditional M68HC08 method where VDD + VHI is applied to IRQ1 and the mode pins are configured appropriately. • A second method, intended for in-circuit programming applications, will force entry into monitor mode without requiring high voltage on the IRQ1 pin when the reset vector locations of the FLASH are erased ($FF). NOTE For both methods, holding the PTC2 pin low when entering monitor mode causes a bypass of a divide-by-two stage at the oscillator. The CGMOUT frequency is equal to the CGMXCLK frequency, and the OSC1 input directly generates internal bus clocks. In this case, the OSC1 signal must have a 50 percent duty cycle at maximum bus frequency. Table 18-1 is a summary of the differences between user mode and monitor mode. Table 18-1. Mode Differences Functions Modes User Monitor COP Enabled Disabled(1) Rest Vector High $FFFE $FEFE Reset Vector Low $FFFF $FEFF Break Vector High $FFFC $FEFC Break Vector Low $FFFD $FEFD SWI Vector High $FFFC $FEFC SWI Vector Low $FFFD $FEFD 1. If the high voltage (VDD + VHI) is removed from the IRQ1 pin or the RST pin, the SIM asserts its COP enable output. The COP is a mask option enabled or disabled by the COPD bit in the configuration register. 18.3.1.2 Normal Monitor Mode Table 18-2 shows the pin conditions for entering monitor mode. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 256 Freescale Semiconductor Monitor ROM (MON) VDD 10 kΩ S1 RST 0.1 µF MC68HC908MR16/ MC68HC908MR32 VHI 10 kΩ VDDA 1 10 µF + 3 4 10 µF + 18 0.1 µF 17 + 10 µF VDD VREFH VREFH 0.1 µF 0.02 µF 5 6 16 15 20 pF X1 4.9152 MHz 10 MΩ OSC2 VDD 1 2 6 4 VDD 10 kΩ A B S3 VDD 10 kΩ A B S2 VDD 10 kΩ PTC3 PTC4 MC74HC125 14 3 5 VDD VDD 0.1 µF 20 pF VREFL VSSAD VSSA PWMGND VSS OSC1 CGMXFC MC145407 20 + 10 µF 0.1 µF VDDAD VDDAD IRQ VDDA 2 19 DB-25 2 3 7 7 VDD 10 kΩ PTA0 PTA7 PTC2 S2 Position A — Bus clock = CGMXCLK ÷ 4 or CGMVCLK ÷ 4 S2 Position B — Bus clock = CGMXCLK ÷ 2 S3 Position A — Parallel communication S3 Position B — Serial communication Figure 18-8. Monitor Mode Circuit MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 257 258 Development Support Table 18-2. Monitor Mode Signal Requirements and Options For Serial IRQ RESET (S1) $FFFE /$FFFF PLL PTC3 PTC4 PTC2 External Bus CGMOUT (S2) Clock(1) Frequency Communication(2) COP Baud PTA7 PTA0 (S3) Rate(3) (4) Disabled X 1 Disabled X 1 Disabled X 1 Disabled X Enabled X 1 X DNA — Enters user mode — will encounter an illegal address reset 1 0 DNA 9600 External frequency always divided by 4 1 0 DNA 9600 X 0 0 9600 No operation until reset goes high PTC3 and PTC2 voltages only required if IRQ = VTST; PTC2 determines frequency divider PTC3 and PTC2 voltages only required if IRQ = VTST; PTC2 determines frequency divider Comment MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor X VTST GND VDD or VTST VDD or VTST VDD X X X X X X 4.9152 MHz 0 4.9152 MHz 0 2.4576 MHz X OFF 1 0 0 VTST X OFF 1 0 1 9.8304 MHz 9.8304 MHz 4.9152 MHz 4.9152 MHz 2.4576 MHz 2.4576 MHz VDD VDD or GND VDD or GND $FFFF Blank $FFFF Blank OFF X X X VTST VDD or VTST OFF X X X X — — Non-$FF OFF Programmed X X X X — — Enabled X X — Enters user mode 1. External clock is derived by a 32.768 kHz crystal or a 4.9152/9.8304 MHz off-chip oscillator. 2. DNA = does not apply, X = don’t care 3. PAT0 = 1 if serial communication; PTA0 = X if parallel communication 4. PTA7 = 0 → serial, PTA7 = 1 → parallel communication for security code entry Monitor ROM (MON) Enter monitor mode by either: • Executing a software interrupt instruction (SWI) or • Applying a logic 0 and then a logic 1 to the RST pin Once out of reset, the MCU waits for the host to send eight security bytes. After receiving the security bytes, the MCU sends a break signal (10 consecutive logic 0s) to the host computer, indicating that it is ready to receive a command. The break signal also provides a timing reference to allow the host to determine the necessary baud rate. Monitor mode uses alternate vectors for reset and SWI. The alternate vectors are in the $FE page instead of the $FF page and allow code execution from the internal monitor firmware instead of user code. The computer operating properly (COP) module is disabled in monitor mode as long as VHI is applied to either the IRQ pin or the RST pin. (See Chapter 14 System Integration Module (SIM) for more information on modes of operation.) 18.3.1.3 Forced Monitor Mode If the voltage applied to the IRQ1 is less than VDD + VHI the MCU will come out of reset in user mode. The MENRST module is monitoring the reset vector fetches and will assert an internal reset if it detects that the reset vectors are erased ($FF). When the MCU comes out of reset, it is forced into monitor mode without requiring high voltage on the IRQ1 pin. The COP module is disabled in forced monitor mode. Any reset other than a POR reset will automatically force the MCU to come back to the forced monitor mode. 18.3.1.4 Data Format Communication with the monitor ROM is in standard non-return-to-zero (NRZ) mark/space data format. (See Figure 18-9 and Figure 18-10.) START BIT NEXT START BIT BIT 0 BIT 1 BIT 2 BIT 3 BIT 4 BIT 5 BIT 6 BIT 7 STOP BIT Figure 18-9. Monitor Data Format START BIT START BIT NEXT START BIT NEXT START BIT $A5 BREAK BIT 0 BIT 0 BIT 1 BIT 1 BIT 2 BIT 2 BIT 3 BIT 3 BIT 4 BIT 4 BIT 5 BIT 5 BIT 6 BIT 6 BIT 7 BIT 7 STOP BIT STOP BIT Figure 18-10. Sample Monitor Waveforms The data transmit and receive rate can be anywhere from 4800 baud to 28.8 Kbaud. Transmit and receive baud rates must be identical. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 259 Development Support 18.3.1.5 Echoing As shown in Figure 18-11, the monitor ROM immediately echoes each received byte back to the PTA0 pin for error checking. SENT TO MONITOR READ ECHO READ ADDR. HIGH ADDR. HIGH ADDR. LOW ADDR. LOW DATA RESULT Figure 18-11. Read Transaction Any result of a command appears after the echo of the last byte of the command. 18.3.1.6 Break Signal A start bit followed by nine low bits is a break signal. See Figure 18-12. When the monitor receives a break signal, it drives the PTA0 pin high for the duration of two bits before echoing the break signal. MISSING STOP BIT 2--STOP-BIT DELAY BEFORE ZERO ECHO 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 Figure 18-12. Break Transaction 18.3.1.7 Commands The monitor ROM uses these commands (see Table 18-3–Table 18-8): • READ, read memory • WRITE, write memory • IREAD, indexed read • IWRITE, indexed write • READSP, read stack pointer • RUN, run user program MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 260 Freescale Semiconductor Monitor ROM (MON) Table 18-3. READ (Read Memory) Command Description Operand Data Returned Opcode Read byte from memory 2-byte address in high-byte:low-byte order Returns contents of specified address $4A Command Sequence SENT TO MONITOR READ READ ADDRESS HIGH ADDRESS HIGH ADDRESS LOW ADDRESS LOW DATA ECHO RETURN Table 18-4. WRITE (Write Memory) Command Description Operand Data Returned Opcode FROM HOST Write byte to memory 2-byte address in high-byte:low-byte order; low byte followed by data byte None $49 Command Sequence WRITE WRITE ADDRESS HIGH ADDRESS HIGH ADDRESS LOW ADDRESS LOW DATA DATA ECHO Table 18-5. IREAD (Indexed Read) Command Description Operand Data Returned Opcode Read next 2 bytes in memory from last address accessed 2-byte address in high byte:low byte order Returns contents of next two addresses $1A Command Sequence FROM HOST IREAD IREAD DATA DATA ECHO RETURN MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 261 Development Support Table 18-6. IWRITE (Indexed Write) Command Description Operand Data Returned Opcode Write to last address accessed + 1 Single data byte None $19 Command Sequence FROM HOST IWRITE IWRITE DATA DATA ECHO A sequence of IREAD or IWRITE commands can access a block of memory sequentially over the full 64-Kbyte memory map. Table 18-7. READSP (Read Stack Pointer) Command Description Operand Data Returned Opcode Reads stack pointer None Returns incremented stack pointer value (SP + 1) in high-byte:low-byte order $0C Command Sequence FROM HOST READSP READSP SP HIGH SP LOW ECHO RETURN Table 18-8. RUN (Run User Program) Command Description Operand Data Returned Opcode Executes PULH and RTI instructions None None $28 Command Sequence FROM HOST RUN RUN ECHO MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 262 Freescale Semiconductor Monitor ROM (MON) 18.3.1.8 Baud Rate With a 4.9152-MHz crystal and the PTC2 pin at logic 1 during reset, data is transferred between the monitor and host at 4800 baud. If the PTC2 pin is at logic 0 during reset, the monitor baud rate is 9600. See Table 18-9. Table 18-9. Monitor Baud Rate Selection VCO Frequency Multiplier (N) 1 Monitor baud rate 4800 2 9600 3 14,400 4 19,200 5 24,000 6 28,800 18.3.2 Security A security feature discourages unauthorized reading of FLASH locations while in monitor mode. The host can bypass the security feature at monitor mode entry by sending eight security bytes that match the bytes at locations $FFF6–$FFFD. Locations $FFF6–$FFFD contain user-defined data. NOTE Do not leave locations $FFF6–$FFFD blank. For security reasons, program locations $FFF6–$FFFD even if they are not used for vectors. During monitor mode entry, the MCU waits after the power-on reset for the host to send the eight security bytes on pin PTA0. If the received bytes match those at locations $FFF6–$FFFD, the host bypasses the security feature and can read all FLASH locations and execute code from FLASH. Security remains bypassed until a power-on reset occurs. If the reset was not a power-on reset, security remains bypassed and security code entry is not required. (See Figure 18-13.) Upon power-on reset, if the received bytes of the security code do not match the data at locations $FFF6–$FFFD, the host fails to bypass the security feature. The MCU remains in monitor mode, but reading a FLASH location returns an invalid value and trying to execute code from FLASH causes an illegal address reset. After receiving the eight security bytes from the host, the MCU transmits a break character, signifying that it is ready to receive a command. NOTE The MCU does not transmit a break character until after the host sends the eight security bytes. To determine whether the security code entered is correct, check to see if bit 6 of RAM address $60 is set. If it is, then the correct security code has been entered and FLASH can be accessed. If the security sequence fails, the device can be reset (via power-pin reset only) and brought up in monitor mode to attempt another entry. After failing the security sequence, the FLASH mode can also be bulk erased by executing an erase routine that was downloaded into internal RAM. The bulk erase operation clears the security code locations so that all eight security bytes become $FF. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 263 Development Support VDD 4096 + 32 CGMXCLK CYCLES RST 24 BUS CYCLES PA7 COMMAND 1 BYTE 2 ECHO BYTE 8 ECHO 2 BREAK 3 1 COMMAND ECHO 256 BUS CYCLES (MINIMUM) BYTE 1 BYTE 2 BYTE 8 1 FROM HOST PA0 1 FROM MCU BYTE 1 ECHO NOTES: 1 = Echo delay, 2 bit times 2 = Data return delay, 2 bit times 3 = Wait 1 bit time before sending next byte. 3 Figure 18-13. Monitor Mode Entry Timing MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 264 Freescale Semiconductor Chapter 19 Electrical Specifications 19.1 Introduction This section contains electrical and timing specifications. 19.2 Absolute Maximum Ratings Maximum ratings are the extreme limits to which the microcontroller unit (MCU) can be exposed without permanently damaging it. NOTE This device is not guaranteed to operate properly at the maximum ratings. For guaranteed operating conditions, refer to 19.5 DC Electrical Characteristics. Characteristic(1) Supply voltage Input voltage Input high voltage Maximum current per pin excluding VDD and VSS Storage temperature Maximum current out of VSS Maximum current into VDD 1. Voltages referenced to VSS. Symbol VDD VIn VHI I TSTG IMVSS IMVDD Value –0.3 to +6.0 VSS –0.3 to VDD +0.3 VDD + 4 maximum ±25 –55 to +150 100 100 Unit V V V mA °C mA mA NOTE This device contains circuitry to protect the inputs against damage due to high static voltages or electric fields; however, it is advised that normal precautions be taken to avoid application of any voltage higher than maximum-rated voltages to this high-impedance circuit. For proper operation, it is recommended that VIn and VOut be constrained to the range VSS ≤ (VIn or VOut) ≤ VDD. Reliability of operation is enhanced if unused inputs are connected to an appropriate logic voltage level (for example, either VSS or VDD). MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 265 Electrical Specifications 19.3 Functional Operating Range Characteristic Operating temperature range(1) MC68HC908MR24CFU MC68HC908MR24VFU Operating voltage range 1. See Freescale representative for temperature availability. C = Extended temperature range (–40°C to +85°C) V = Automotive temperature range (–40°C to +105°C) Symbol TA VDD Value –40 to 85 –40 to 105 5.0 ± 10% Unit °C V 19.4 Thermal Characteristics Characteristic Thermal resistance, 64-pin QFP I/O pin power dissipation Power dissipation(1) Constant(2) Average junction temperature Maximum junction temperature Symbol θJA PI/O PD Value 76 User determined PD = (IDD x VDD) + PI/O = K/(TJ + 273°C) PD x (TA + 273°C) + PD2 x θJA TA + (PD x θJA) 125 Unit °C/W W W W/°C °C °C K TJ TJM 1. Power dissipation is a function of temperature. 2. K is a constant unique to the device. K can be determined for a known TA and measured PD. With this value of K, PD and TJ can be determined for any value of TA. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 266 Freescale Semiconductor DC Electrical Characteristics 19.5 DC Electrical Characteristics Characteristic(1) Output high voltage (ILoad = –2.0 mA) all I/O pins Output low voltage (ILoad = 1.6 mA) all I/O pins PWM pin output source current (VOH = VDD –0.8 V) PWM pin output sink current (VOL = 0.8 V) Input high voltage, all ports, IRQs, RESET, OSC1 Input low voltage, all ports, IRQs, RESET, OSC1 VDD supply current Run(3) Wait(4) Stop(5) I/O ports high-impedance leakage current Input current (input only pins) Capacitance Ports (as input or output) Low-voltage inhibit reset(6) Low-voltage reset/recover hysteresis Low-voltage inhibit reset recovery (VREC1 = VLVR1 + VLVH1) Low-voltage inhibit reset Low-voltage reset/recover hysteresis Low-voltage inhibit reset recovery (VREC2 = VLVR2 + VLVH2) POR re-arm voltage(7) POR rise time ramp rate(8) POR reset voltage(9) Monitor mode entry voltage (on IRQ) IDD — — — — — — — 4.0 40 4.04 3.85 150 4.0 0 0.035 0 VDD + 2.5 — — — — — — — 4.35 90 4.5 4.15 210 4.4 — — 700 — 30 12 700 ±10 ±1 12 8 4.65 150 4.75 4.45 250 4.6 100 — 800 8.0 mA mA µA µA µA pF V mV V V mV V mV V/ms V V Symbol VOH VOL IOH IOL VIH VIL Min VDD –0.8 — –7 20 0.7 x VDD VSS Typ(2) — — — — — — Max — 0.4 — — VDD 0.3 x VDD Unit V V mA mA V V IIL IIn COut CIn VLVR1 VLVH1 VREC1 VLVR2 VLVH2 VREC2 VPOR RPOR VPORRST VHi 1. VDD = 5.0 Vdc ± 10%, VSS = 0 Vdc, TA = TL to TH, unless otherwise noted. 2. Typical values reflect average measurements at midpoint of voltage range, 25°C only. 3. Run (operating) IDD measured using external square wave clock source (fOSC = 8.2 MHz). All inputs 0.2 V from rail; no dc loads; less than 100 pF on all outputs. CL = 20 pF on OSC2; all ports configured as inputs; OSC2 capacitance linearly affects run IDD; measured with all modules enabled 4. Wait IDD measured using external square wave clock source (fOSC = 8.2 MHz); all inputs 0.2 V from rail; no dc loads; less than 100 pF on all outputs. CL = 20 pF on OSC2; all ports configured as inputs; OSC2 capacitance linearly affects wait IDD; measured with PLL and LVI enabled. 5. Stop IDD measured with PLL and LVI disengaged, OCS1 grounded, no port pins sourcing current. It is measured through combination of VDD, VDDAD, and VDDA. 6. The low-voltage inhibit reset is software selectable. Refer to Chapter 9 Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI). 7. Maximum is highest voltage that POR is guaranteed. 8. If minimum VDD is not reached before the internal POR is released, RST must be driven low externally until minimum VDD is reached. 9. Maximum is highest voltage that POR is possible. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 267 Electrical Specifications 19.6 FLASH Memory Characteristics Characteristic RAM data retention voltage FLASH program bus clock frequency FLASH read bus clock frequency FLASH page erase time 1 K cycles FLASH mass erase time FLASH PGM/ERASE to HVEN setup time FLASH high-voltage hold time FLASH high-voltage hold time (mass erase) FLASH program hold time FLASH program time FLASH return to read time FLASH cumulative program HV period FLASH endurance(4) FLASH data retention time(5) Symbol VRDR — fRead(1) tErase tMErase tNVS tNVH tNVHL tPGS tPROG tRCV(2) tHV(3) — — Min 1.3 1 0 0.9 3.6 4 10 5 100 5 30 1 — 10 k 15 Typ — — — 1 4 — — — — — — — — 100 k 100 Max — — 8M 1.1 5.5 — — — — — 40 — 4 — — Unit V MHz Hz ms ms µs µs µs µs µs µs ms Cycles Years 1. fRead is defined as the frequency range for which the FLASH memory can be read. 2. tRCV is defined as the time it needs before the FLASH can be read after turning off the high voltage charge pump, by clearing HVEN to 0. 3. tHV is defined as the cumulative high voltage programming time to the same row before next erase. tHV must satisfy this condition: tNVS + tNVH + tPGS + (tPROG x 32) ≤ tHV maximum. 4. Typical endurance was evaluated for this product family. For additional information on how Freescale defines Typical Endurance, please refer to Engineering Bulletin EB619. 5. Typical data retention values are based on intrinsic capability of the technology measured at high temperature and de-rated to 25°C using the Arrhenius equation. For additional information on how Freescale defines Typical Data Retention, please refer to Engineering Bulletin EB618. 19.7 Control Timing Characteristic(1) Frequency of operation(2) Crystal option External clock option(3) Internal operating frequency RESET input pulse width low(5) Symbol fOSC fOP tIRL Min 1 dc(4) — 50 Max Unit 8 32.8 8.2 — MHz MHz ns 1. VDD = 5.0 Vdc ± 10%, VSS = 0 Vdc; timing shown with respect to 20% VDD and 70% VDD, unless otherwise noted 2. See 19.8 Serial Peripheral Interface Characteristics for more information. 3. No more than 10% duty cycle deviation from 50%. 4. Some modules may require a minimum frequency greater than dc for proper operation; see appropriate table for this information. 5. Minimum pulse width reset is guaranteed to be recognized. It is possible for a smaller pulse width to cause a reset. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 268 Freescale Semiconductor Serial Peripheral Interface Characteristics 19.8 Serial Peripheral Interface Characteristics Diagram Number(1) Characteristic(2) Operating frequency Master Slave Cycle time Master Slave Enable lead time Enable lag time Clock (SPCK) high time Master Slave Clock (SPCK) low time Master Slave Data setup time (inputs) Master Slave Data hold time (inputs) Master Slave Access time, slave(3) CPHA = 0 CHPA = 1 Disable time, slave(4) Data valid time after enable edge Master Slave(5) Symbol Min Max Unit fOP(M) fOP(S) tCYC(M) tCYC(S) tLead(S) tLag(S) tSCKH(M) tSCKH(S) tSCKL(M) tSCKL(S) tSU(M) tSU(S) tH(M) tH(S) tA(CP0) tA(CP1) tDIS(S) tV(M) tV(S) fOP/128 fOP/2 fOP MHz dc 2 1 15 15 100 50 1 2 3 4 128 — — — — — tCYC ns ns ns 5 100 50 45 5 0 15 0 0 — — — — — — — 40 20 25 ns 6 ns 7 ns 8 9 ns ns 10 — — 10 40 ns 1. VDD = 5.0 Vdc ± 10%, all timing is shown with respect to 20% VDD and 70% VDD, unless otherwise noted; assumes 100 pF load on all SPI pins 2. Numbers refer to dimensions in Figure 19-1 and Figure 19-2. 3. Time to data active from high-impedance state 4. Hold time to high-impedance state 5. With 100 pF on all SPI pins MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 269 Electrical Specifications SS INPUT SS PIN OF MASTER HELD HIGH 1 SPCK, CPOL = 0 OUTPUT NOTE 5 4 SPCK, CPOL = 1 OUTPUT NOTE 5 4 6 7 LSB IN 10 BITS 6–1 11 MASTER LSB OUT MISO INPUT 10 MOSI OUTPUT MSB IN 11 MASTER MSB OUT BITS 6–1 Note: This first clock edge is generated internally, but is not seen at the SCK pin. a) SPI Master Timing (CPHA = 0) SS INPUT SS PIN OF MASTER HELD HIGH 1 SPCK, CPOL = 0 OUTPUT 5 4 NOTE SPCK, CPOL = 1 OUTPUT 5 4 6 7 LSB IN 10 BITS 6–1 11 MASTER LSB OUT NOTE MISO INPUT 10 MOSI OUTPUT MSB IN 11 MASTER MSB OUT BITS 6–1 Note: This last clock edge is generated internally, but is not seen at the SCK pin. b) SPI Master Timing (CPHA = 1) Figure 19-1. SPI Master Timing MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 270 Freescale Semiconductor Serial Peripheral Interface Characteristics SS INPUT 1 SPCK, CPOL = 0 INPUT 2 SPCK, CPOL = 1 INPUT 8 MISO INPUT SLAVE 6 MOSI OUTPUT MSB IN MSB OUT 7 10 BITS 6–1 BITS 6–1 11 LSB IN SLAVE LSB OUT 11 5 4 9 NOTE 11 5 4 3 Note: Not defined, but normally MSB of character just received a) SPI Slave Timing (CPHA = 0) SS INPUT 1 SPCK, CPOL = 0 INPUT 2 SPCK, CPOL = 1 INPUT 8 MISO INPUT 5 4 10 NOTE SLAVE 6 MOSI OUTPUT MSB IN MSB OUT 7 10 BITS 6–1 BITS 6–1 11 LSB IN 9 SLAVE LSB OUT 5 4 3 Note: Not defined, but normally LSB of character previously transmitted b) SPI Slave Timing (CPHA = 1) Figure 19-2. SPI Slave Timing MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 271 Electrical Specifications 19.9 TImer Interface Module Characteristics Characteristic Input capture pulse width Input clock pulse width Symbol tTIH, tTIL tTCH, tTCL Min 125 (1/fOP) + 5 Max — — Unit ns ns 19.10 Clock Generation Module Component Specifications Characteristic Crystal load capacitance Crystal fixed capacitance Crystal tuning capacitance Feedback bias resistor Series resistor Filter capacitor Symbol CL C1 C2 RB RS CF Min — — — — 0 — Typ — 2 * CL 2 * CL 22 MΩ 330 kΩ CFACT* (VDDA/fXCLK) Max — — — — 1 MΩ — CBYP must provide low ac impedance from f = fXCLK/100 to 100*fVCLK, so series resistance must be considered Not required Notes Consult crystal manufacturing data Consult crystal manufacturing data Consult crystal manufacturing data Bypass capacitor CBYP — 0.1 µF — 19.11 CGM Operating Conditions Characteristic Crystal reference frequency Range nominal multiplier VCO center-of-range frequency VCO frequency multiplier VCO center of range multiplier VCO operating frequency Symbol fXCLK fNOM fVRS N L fVCLK Min 1 — 4.9152 1 1 fVRSMIN Typ — 4.9152 — — — — Max 8 — 32.8 15 15 fVRSMAX Unit MHz MHz MHz — — — MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 272 Freescale Semiconductor CGM Acquisition/Lock Time Specifications 19.12 CGM Acquisition/Lock Time Specifications Description Filter capacitor multiply factor Acquisition mode time factor Tracking mode time factor Manual mode time to stable Symbol CFACT KACQ KTRK tACQ tAL tLock ∆TRK ∆ACQ ∆Lock ∆UNL nACQ nTRK tACQ tAL tLock fJ Min — — — — Typ 0.0154 0.1135 0.0174 (8*VDDA)/ (fXCLK*KACQ) (4*VDDA)/ (fXCLK*KTRK) tACQ+tAL — — — — 32 128 (8*VDDA)/ (fXCLK*KACQ) (4*VDDA)/ (fXCLK*KTRK) tACQ+tAL — Max — — — — Notes F/sV V V If CF chosen correctly If CF chosen correctly Manual stable to lock time Manual acquisition time Tracking mode entry frequency tolerance Acquisition mode entry frequency tolerance Lock entry frequency tolerance Lock exit frequency tolerance Reference cycles per acquisition mode measurement Reference cycles per tracking mode measurement Automatic mode time to stable — — 0 — — ± 3.6% ± 7.2% ± 0.9% ± 1.8% — — — ±6.3% 0 ±0.9% — — nACQ/fXCLK nTRK/fXCLK — 0 If CF chosen correctly If CF chosen correctly Automatic stable to lock time Automatic lock time PLL jitter (deviation of average bus frequency over 2 ms) — — ± (fXCLK) *(0.025%) *(N/4) N = VCO freq. mult. MC68HC908MR32 • MC68HC908MR16 Data Sheet, Rev. 6.1 Freescale Semiconductor 273 Electrical Specifications 19.13 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) Characteristics Characteristic Supply voltage Input voltages Resolution Absolute accuracy ADC internal clock Conversion range Power-up time Conversion time Sample time Monotonicity Zero input reading Full-scale reading Input capacitance VREFH/VREFL current Absolute accuracy (8-bit truncation mode) Quantization error (8-bit truncation mode) Symbol VDDAD VADIN BAD AAD fADIC RAD tADPU tADC tADS MAD ZADI FADI CADI IVREF AAD — 000 3FC — — — — — — — 1.6 — — 003 3FF 30 — ±1 + 7/8 – 1/8 Min 4.5 0 10 — 500 k VSSAD 16 16 5 Typ — — — — — — — — — Max 5.5 VDDAD 10 ±4 1.048 M VDDAD — 17 — Unit V V Bits LSB Hz V tAIC cycles tAIC cycles tAIC cycles Guaranteed Hex Hex pF mA LSB LSB Includes quantization VADIN = VSSAD VADIN = VDDAD Not tested Includes quantization tAIC = 1/fADIC Notes VDDAD should be tied to the same potential as VDD via separate traces VADIN
68HC908MR16CFU 价格&库存

很抱歉,暂时无法提供与“68HC908MR16CFU”相匹配的价格&库存,您可以联系我们找货

免费人工找货